Paradyne Network Card 916x User Manual

MODEL 916x/926x  
T1 ACCESS MUX  
TECHNICAL REFERENCE  
Document No. 9161-A2-GH30-31  
July 1998  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Important Regulatory Information  
EMI Warnings  
!
WARNING:  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device,  
pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against  
harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment  
generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance  
with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. Operation of this  
equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference in which case the user will be  
required to correct the interference at his own expense.  
The authority to operate this equipment is conditioned by the requirements that no modifications will be  
made to the equipment unless the changes or modifications are expressly approved by Paradyne.  
!
WARNING:  
To Users of Digital Apparatus in Canada:  
This Class A digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian interference-causing equipment  
regulations.  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe A respecte toutes les exigences du règlement sur le matériel  
brouilleur du Canada.  
9161-A2-GH30-31  
July 1998  
B
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Important Regulatory Information  
Important Safety Instructions  
1. Read and follow all warning notices and instructions marked on the product or included in the manual.  
2. All installation and service must be performed by qualified service personnel, as opening or removing covers may  
expose dangerous voltage points or other risks.  
3. This product is intended to be used with a 3-wire grounding type plug – a plug which has a grounding pin. This is  
a safety feature. Equipment grounding is vital to ensure safe operation. Do not defeat the purpose of the  
grounding type plug by modifying the plug or using an adapter.  
Prior to installation, use an outlet tester or a voltmeter to check the ac receptacle for the presence of earth  
ground. If the receptacle is not properly grounded, the installation must not continue until a qualified electrician  
has corrected the problem.  
If a 3-wire grounding type power source is not available, consult a qualified electrician to determine another  
method of grounding the equipment.  
The rear I/O panel has provision for a permanently connected protective earthing (grounding) conductor. Connect  
a 6-14 AWG conductor to this solderless lug connector, identified by the protective earth symbol.  
4. Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided for ventilation. To ensure reliable operation of the product and to  
protect it from overheating, these slots and openings must not be blocked or covered. Always install the housings  
in a vertical, upright position to allow for proper cooling.  
5. Do not allow anything to rest on the power cord and do not locate the product where persons will walk on the  
power cord.  
6. General purpose cables are provided with this product. Special cables, which may be required by the regulatory  
inspection authority for the installation site, are the responsibility of the customer. Use a minimum 26 AWG line  
cord for network connections.  
7. When installed in the final configuration, the product must comply with the applicable Safety Standards and  
regulatory requirements of the country in which it is installed. If necessary, consult with the appropriate regulatory  
agencies and inspection authorities to ensure compliance.  
8. A rare phenomenon can create a voltage potential between the earth grounds of two or more buildings. If  
products installed in separate buildings are interconnected, the voltage potential may cause a hazardous  
condition. Consult a qualified electrical consultant to determine whether or not this phenomenon exists and, if  
necessary, implement corrective action prior to interconnecting the products.  
9. Filler panels are provided with the housings to cover unused slots. You must install filler panels on the unused  
slots to avoid possible injury from electrical shock and to maintain compliance with FCC rules.  
10. In addition, if the equipment is to be used with telecommunications circuits, take the following precautions:  
Never install telephone wiring during a lightning storm.  
Never install telephone jacks in wet locations unless the jack is specifically designed for wet locations.  
Never touch uninsulated telephone wires or terminals unless the telephone line has been disconnected at the  
network interface.  
Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines.  
Avoid using a telephone (other than a cordless type) during an electrical storm. There may be a remote risk of  
electric shock from lightning.  
Do not use the telephone to report a gas leak in the vicinity of the leak.  
July 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-31  
C
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Important Regulatory Information  
Government Requirements  
Certain governments require that instructions pertaining to connection to the telephone network be included in the  
installation and operation manual. Specific instructions are listed in the following sections.  
United States  
Notice to Users of the Telephone Network  
This equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules. On the equipment is a label or silk screened text that  
contains, among other information, the FCC registration number for this equipment. If requested, please provide this  
information to your telephone company.  
If your T1 equipment causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone company may discontinue your service  
temporarily. If possible, they will notify you in advance. But if advance notice is not practical, you will be notified as  
soon as possible. You will be advised of your right to file a complaint with the FCC.  
Your telephone company may make changes in facilities, equipment, operations, or procedures that could affect the  
proper operation of your equipment. If so, you will be given advance notice so as to give you an opportunity to  
maintain uninterrupted service.  
No repairs may be performed by the user. Should you experience difficulty with this equipment, refer to the Warranty,  
Sales and Service Information section on page A.  
Make the T1 network connection using a Universal Service Order Code (USOC) type RJ48C jack for single-line  
installations and type RJ48H jack for multiline installations. Specify both the Service Order Code 6.0N, as well as the  
proper Facility Interface Code, to the telephone company when ordering the T1 line. The T1 equipment can be  
configured to support any of the framing format and line signaling techniques shown in the table below. The T1  
equipment’s configuration must correspond to the T1 line’s parameters.  
Facility Interface Codes  
Code  
Description  
04DU9-BN  
04DU9-DN  
04DU9-1KN  
04DU-1SN  
1.544 Mbps superframe format (SF) without line power  
1.544 Mbps SF and B8ZS without line power  
1.544 Mbps ANSI ESF without line power  
1.544 Mbps ANSI ESF and B8ZS without line power  
The Federal Communication’s Commission (FCC) requires that the end user (person responsible for operation and  
maintenance of the equipment) file an affidavit with the local exchange carrier when connecting unprotected  
Customer Premises Equipment (CPE) to the public T1 network. The T1 equipment is considered an unprotected CPE  
because the analog through transmission gain paths, associated with the voice cards, are user adjustable. This  
affidavit is required whenever digital terminal equipment without encoded analog content and billing protection is used  
to transmit digital signals containing encoded analog content which is intended for eventual conversion into  
voice-band analog signals and retransmitted on the network. This affidavit shall affirm that either no encoded analog  
content or billing information is being transmitted or that the output of the device meets Part 68 encoded analog  
content or billing protection specifications. An affidavit form has been provided for your convenience.  
9161-A2-GH30-31  
July 1998  
D
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Important Regulatory Information  
!
WARNING:  
In order to maintain compliance with Part 68, FCC Rules and Industry Canada’s CS-03 Specification, the  
transmit gain settings associated with the E&M, FXO and FXS Voice APMs must be set to ensure that:  
The absolute signal power of the encoded analog signals, other than live voice and network control  
signaling, will not exceed –12 dBm when averaged over any 3-second interval.  
For network control signals (such as DTMF), the level will not exceed –3 dBm.  
The E&M, FXO and FXS voice lines are to be connected to locally attached equipment only. Under no  
circumstances should voice lines be used on exposed (outside) plant lines.  
After the telephone company has installed the requested service and jack, you can connect the equipment to the  
network. An FCC-compliant telephone cord and modular plug are provided with this equipment. This equipment is  
designed to be connected to the telephone network or premises wiring using a compatible modular jack that is Part 68  
compliant.  
Canada  
Notice to Users of the Canadian Telephone Network  
The Industry Canada label identifies certified equipment. This certification means that the equipment meets  
telecommunications network protective, operational and safety requirements as prescribed in the appropriate Terminal  
Equipment Technical Requirements document(s). The Department does not guarantee the equipment will operate to  
the user’s satisfaction.  
Before installing this equipment, users should ensure that it is permissible to be connected to the facilities of the local  
telecommunications company. The equipment must also be installed using an acceptable method of connection. The  
customer should be aware that compliance with the above conditions may not prevent degradation of service in some  
situations.  
Repairs to certified equipment should be coordinated by a representative designated by the supplier. Any repairs or  
alterations made by the user to this equipment, or equipment malfunctions, may give the telecommunications  
company cause to request to disconnect the equipment.  
Users should ensure for their own protection that the electrical ground connections of the power utility, telephone lines  
and internal metallic water pipe system, if present, are connected together. This precaution may be particularly  
important in rural areas.  
CAUTION:  
Users should not attempt to make such connections themselves, but should contact the appropriate  
electric inspection authority, or electrician, as appropriate.  
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) assigned to each terminal device provides an indication of the maximum  
number of terminals allowed to be connected to a telephone interface. The termination on an interface may consist of  
any combination of devices subject only to the requirement that the sum of the Ringer Equivalence Numbers of all the  
devices does not exceed 5.  
If your equipment is in need of repair, refer to the procedures described in the Warranty, Sales and Service  
Information section on page A.  
July 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-31  
E
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
About This Guide  
H
H
H
H
H
Document Purpose and Intended Audience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ix  
Document Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ix  
Conventions Used . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . x  
Product-Related Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xi  
Reference Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xii  
1
2
About the T1 Access Mux  
H
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1  
Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2  
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6  
H
Management and Control  
H
H
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1  
Configuring Local Management Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1  
Creating a Management Link Through the COM Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Configuring an External Device (Connected to the COM Port) . . . . . 2-3  
Configuring End-to-End Management Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Management Control Using the ESF FDL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Management Control Using an EDL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
H
3
Applications  
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data and E&M . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data and APL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data, FXS and E&M . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data and Drop & Insert . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6  
Channel Bank Replacement and Additions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7  
Off-Premises Extension (OPX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8  
Direct Inward Dial (DID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8  
Video Conferencing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Consolidated T1 Access of DDS Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
i
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
4
User Interface  
H
H
H
H
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1  
Async Terminal User Interface Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1  
Network Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1  
Menu Hierarchy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1  
Main Menu Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2  
Screen Field Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2  
What Affects Screen Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Screen Work Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Navigating the Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Keyboard Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Screen Function Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
Selecting from a Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7  
Selecting a Field . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7  
Making Input Selections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7  
Switching Between Screen Work Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8  
Accessing the User Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8  
H
H
5
Setting Up  
H
Considerations When Setting Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1  
Selecting a Management Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Logins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Adding System Identity Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Setting Date and Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Configuring the T1 Access Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Recommended Order of Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5  
Configuration Option Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5  
Accessing and Displaying Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5  
Changing Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6  
Saving Configuration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6  
Configuring T1 and DSX-1 Interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7  
Configuring the Network Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7  
Configuring the DSX-1 Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Configuring Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16  
Configuring Sync Data Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16  
Configuring Voice Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Configuring OCU-DP Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-32  
Copying Port Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-35  
H
H
H
H
H
H
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
ii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
H
Assigning Cross Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-36  
Assigning DSX-1 Timeslots to the Network Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-39  
DSX-1 Signaling Assignments and Trunk Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . 5-40  
Assigning Network 2 Timeslots to Network 1 Interface Timeslots . . . 5-43  
Network to Network Signaling Assignments and Trunk  
Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-43  
Assigning Voice Ports to DSX-1 or Network Interface Timeslots . . . . 5-44  
Assigning Sync Data Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-44  
Assigning OCU-DP Data Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-46  
Clearing Port Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-47  
Setting System Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-48  
Setting User Interface Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-52  
Setting Up the Communication Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-52  
H
H
Setting Up the Communication Port to Support an External  
Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-57  
Setting Up to Support a Telnet or FTP Session . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-61  
Configuring for Alarms and Traps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-64  
Setting Management and Communication Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-67  
Setting Communication Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-67  
Setting Up for SNMP Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-70  
Setting Up SNMP NMS Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-72  
Setting Up for SNMP Traps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-74  
Setting Up and Placing a Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-78  
H
H
H
H
6
Security  
Limiting Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1  
Limiting Async Terminal Direct Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1  
Limiting Telnet Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3  
Controlling External Device Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
Controlling SNMP Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Disabling SNMP Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Assigning SNMP Community Names and Access Levels . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Limiting SNMP Access Through IP Addresses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Creating a Login . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8  
Deleting a Login . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9  
H
H
H
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
7
Displaying System Information  
H
H
H
H
H
Displaying System and NAM Identity Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1  
Displaying APM Identity Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2  
Displaying System and Test Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2  
Displaying Voice APM Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3  
Displaying Cross Connect Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7  
Displaying Network Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7  
Displaying DSX-1 Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9  
Displaying Port Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11  
Displaying Device Name and SNMP System  
Identification Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12  
H
Viewing Network and Sync Data Performance Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12  
What Statistics Can Be Collected? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12  
Network Performance Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13  
Sync Data Performance Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13  
Displaying Performance Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14  
Selecting Performance Statistics Intervals for Display . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14  
Clearing Performance Statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-16  
Status Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-16  
System Status Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-16  
System Health and Test Status Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-17  
Health and Status Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-17  
Self-Test Results Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-22  
Test Status Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-24  
H
H
H
8
Operation and Maintenance  
H
Startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1  
Logging In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1  
Logging Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
Starting a Session . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
Ending a Session . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4  
Supported SNMP Traps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5  
Dialing Out and Sending SNMP Traps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5  
Maintaining COM Port Directories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Displaying Directory Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Changing Directory Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7  
Changing Device Name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7  
H
H
H
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
iv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
H
Hot Swapping of APMs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8  
APM Insertion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8  
APM Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9  
NAM Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9  
Downloading Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9  
File Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9  
Performing an Upgrade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Backing Up Your Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12  
Resetting the T1 Access Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13  
Resetting the T1 Access Unit from the Control Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13  
Restoring Access to the User Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13  
H
H
H
H
H
H
9
Troubleshooting  
H
H
H
H
What Are the Troubleshooting Features? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1  
How Do I Know There Is a Problem? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1  
T1 NAM LEDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2  
T1 NAM Test Jack Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4  
9161 Single T1 NAM Test Jack Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4  
9261 Dual T1 NAM Test Jack Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5  
Dual DSX APM LEDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6  
9109 Dual DSX APM Test Jack Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7  
Test Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8  
Sync Data APM Front Panel LEDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9  
OCU-DP APM Front Panel LEDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10  
Voice APM Front Panel LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11  
System Alarm Relay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11  
Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12  
Viewing Alarm Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12  
ASCII Alarm Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12  
System Error Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-18  
Automatic Dialing Out When an Alarm Occurs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-19  
Manual Dialing Out When an Alarm Occurs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20  
Tests Available . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-21  
Interface Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-22  
Line Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-23  
Payload Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24  
Repeater Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-25  
Remote Loopbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-26  
Sending and Monitoring Pattern Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-27  
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
H
H
Data Port Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-28  
DTE Loopback (DTLB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-28  
DTE Payload Loopback (DTPLB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-29  
Data Channel Loopback (DCLB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-30  
V.54 Remote Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-30  
Remote FT1 Data Channel Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-31  
Sending and Monitoring Pattern Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-32  
Voice Port Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-32  
Digital Loopbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-33  
Analog Loopbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-33  
Line Loopbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-34  
Test Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-34  
Force and Monitor Signaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-35  
OCU-DP Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-37  
Sending a Latching Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-37  
Starting/Stopping Other Loopbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-38  
OCU-DP Local Loopback Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-38  
DDS CSU/DSU Latching/Nonlatching Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-39  
OCU Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-40  
DS-0 Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-40  
Line Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-41  
Data Loopback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-42  
OCU-DP Remote Loopback Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-42  
Device Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-42  
Test Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-43  
Starting and Stopping a Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-43  
Aborting All Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-44  
Determining Test Status and Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-44  
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
A Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
H
H
H
H
Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-1  
Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-2  
Recording Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-3  
Channel Assignments Worksheets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A-15  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
vi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
B IP Addressing  
H
H
Selecting an IP Addressing Scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-1  
IP Addressing Scheme Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3  
Direct Management Links to Remote T1 Access Units . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3  
Routing to Remote T1 Access Units on the Same Subnet . . . . . . . . . B-4  
Routing to Remote Access Units Using Different Subnets . . . . . . . . . B-5  
Routing to Remote T1 Access Units Using Routers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-6  
Assigning IP Addresses and Subnet Masks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-7  
C SNMP Traps  
H
H
H
H
Trap: warmStart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-1  
Trap: authentificationFailure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-2  
Traps: linkUp and linkDown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-2  
Traps: Enterprise-Specific . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C-4  
D SNMP Cross-Reference  
E Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
H
COM Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-1  
COM Port-to-PC Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-2  
COM Port-to-Terminal/Printer Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-2  
COM Port-to-Modem Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-3  
Gender Adapter/Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-3  
LAN Adapter and Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-4  
T1 Network Interface Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-4  
DSX-1 Port Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-5  
T1 Line Interface Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-5  
EIA-530A Port Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-6  
EIA-530A-to-V.35 DTE Adapter Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-7  
EIA-530A-to-RS449 DTE Adapter Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-9  
EIA-530A-to-X.21 DTE Adapter Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-11  
Voice APM Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-12  
FXO/FXS Voice APM Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-12  
E&M Voice APM Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-13  
Extension Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-15  
OCU Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-25  
OCU Port Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-25  
T1 Mass Termination Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-26  
RJ48H Connector Pinouts for T1 Mass Termination Cable . . . . . . . . E-26  
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
F Technical Specifications  
G Equipment List  
Glossary  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
viii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
About This Guide  
Document Purpose and Intended Audience  
This manual contains information needed to properly set up, configure and verify  
operation of the 916x/926x T1 Access Mux. It is designed for system designers,  
engineers, system administrators, and operators.  
Document Summary  
Section  
Description  
Chapter 1  
About the T1 Access Mux. Provides an overview of the  
components and features of the T1 access unit.  
Chapter 2  
Management and Control. Contains the steps you  
need to provide management connectivity to the T1  
access unit.  
Chapter 3  
Applications. Shows some typical T1 access unit  
applications.  
Chapter 4  
Chapter 5  
User Interface. Describes the async terminal interface.  
Setting Up. Describes how to configure the T1 access  
unit for operation in your network.  
Chapter 6  
Security. Describes how to administer security,  
including log-in procedures, and limiting user interface,  
telnet, and SNMP access.  
Chapter 7  
Chapter 8  
Displaying System Information. Describes how to  
display information about your system.  
Operation and Maintenance. Provides information for  
startup and monitoring, dialing out to send SNMP  
traps, maintaining call directories, hot swapping APMs,  
downloading, upgrading, and resetting the T1 access  
unit.  
Chapter 9  
Troubleshooting. Explains troubleshooting and test  
procedures of the T1 access unit.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About This Guide  
Section  
Description  
Appendix A  
Menus and Configuration Worksheets. Contains a  
graphical representation of the system configuration  
options and worksheets for you to record your  
selections.  
Appendix B  
IP Addressing. Provides guidelines for selecting an IP  
addressing scheme.  
Appendix C  
Appendix D  
SNMP Traps. Lists SNMP traps.  
SNMP Cross-Reference. Provides a cross-reference of  
SNMP MIB objects and user interface commands.  
Appendix E  
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments. Describes  
cables to be used with the T1 access unit, as well as  
their connectors and pin assignments.  
Appendix F  
Appendix G  
Glossary  
Index  
Technical Specifications.  
Equipment List. Lists related equipment.  
Defines acronyms and terms used in this document.  
Lists key terms, acronyms, concepts, and sections in  
alphabetical order.  
Conventions Used  
Convention  
Indicates  
Italic  
Variable information (e.g., slot s, indicating slot  
number 01, 02, etc.).  
Menu selection sequence:  
The selections to be made from a menu or  
selections from within a menu before  
performing a procedural step (e.g.,  
Main MenuStatusSystem and Test Status).  
Brackets [ ]  
Multiple selection choices (e.g., [Current  
Configuration/Customer Configuration 1/  
Customer Configuration 2]).  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
x
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About This Guide  
Product-Related Documents  
Document Number  
Document Title  
9000-A2-GN14  
2-Slot and 5-Slot Housing Wall Mounting Kit  
Installation Instructions  
9000-A2-GN15  
9000-A2-GN16  
2-Slot Housing Installation Instructions  
5-Slot Housing with AC Power Supply Installation  
Instructions  
9000-A2-GN17  
5-Slot Housing and FrameSaver 9000 Series Access  
Carrier AC Power Supply Installation Instructions  
9000-A2-GN1A  
9000-A2-GN1B  
2-Slot Power Supply Installation Instructions  
DC Power Supply for 5-Slot Housing Installation  
Instructions  
9000-A2-GN1C  
5-Slot Housing with DC Power Supply Installation  
Instructions  
9000-A2-GN1D  
9000-A2-GX42  
9000 Series Access Carrier Installation Instructions  
Affidavit Requirements for Connection to Digital  
Service  
9109-A2-GN10  
9109-A2-GN11  
9109-A2-GN12  
9109-A2-GN13  
9109-A2-GN14  
9109-A2-GN15  
9161-A2-GK41  
9161-A2-GK43  
9109 Sync Data Application Module (APM)  
Installation Instructions  
9109 E&M Analog Voice Application Module (APM)  
Installation Instructions  
9109 FXS Analog Voice Application Module (APM)  
Installation Instructions  
9109 Dual DSX Application Module (APM)  
Installation Instructions  
9109 FXO Analog Voice Application Module (APM)  
Installation Instructions  
9109 OCU-DP Application Module (APM) Installation  
Instructions  
916x T1 Access Mux Software Release 1 to  
Release 2 Upgrade Instructions  
9161/9261 T1 Network Access Module (NAM)  
Upgrade Instructions  
9161-A2-GL10  
9161-A2-GN10  
916x/926x T1 Access Mux Quick Reference  
9161 Single T1 Network Access Module (NAM)  
Installation Instructions  
9261-A2-GN10  
9261-A2-GZ10  
9261 Dual T1 Network Access Module (NAM)  
Installation Instructions  
9161 Single T1 Network Access Module (NAM) to  
9261 Dual T1 NAM Upgrade Instructions  
Contact your sales or service representative to order additional product  
documentation.  
Paradyne documents are also available on the World Wide Web at:  
http://www.paradyne.com  
Select Service & Support Technical Manuals  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
xi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About This Guide  
Reference Documents  
CSA-22.2 No. 950  
CSA 108-M1983  
FCC Part 15  
UL 1950  
Management Information Base for Network Management of TCP/IP-Based  
Internets: MIBII. RFC 1213, March 1991  
Definitions of Managed Objects for the DS1 and E1 Interface Types. RFC 1406,  
January 1993  
Evolution of the Interfaces Group of MIB II. RFC 1573, January 1994  
Definitions of Managed Objects for RS-232-like Hardware Devices. RFC 1659,  
July 1994  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
xii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About the T1 Access Mux  
1
Overview  
The T1 Access Mux is the interface between your customer premises equipment  
and a T1 network. The 916x/926x product line supports the following T1 Access  
Mux configurations:  
H
H
H
9161 Single T1 NAM or 9261 Dual T1 NAM in a 2-slot housing  
9161 Single T1 NAM or 9261 Dual T1 NAM in a 5-slot housing  
9161 Single T1 NAM or 9261 Dual T1 NAM in a 9000 Series Access Carrier  
All configurations are referred to as the T1 access unit in this document.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
1-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter:ChapName  
Components  
The T1 access unit consists of either a 9161 or 9261 Network Access Module  
(NAM) installed in a two-slot or five-slot chassis, along with optional Sync Data,  
DSX, or voice Application Modules (APMs) for particular applications. Up to 14  
NAMs can also be installed in the 14-slot access carrier.  
Ground Screw  
and Label  
Slot 01 Slot 02  
Slot 02 Slot 01  
Front View  
Rear View  
(without Bezel)  
98-15129-02  
Fully Loaded 2-Slot Housing  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
1-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About the T1 Access Mux  
Ground Screw  
and Label  
Slot 01  
Slot 05  
Slot 01  
Slot 05  
Front View  
(without Bezel)  
Rear View  
98-15138-02  
Fully Loaded 5-Slot Housing  
Slot 01  
Slot 01  
Slot 14  
Slot 14  
Front View  
Rear View  
98 -15743-02  
Fully Loaded Access Carrier  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
1-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About the T1 Access Mux  
The 9161 Single T1 NAM is equipped with:  
IN  
H
H
H
One T1 network interface  
One DSX-1 drop and insert port  
Two DTE interface ports  
IN  
NTE1  
NTE  
OUT  
OUT  
IN  
IN  
NTE2  
DXS  
OUT  
OUT  
IN  
IN  
E1TMON  
NTE  
The 9261 Dual T1 NAM is equipped with:  
MNO  
OUT  
OUT  
H
H
Two T1 network interfaces  
Two DTE interface ports  
IN  
IN  
E2TMON  
DXSMON  
OUT  
OUT  
916  
9261  
OK  
OK  
ALM  
ALM  
TST  
BKP  
SIG  
TST  
BKP  
SIG  
NTEWORK  
NTE1  
OOF  
ALM  
SIG  
OOF  
ALM  
1–  
OOF  
ALM  
SIG  
OOF  
ALM  
1–  
NTE2  
DXS  
OK  
P
OK  
PRO  
2–  
2–  
T
T
O
O
K
K
496-15206  
97-15645  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
1-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About the T1 Access Mux  
There are six APM types:  
H
The Synchronous Data APM, which supports:  
IN  
— Four ports, each supporting EIA-530A, V.35,  
RS449, or V.11/X.21  
OUT  
IN  
OUT  
— Rates of Nx56 or Nx64  
IN  
— Standard RS232-like (RFC 1659) MIB  
OUT  
IN  
— Enterprise MIB for testing, statistics, and  
some configuration functions  
OUT  
OK  
OK  
See the 9109 Sync Data Application Module (APM)  
Installation Instructions for more information.  
1–  
SIG  
OK  
H
H
The Dual DSX APM, which supports:  
— Two DSX-1 drop and insert ports  
2–  
OOF  
O
K
3–  
ALM  
O
K
4–  
SIG  
O
K
OOF  
See the 9109 Dual DSX Application Module  
(APM) Installation Instructions for more  
information.  
ALM  
The E&M Voice APM, which supports:  
— E&M Type I, II, IV, or V circuits  
496-15154  
97-15649-01  
law PCM coding of analog voice line  
— Enterprise MIB for testing and  
some configuration functions  
See the 9109 E&M Analog Voice  
Application Module (APM) Installation  
Instructions for more information.  
H
H
The FXO Voice APM, which supports:  
1
109FXS  
190FX  
OK  
OK  
— FXO circuits  
O
law PCM coding of analog voice line  
— Enterprise MIB for testing and some  
configuration functions  
See the 9109 FXO Analog Voice Application  
Module (APM) Installation Instructions  
for more information.  
The FXS Voice APM, which supports:  
496-15141  
496-15139  
97-15648  
— FXS circuits  
law PCM coding of analog voice line  
— Enterprise MIB for testing and some  
configuration functions  
See the 9109 FXS Analog Voice Application Module (APM) Installation  
Instructions for more information.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
1-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About the T1 Access Mux  
H
The OCU-DP APM, which supports:  
— Either two or six ports  
— Speeds of 56 kbps and 64 kbps, as well as 4-wire  
Switched 56  
— Enterprise MIB for testing and some  
configuration functions  
See the 9109 OCU-DP Application Module (APM)  
Installation Instructions for more information.  
OK  
NOTE:  
1-TST  
2-TST  
The following NAM I/O versions are required to use the  
OCU-DP APM:  
— SINGLE T1 NAM (870-3389-8000) for the  
9161 Single T1 NAM  
— DUAL T1 NAM (870-2585-8000) for the  
9261 Dual T1 NAM  
98-15927  
98-15926  
Features  
The T1 access unit offers the following features:  
H
Upgradability. There are three housings to select from: 2-slot, 5-slot and  
14-slot access carrier. You can start with a 2-slot housing, and move your  
NAM and APM to a 5-slot housing at a later time. Only NAMs may be used in  
a 14-slot housing.  
— The 2-slot housing holds one NAM and APM pair.  
— The 5-slot housing holds one NAM and up to four APMs, allowing  
expansion capability as your network needs grow.  
— As you need additional DTE or voice ports for your network applications,  
you can add APMs.  
H
Modular Design. Any NAM or APM can be physically removed from one  
housing and moved to another.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
1-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About the T1 Access Mux  
H
Hot Swapping. Provides the ability to insert and remove APMs without  
powering-down the housing, and without having to reconfigure the cards  
each time they are moved.  
The APM configurations travel with the NAM. When an APM is inserted or  
removed, the NAM senses that an APM has been inserted or removed, and  
can automatically make the appropriate changes to screens, configuration  
options, and MIB objects.  
— When an APM is inserted in a previously unassigned slot, the T1 access  
unit configures the APM using the factory default configuration.  
— When the same type of APM is inserted into a previously assigned slot,  
the T1 access unit uses the configuration for the APM that previously  
occupied the slot; the APM does not have to be reconfigured.  
— When another type of APM is inserted into a previously assigned slot, an  
alarm and trap are generated for the slot. If accepted, the factory default  
configuration is loaded for the new APM type; if rejected, the new APM is  
ignored and the previous configuration is retained.  
H
The NAM can be removed without powering down the unit; however, all  
system functionality is lost. When a NAM is removed and inserted into  
another housing, it applies the NAM’s configurations from the previous  
housing to the current housing.  
— If the NAM is moved from a 2-slot housing to a 5-slot housing, the  
operator can use the configuration of the APM in slot 02 of the previous  
housing. APMs in slots 03 – 05 will be configured with the factory default  
settings.  
— If the NAM is moved from a 5-slot housing to a 2-slot housing, the factory  
default configuration options are loaded.  
— If the NAM is moved from a 2-slot or a 5-slot housing to a 14-slot  
housing, the factory default configuration options are loaded.  
H
H
Multiple User Interfaces. Provides multiple means for configuring,  
operating, managing, and monitoring the unit.  
Menu-Driven User Interface. Provides an easy to use, menu-driven  
interface for configuring and managing the T1 access unit locally or  
remotely.  
Access to the user interface can be through an async terminal (or other  
VT100-compatible terminal), PC emulation, modem, or a Telnet session.  
LED (Light-Emitting Diode) Monitoring. Provides LEDs on the circuit card  
faceplates that indicate the status of the card’s operation.  
Network Management Capability.  
SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) Management. Provides  
network management via an external SNMP management system using  
industry-standard and Paradyne-specific MIB (Management Information  
Base) objects.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
1-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About the T1 Access Mux  
H
Multiple Management Paths. Provides multiple methods for sending/  
receiving management data.  
Embedded Data Link (EDL). Provides a path for management data over  
a performance channel between two nodes. The performance channel  
uses 8 Kbps of bandwidth, and is embedded in the synchronous data  
channel. If you choose this method, you must have a Sync Data port.  
Direct Data Link (DDL). Provides a path between two nodes over the  
T1/FT1 link itself, embedding the management data in the T1 bundle.  
The management data always uses 1 DS0 (64 Kbps).  
Facility Data Link (FDL). Provides the management path over the FDL of  
the DS1 extended superframe (ESF). Using this method does not use  
any customer data bandwidth, but requires end-to-end connectivity. If you  
select this method, you may need to work with your service provider to  
ensure that ESF framing is used and the required FDL management path  
exists end-to-end.  
COM Port. Provides a physical path over the communications  
port/interface for local user interface access or network IP connectivity  
data management.  
H
H
H
IP Connectivity. Supports connectivity within an IP network for up to 300 IP  
host and/or network routes. Using the four management paths described  
above, provides IP routing for SNMP, Telnet, and file transfer protocol (FTP)  
messages connectivity without requiring direct connections.  
DSX-1 Drop and Insert port(s) allows DTEs/PBXs that support the DS1  
signal format to share the T1 network with other high-speed equipment. One  
DSX-1 port is provided on the 9161 T1 NAM. The DSX APM (for use with the  
9261 T1 NAM) provides two drop/insert ports.  
Alarm and Fault Condition Indication. Provides the capability of attaching  
a terminal or printer to display/print alarm messages.  
Alarms or traps that are generated include: power supply, loss of signal, out  
of frame, alarm indication signal, excessive error rate, primary and secondary  
clock failure, yellow alarm signal received, misconfiguration, and APM failure.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
1-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About the T1 Access Mux  
H
Extensive Testing Capability. Provides the capability to maintain the T1  
access unit and diagnose device and network problems via:  
Menu-Driven User Interface. Accessed using an async (or other  
VT100-compatible) terminal, PC emulation, or Telnet, provides T1  
network, DSX-1, sync data port, voice port, and device (lamp) tests.  
Loopbacks that can be selected for an interface include: line, payload,  
repeater, remote line, DTE, DTE payload (V.54 loop 3), data channel,  
remote data channel (V.54 loop 2 or FT1), V.54, digital, and analog.  
Pattern Tests that can be selected for an interface include: QRSS,  
all zeros, all ones, 1-in-8 (T1 interface only), 3-in-24 (T1 interface only),  
15  
20  
63, 511, 2047, 2 -1, 2 -1, and 2-byte (user defined).  
Tone and signal tests can also be selected for voice APMs.  
SNMP MIB Object Test Commands. Supports the same testing capability  
as the user interface. Paradyne MIBs can be downloaded from our World  
Wide Web site. See page A of this manual for our World Wide Web site  
address.  
Test Jacks. Located on the T1 access unit’s faceplate, support using  
external test equipment to perform break-in testing and monitoring of the  
T1 network and DSX-1 interfaces. Remove the housing’s bezel to access  
these jacks.  
H
Extensive Monitoring Capability. Provides status information to help you  
keep track of and evaluate the unit’s and network’s operation via:  
Status Branch. Provides system and test status, voice card status for all  
eight ports for each card, channel status for all DS0 assignments for all  
time slots of the T1 network interface, channel status for all DS0  
assignments for all time slots of the DSX-1 interface, and all port  
assignments for each voice and data port of both the NAM and APM  
cards.  
Front Panel. Provides test jacks to monitor the unit’s T1 network and  
DSX-1 interfaces, and LEDs to monitor the unit and its interfaces.  
Test jacks. Accessed by removing the housing’s bezel, provide T1  
network and DSX-1 monitoring.  
LEDs. Visible without removing the bezel, provide unit and interface  
monitoring that includes T1 network and DSX-1 interface received signal  
status, as well as synchronous data port statuses.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
1-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About the T1 Access Mux  
H
Extensive Statistics Gathering. Provides a complete view of the network’s  
and each data port’s performance through the statistical data collected from  
those interfaces to assist in determining the duration of a condition or event.  
— A total of 96 intervals (24 hours) of user and Telco statistical data is kept,  
seven per screen page, over a 24 hour period, in 15-minute intervals.  
— A total of 32 intervals (8 hours) of Synchronous Data Port statistical data  
is kept, over an 8 hour period, in 15-minute intervals.  
— Quick and easy access to any of the 96 sets of statistics is provided by  
selecting a specific interval or occurrence timeframe. (Specifying an  
occurrence timeframe is useful when you know about what time a  
specific event occurred.)  
You can select a set of statistics to display at the following times:  
following an event, preceding an event, immediately preceding and  
following an event, or only those statistics that occurred at or after the  
event that is the specified interval or time.  
— Statistics collected measure or count the following: errored, unavailable,  
severely errored, and bursty errored seconds, as well as controlled slip  
seconds and loss-of-frame counts. In addition, yellow alarm, loss of  
signal, excessive error rate, frame-synchronization bit error, and  
line-code violation counts are kept for each 15-minute interval.  
— The worst interval for each statistic is provided as an additional aid in  
selecting statistical information surrounding trouble spots.  
H
H
Configuration Upload/Download and Software Download Capability.  
Provides quick, cost-effective software upgrades, and quick transfer of  
configuration options to and from nodes using a standard file transfer protocol  
(FTP).  
Security. Provides multiple levels of security, which prevents unauthorized  
access to the unit.  
Security can be controlled by:  
— Disabling any form of access to the unit.  
— Requiring logins (login ID/password/access level combinations), with  
three access levels to select from: read-only, limited-access, and  
full-access.  
— Enabling SNMP management, and specifying a community name and  
access level Read or Read/Write.  
— Enabling SNMP management, and specifying the IP addresses of only  
selected NMSs.  
H
H
Redundant power supply. Redundant load sharing supply (both AC and DC  
versions available) for the 5-slot housing and the access carrier. Protects the  
system from a service outage if one power supply fails.  
Wall-Mount Bracket. Allows one 5-slot, or up to two 2-slot housings to be  
mounted on a wall.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
1-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Management and Control  
2
Overview  
This chapter provides the steps needed to provide management connectivity to  
the T1 access unit. You need to select and configure:  
H
H
A method of local management connectivity for T1 access units.  
A method for end-to-end management connectivity across the network.  
See Appendix B, IP Addressing for an IP addressing scheme that fits the local  
and end-to-end management connectivity methods.  
Configuring Local Management Control  
When managing the T1 access unit locally, you can establish a management link  
in one of two ways. You can:  
H
H
Create a management link directly connected through the COM port.  
Connect through an external device (modem, LAN adapter, etc.) to the COM  
port.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
2-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Management and Control  
Creating a Management Link Through the COM Port  
When the COM port is configured as the IP management link (Net Link), the user  
interface is also accessible via Telnet. Although not shown in the illustration  
below, a LAN adapter can be connected to the COM port to provide Ethernet or  
Token Ring connectivity, or an async terminal (or other VT100-compatible)  
interface can be directly connected to the COM port, as well.  
Customer Data  
T1  
Access  
Unit  
DTE  
Port  
DCE  
Port  
T1  
Network  
WAN Link  
Router  
NET  
Port  
AUX  
Port  
COM  
Port  
Management Data  
Physical Connection  
Customer Data  
• 2 Cables  
– 1 for Management Data  
496-15182  
– 1 or more for Customer Data  
The configuration options below show what should be configured for a  
management link. These configuration options are configured from the user  
interface based upon the Port Type selected, Asynchronous or Synchronous.  
Menu selection sequence:  
Main MenuConfigurationUser InterfaceCommunication Port  
Port Use Set to Net Link and  
Port Type Set to Asynchronous  
Port Use Set to Net Link and  
Port Type Set to Synchronous  
— Data Rate (Kbps)  
— Character Length  
— Parity  
— Clock  
— Data Rate (Kbps)  
— Stop Bits  
— Ignore Control Leads  
See Table 5-10, Communication Port Options, in Chapter 5, Setting Up.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
2-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Management and Control  
When the communication (COM) port is configured as the IP management link,  
the async terminal interface is accessible through Telnet.  
When this is the case, you also need to enable Telnet session configuration  
options.  
Menu selection sequence:  
Main MenuConfigurationUser InterfaceTelnet/FTP Session  
You must also have an IP address and a subnet mask assigned.  
Menu selection sequence:  
Main MenuConfigurationManagement and Communication  
See Table 5-12, Telnet/FTP Session Options, in Chapter 5, Setting Up.  
In addition, if you want to access the configuration files (upload, download), or  
download new firmware files to the T1 access unit, you must set the FTP Session  
configuration option to Enable.  
Configuring an External Device (Connected to the COM Port)  
The T1 access unit can be managed remotely by connecting an external device  
like a modem or PAD (packet assembly/disassembly) facility to the COM port.  
T1 Access  
Simple  
ASCII  
Interface  
Unit  
T1  
Network  
WAN Link  
Async or  
VT100  
Terminal  
-or-  
SNMP  
NMS  
COM  
Port  
VT100 Emulation  
and Telnet or  
NMS using SNMP  
External  
Modem  
External  
Modem  
PSTN  
97-15188-01  
Using this out-of-band example, configure call processing using the following  
pertinent configuration options, configured from the user interface.  
Menu selection sequence:  
Main MenuConfigurationUser InterfaceExternal Device (COM Port)  
— External Device Commands  
— Dial-In Access  
— Port Usage  
See Table 5-11, External Device (COM Port) Options, in Chapter 5, Setting Up.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
2-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Management and Control  
Configuring End-to-End Management Control  
When managing the T1 access unit remotely, you can establish a management  
link across the network in one of three ways. You can:  
H
H
H
Use the Facility Data Link (FDL) for a point-to-point ESF T1 link.  
Use an Embedded Data Link (EDL) associated with a Sync Data port.  
Use a Direct Data Link (DDL).  
Management Control Using the ESF FDL  
You can configure the T1 access unit to use FDL as a management link if  
available for a point-to-point, ESF T1 link, where FDL is end-to-end.  
T1 Access  
Unit B  
T1 Access  
Unit A  
LAN  
T1  
Network  
NMS  
Physical Connection  
FDL  
496-15183  
As shown in the example, in-band management is accomplished through the FDL  
between the two T1 access units. Management data for T1 Access Unit B goes to  
T1 Access Unit A, which then routes it into the FDL between the units. This  
example assumes that the NMS (or Host) that is attempting to access T1 Access  
Unit B is attached (using SLIP or PPP) via the COM port on T1 Access Unit A.  
Set the Management Link configuration option to FDL.  
Menu selection sequence:  
Main MenuConfigurationNetwork Interface  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
2-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Management and Control  
Management Control Using an EDL  
In the configuration below, the T1 access unit’s management data is multiplexed  
with customer data by taking 8 Kbps of the allocated data on a port to use as the  
EDL.  
There is one configured EDL through the network to each unit:  
H
A shared circuit for management and customer data  
T1 Access  
Unit C  
Port y  
Cluster  
Controller  
T1 Access  
Unit A  
T1 Access  
Unit B  
T1  
Network  
Port 1  
FEP  
Port 2  
Router  
Port x  
Router  
Physical Connection  
EDL  
496-15184  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
2-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Management and Control  
This page intentionally left blank.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
2-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Applications  
3
Overview  
This chapter provides information about the following applications:  
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data and E&M  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data and APL  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data, FXS and E&M  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data and Drop & Insert  
Channel Bank Replacement and Additions  
Off Premises Extension (OPX)  
Direct Inward Dial (DID)  
Video Conferencing  
Consolidated T1 Access of DDS Circuits  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
3-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Applications  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data  
This application supports two ports of high speed data. The following diagram  
depicts a router and a mainframe.  
The data moving through the FEP and the cluster controller is heritage data that  
is not available on the LAN. Because the T1 access unit includes two data ports,  
the router-based data can easily be added to the network without disrupting the  
existing network operations.  
The data rates available to the two applications can be easily changed. This  
allows the router connection to increase in speed. It also allows the FEP-based  
data to reduce its data rate as the amount of data transmitted on this route  
declines naturally over time.  
Cluster  
Controller  
FEP  
Terminal  
Router  
Router  
Mainframe  
T1 Access  
Unit  
T1 Access  
Unit  
496-15189  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
3-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Applications  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data and E&M  
Analog PBXs (shown in the following diagram) typically communicate on trunk  
lines (lines between switches) with a type of communications protocol called  
E&M.  
The T1 access unit fully supports this application. The T1 access unit supports up  
to three 8-port E&M APMs. In the example shown in the diagram, eight time slots  
could be assigned to the voice ports, two time slots to the FEP-Cluster controller  
link, and up to 14 time slots to the router link. This provides the following:  
H
H
H
Voice – Eight telephone calls  
FEP-CC – 128 kbps  
Router – 896 kbps  
Downtown HQ  
Cluster  
Controller  
FEP  
Terminal  
T1 Access  
Unit  
T1 Access  
Unit  
Router  
Router  
Mainframe  
E&M  
PBX  
E&M  
PBX  
Analog  
PBX  
Analog  
PBX  
496-15190  
Suburban Office  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data and E&M  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
3-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Applications  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data and APL  
In the example shown in the following diagram, E&M analog voice APMs are  
used to transport analog private line (APL) modem traffic instead of voice traffic.  
In some parts of the country digital circuits are hard to obtain, and many  
applications do not require the higher speeds of digital circuits. This application  
allows customers to use existing modems while reducing the cost of using them  
by eliminating access lines.  
The T1 access unit supports up to three 8-port E&M APMs. A typical application  
consists of:  
H
H
H
Modem Lines – Eight lines  
FEP-CC – 128 kbps  
Router – 896 kbps  
E&M is used to transport the analog information, and no E&M signaling is  
involved. In fact, the E&M signaling leads are disconnected in this application (the  
operating mode is set to Transmit Only). See Chapter 4, Setting Up, for more  
information on configuring voice ports.  
Downtown HQ  
Cluster  
Controller  
FEP  
Terminal  
T1 Access  
Unit  
T1 Access  
Unit  
Router  
Router  
Mainframe  
E&M  
(APL Modems)  
497-15191-01  
Suburban Office  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data and APL  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
3-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Applications  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data, FXS and E&M  
In the example shown in the following diagram, data and regular voice traffic are  
transported by the T1 access unit and the APL modem. E&M-type voice (in  
Transmit mode only) is being used to transport the APL modem traffic, while FXS  
is employed to transmit regular voice traffic.  
Another variation of this application would have the lines connected to the  
telephones terminate at a switch in the cloud, where they could be connected to  
any other telephone in the world.  
Downtown HQ  
Cluster  
Controller  
FEP  
Terminal  
T1 Access  
Unit  
T1 Access  
Unit  
Router  
Router  
Mainframe  
FXS and E&M  
Voice  
497-15192-01  
APL  
Modems  
Warehouse  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data FXS and E&M (Transmit Only Mode)  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
3-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Applications  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data and  
Drop & Insert  
In the example shown in the following diagram, voice and data are mixed. The  
Drop and Insert feature of the T1 access unit allows voice information to be sent  
from a remote site to a large site that contains a digital PBX. People at the distant  
end can make calls.  
Multiple routers and data lines require adding a Sync Data APM to the T1 access  
unit, because more than two data ports are needed.  
Administration  
Service  
Router  
Headquarters  
T1 Access  
Unit  
T1 Access  
Unit  
Router  
Router  
Sales  
Mainframe  
T1 or DSX-1  
Drop and Insert  
FXS  
PBX  
Digital  
PBX  
Regional Office  
97-15193-01  
T1 Access Unit with High Speed Data and Drop & Insert  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
3-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Applications  
Channel Bank Replacement and Additions  
In the example shown in the following diagram, the T1 access unit is a  
replacement for a channel bank. The T1 access unit is more than just a  
replacement for a channel bank. It can do many things that a channel bank  
cannot do. A channel bank has no data ports, it passes data as if it comes from  
external modems or DSUs. The T1 access unit provides both data and voice  
ports. A channel bank is a “dumb” device, and therefore cannot be managed from  
a remote site, while the T1 access unit can be managed via SNMP.  
Public Switched  
Telephone Network  
T1 Access Unit  
with E&M and  
4-Wire  
E&M Circuits  
FXS APMs  
PBX  
D4  
Analog  
PBX  
Switch  
FXS Circuits  
to Dial Modems  
97-15194-01  
Channel Bank Replacement  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
3-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Applications  
Off-Premises Extension (OPX)  
The configuration shown in the following diagram permits a branch location to  
access the PBX line as if it were locally connected. Likewise, the branch office  
phones appear as if they are locally connected. A call between the two sites does  
not result in any long distance charges.  
Branch Office  
Headquarters  
T1 Access  
T1 Access  
Unit  
Unit  
Router  
Router  
PBX  
Line  
FXO  
FXS  
X114  
X114  
PBX  
Mainframe  
X113  
X112  
X111  
97-15672  
Off-Premises Extension  
Direct Inward Dial (DID)  
The configuration shown in the following diagram allows an incoming call to dial  
to an extension from the PBX, without going through the main switchboard.  
T1 Access  
Unit  
DID Lines  
Central  
Office  
(CO)  
T1 Facility  
FXO  
PBX  
97-15673  
Direct Inward Dial  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
3-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Applications  
Video Conferencing  
The OCU-DP APM supports Switched 56 video as shown in the following  
example. Here, an external video codec is connected to OCU-DP ports using  
external Switched 56K DSU/CSUs. This connection can be up to 18,000 feet. The  
OCU-DP APM converts the 56K digital format from the line side into a digital DS0  
format. This DS0 format contains the 56K of data plus the necessary signaling  
information required to set up the call to the far-end video equipment.  
4-Wire  
Switched  
56K Facility  
Video  
Codec  
Video  
Codec  
4-Wire  
56K Facility  
Switched  
56K  
DDS/PSTN  
T1FT1  
T1 Access  
56K  
DSU/CSU  
Integral 56K  
DSU/CSUs  
Mux with  
OCU-DP  
Cards(s)  
98-15972  
Video Conferencing  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
3-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Applications  
Consolidated T1 Access of DDS Circuits  
The following example illustrates how to use the OCU-DP APM to reduce facility  
costs associated with point-to-point 56/64K connections by consolidating these  
lines into a single T1 facility. The T1 Access Muxes shown in this application  
could also be used to support both voice and high-speed data.  
Typically, T1 Access Muxes are placed at concentration points where a single T1  
line is less costly than multiple (typically four or five) 56K lines. If DSUs are left at  
both ends of the circuit, proprietary DSU Network Management Systems can be  
used. Or, circuits associated with remote DSUs can be terminated directly on a  
Sync Data APM at the Data Center to eliminate Data Center DSUs.  
The OCU-DP APM does not support subrate DDS rates. Subrate applications can  
be supported by installing a Paradyne 3610 or similar device configured for  
56/64K line speed.  
56 kbps  
Data Center  
56 kbps  
T1  
OCU-DP  
Card  
DCE  
Manager  
56 kbps  
56 kbps  
56 kbps  
1 or 2  
T1s  
T1  
Public  
Network  
DSU  
Carrier  
Remote DSUs  
98-15971  
Consolidated T1 Access of DDS Circuits  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
3-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Interface  
4
Introduction  
The T1 access unit uses menu-driven asynchronous (async) terminal interface  
menus and screens. Along with the LED status indicators on the front panel, the  
menu-driven interface provides feedback and status on the:  
H
H
H
H
T1 access unit  
DSX-1 and Network T1 interfaces  
Synchronous data ports  
Voice ports  
Async Terminal User Interface Access  
You can access the user interface:  
H
H
Locally through a direct connection to the communications port via an async  
terminal (or other VT100-compatible terminal) or PC emulation.  
Remotely through a Telnet session, although only one user interface session  
may be active at one time.  
Network Management  
Manage the T1 access unit via an SNMP management system connected to the  
communications port or through a remote in-band connection.  
Menu Hierarchy  
The menu hierarchy represents the organization of the system’s menus and  
screens. Refer to the enclosed Quick Reference for a pictorial view of the menu  
hierarchy.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
4-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Interface  
Main Menu Screen  
Access to all of the T1 access unit’s tasks begins at the Main Menu screen, which  
has four menus or branches.  
The login’s access level appears at the top of the screen unless no security has  
been set up. Menu branches are filtered based on effective security level, which  
is the lower of the Session Access Level (Telnet/FTP Session options) and the  
Login ID access level (Administer Logins under the Control branch).  
Select . . .  
To . . .  
Security Level  
Status  
View diagnostic tests, voice interfaces, cross  
connections, statistics, and T1 access unit  
identity information.  
1, 2, 3  
Test  
Select, monitor, and cancel test for the system’s 1, 2  
interfaces.  
Configuration  
Control  
Display and edit the configuration options.  
1, 2, 3  
Control the user interface for call setup, device  
naming, date and time, login administration,  
and system alarm relay cut-off (for the 5-slot  
housing). Also, initiate a power-on reset of the  
system.  
1
Screen Field Types  
Three types of screen fields are available on the async terminal.  
Use screen field . . .  
Menu selection  
Input  
To . . .  
Display a list of available functions for user selection.  
Add or change information on a screen.  
H Underlines in the field value or selection indicate an input  
or edit field.  
Display  
Display configuration information and results from  
performance and system-specific tests.  
H No underlines in the field value or selection indicate a  
display-only field.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
4-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Interface  
What Affects Screen Displays  
What appears on the screens depends on:  
H
H
Current configuration – How your T1 access unit is currently configured.  
Security access level – The security level set by the system administrator  
for each user.  
H
Data selection criteria – What you entered in previous fields or screens.  
Screen Work Areas  
There are two user work areas:  
H
H
Screen area – Where you input information into fields.  
Screen function key area – Where you perform specific screen functions.  
Following is a sample async terminal interface screen.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
4-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Interface  
Menu Path  
Model Number  
Access Level  
Date and Time  
main  
Device Name: Node A  
Access Level: 1  
Company Name 9162  
01/26/96 23:32  
Device  
Name  
MAIN MENU  
Status  
Test  
Configuration  
Control  
Screen  
Area  
–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––  
Screen  
Function  
Key Area  
Ctrl-a to access these functions  
Save  
Exit  
System  
Message Area  
Screen Format  
Menu path  
Description  
Menu selections made to reach the current screen.  
Customer-assigned identification of the system.  
Currently assigned security access level.  
Vendor company name.  
Device name  
Access level  
Company Name  
Model number xxxx  
The T1 access unit’s model number:  
H 9162 – 9161 Single T1 NAM in 2-slot housing  
H 9165 – 9161 Single T1 NAM in 5-slot housing  
H 9262 – 9261 Dual T1 NAM in 2-slot housing  
H 9265 – 9261 Dual T1 NAM in 5-slot housing  
H 9161 – 9161 Single T1 NAM in 14-slot housing  
H 9261 – 9261 Dual T1 NAM in 14-slot housing  
Date and Time  
Screen area  
Date and Time kept locally by the system  
(24-hour clock).  
Selection, display, and input fields for monitoring and  
maintaining the system.  
Screen function keys  
Specific functions that can be performed on the  
screen.  
System messages and  
field values  
System-related information, valid values for input  
fields, and System Health and Status messages.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
4-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Interface  
Navigating the Screens  
You can navigate the screens by:  
H
H
H
Using keyboard keys  
Switching between the two screen work areas  
Using screen function keys  
Keyboard Keys  
Use the following keyboard keys to navigate within the screens.  
To . . .  
Press . . .  
Move cursor between the screen area and  
the screen function keys area  
Ctrl-a  
Return to the previous screen  
Move cursor to the next field  
Esc  
Right Arrow (on same screen row), or  
Tab (on any screen row)  
Move cursor to the previous field  
Left Arrow (on same screen row), or  
Ctrl-k  
Move cursor one position to the left. If the  
cursor is at the beginning of a field,  
Backspace has no effect.  
Backspace  
Move cursor to the first character of the  
previous field (backtab)  
Ctrl-k  
Display the next valid value for the field  
Delete character that the cursor is on  
Spacebar  
Delete (Del)  
Move cursor up one field within a column on  
the same screen  
Up Arrow or Ctrl-u  
Move cursor down one field within a column  
on the same screen  
Down Arrow or Ctrl-d  
Right Arrow or Ctrl-f  
Move cursor one character to the right if in  
edit mode  
Move cursor one character to the left if in edit Left Arrow or Ctrl-b  
mode  
Redraw the screen display, clearing  
information typed in but not yet entered  
Ctrl-l  
Accept entry or display valid options on the  
last row of the screen when pressed before  
entering data or after entering invalid data  
Return (Enter)  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
4-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Interface  
Screen Function Keys  
All screen function keys (located in the lower part of the screen) operate the  
same way (upper- or lowercase) throughout the screens.  
These keys use the following conventions:  
For the screen  
Select . . .  
M or m  
E or e  
N or n  
O or o  
L or l  
And press Return to . . .  
Return to the Main Menu screen.  
Terminate the async terminal session.  
Enter new data.  
function . . .  
MainMenu  
Exit  
New  
Modify  
Modify existing data.  
Delete  
Save  
Delete data.  
S or s  
R or r  
Save information.  
Refresh  
ClrStats  
Update screen with current information.  
C or c  
Clear network performance statistics and refresh the  
screen.  
U or u  
D or d  
PgUp  
PgDn  
Display the previous page.  
Display the next page.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
4-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Interface  
Selecting from a Menu  
You select from a menu to get subsequent menus or screens so you can perform  
desired tasks.  
" Procedure  
To make a menu selection:  
1. Tab or press an arrow key to position the cursor on a menu selection. Each  
menu selection is highlighted as you press the key to move the cursor from  
position to position.  
2. Press Return. The selected menu or screen appears.  
3. Continue Steps 1 and 2 until you reach the screen you want.  
Refer to the Quick Reference to guide you through menu selections.  
Selecting a Field  
Once you have reached the desired menu or screen, select a field to view,  
change, or issue a command. Select a field from within a menu in the same way  
you select from a menu – press the Tab or right arrow key.  
Example:  
Selecting Control from the Main Menu, selecting Administer Logins, then entering  
or changing security information.  
Making Input Selections  
You can enter information into a field in one of several ways. Once the field is  
selected, you can:  
H
H
Manually type in (enter) the field value or command.  
Example:  
Entering abc as a user’s Login ID on the Administer Logins screen (from the  
Control menu/branch).  
Type in (enter) the first letter(s) of a field value or command, using the  
character matching feature.  
Example:  
When configuring an FXS voice port’s operating mode with the Operating  
Mode configuration option/field selected (values FXS, FXSDN,  
FXSDN/WINK, PLAR and DPO), entering f or F displays the first value  
starting with f – FXS. In this example, entering fxsd or FXSD would display  
FXSDN as the selection.  
H
H
Switch from the screen area to the screen function area and select or enter  
the designated screen function key. See Switching Between Screen Work  
Areas for an example.  
Press the spacebar to make the next valid choice.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
4-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Interface  
Switching Between Screen Work Areas  
Use Ctrl-a to switch between the two screen work areas to perform all screen  
functions.  
" Procedure  
1. Press Ctrl-a to switch from the screen area to the screen function key area.  
2. Select either the function’s designated (underlined) character or Tab to the  
desired function key.  
Example:  
Enter e or E to Exit.  
3. Press Return. The function is performed.  
4. To return to the screen area, press Ctrl-a again.  
Accessing the User Interface  
T1 access unit connectivity can be established via a directly-connected terminal.  
However, if for some reason you cannot access the user interface, do one of the  
following:  
H
Reset COM Port – Allows you to reset the configuration options related to  
COM port usage. This also causes a device reset, where the T1 access unit  
performs a Device Self-Test. No security-related configuration options are  
changed.  
H
Reload Factory Defaults – Allows you to reload the Default Factory  
Configuration, resetting all of the configuration and control settings. This  
method is also useful when the user’s password(s) have been forgotten.  
Selecting this method also causes a device reset.  
" Procedure  
To reset COM port settings:  
1. Attach the async terminal to the COM port.  
2. At the async terminal, configure the terminal to operate at 19.2 kbps, using  
character length of 8 bits, with one stop-bit, and no parity.  
3. Ensure that any hardware or software flow control is disabled.  
4. Reset the T1 access unit, then immediately and repeatedly press Return at a  
rate of at least 1 press per second until the System Paused screen appears.  
5. Tab to the desired method, and enter yes (or y) for the selected prompt.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
4-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
User Interface  
If entering yes to prompt . . . Then . . .  
Reset COM Port usage  
H Port Type is set to Terminal.  
H Data Rate (Kbps) is set to 19.2.  
H Character Length is set to 8.  
H Stop Bits is set to 1.  
H Parity is set to None.  
H External Device Commands is set to Disable.  
Reload Factory Defaults  
All factory-loaded configuration and control  
settings contained in the Default Factory  
configuration area are loaded.  
If no (or n) is entered, or if no selection is made within 30 seconds, the T1  
access unit returns to the condition of operation it was in when the system  
pause was initiated, with the COM port settings returning to their configured  
states.  
If you chose yes, the T1 access unit resets itself, going through a Device  
Self-Test. Connectivity is restored and the Main Menu screen appears.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
4-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
User Interface  
This page intentionally left blank.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
4-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up  
5
Considerations When Setting Up  
When setting up the system, you need to:  
H
Arrange for T1 service.  
H
Plan your channel map. See Assigning Cross Connections on page 5-36 for  
more information.  
H
Choose a management configuration. Decide how you want to manage the  
system:  
— Locally through the T1 access unit’s communications (COM) port either  
directly or remotely through a modem.  
— Through an asynchronous terminal interface or Telnet session, or through  
an SNMP NMS.  
H
H
H
Determine whether you want alarms generated and how you would like the  
system to communicate alarm information to an ASCII terminal/printer or a  
management system. Configuring for Alarms and Traps on page 5-64 tells  
you how to set alarms.  
Determine whether you want traps generated and how you would like the  
system to communicate trap information to an ASCII terminal/printer or a  
management system. Setting Up for SNMP Management on page 5-70 tells  
you how to set SNMP traps.  
If you are managing the system using an SNMP NMS or Telnet, select an IP  
addressing scheme.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Selecting a Management Interface  
Select one of the following management interfaces:  
H
Asynchronous terminal interface – Over the T1 access unit’s COM port for  
local configuration and control when the system does not include an NMS.  
An asynchronous terminal interface is also required for initial setup that  
enables external management.  
H
H
Telnet access to an asynchronous terminal interface – Over the T1 access  
unit’s COM port, through the ESF Facility Data Link (FDL), via an associated  
EDL (EDL) or Direct Data Link (DDL).  
SNMP – SNMP manager(s) using the SNMP protocol to configure and  
control the unit using standard MIBs and enterprise-specific MIB extensions.  
Logins  
Refer to Chapter 6, Security, to learn how to create and delete logins.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Adding System Identity Information  
Use the Device Name screen to identify this system, and to change or display the  
general name, location, and contact for the system.  
" Procedure  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Control Device Name  
2. Use the Tab key to move the cursor to the field where you want to add or  
change information.  
NOTE:  
To clear existing information, place the cursor in the Clear field and press  
Return.  
If the selection is . . . Enter the . . .  
Device Name  
Unique name for device identification of up to  
20 characters.  
System Name  
SNMP system name; can be up to 255 characters.  
System Location  
Your system’s physical location; can be up to  
255 characters.  
System Contact  
Name and how to contact the person responsible for this  
system; can be up to 255 characters.  
3. To save changes, select Save and press Return.  
When Save is complete, Command Complete appears in the message area  
at the bottom of the screen.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Setting Date and Time  
Use the Date & Time screen to set the date and time for the system.  
" Procedure  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Control Date & Time  
2. Use the Tab key to move the cursor to the field where you want to add or  
change information.  
NOTE:  
To clear existing information, move the cursor to the Clear field and press  
Return.  
If the selection is . . . Enter the . . .  
Date (mm/dd/yy)  
Time (hh:mm)  
Date in the format mm/dd/yy or mm-dd-yy.  
Time (24-hour clock) in the format hh:mm.  
3. To save changes, select Save and press Return.  
When Save is complete, Command Complete appears in the message area  
at the bottom of the screen.  
Configuring the T1 Access Unit  
Your system comes preconfigured with factory default settings as noted in the  
configuration option tables in this chapter, as well as on the Quick Reference. If  
you need to display or change these settings, use the system’s Configuration  
branch.  
To change configuration option settings you must perform the following tasks:  
H
H
H
Access and display configuration option settings  
Change configuration option settings  
Save configurations option settings to a configuration option area  
NOTE:  
Only Security Access Level 1 users can change configuration options.  
Security Access Level 2 and 3 users can just view configuration options.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Recommended Order of Configuration  
The menu tree is organized in the recommended order of configuration. See  
Appendix A, Menus and Configuration Worksheets, for a graphical view of the  
system layout. Use the worksheets to keep track of the configuration option  
settings.  
Configuration Option Areas  
The T1 access unit offers four configuration option storage areas:  
Configuration Option Area Description  
Current Configuration  
The T1 access unit’s set of currently active  
configuration options.  
Customer Configuration 1  
Customer Configuration 2  
The first of two alternate sets of configurations that can  
be set up by the customer and stored for future use.  
The second of two alternate sets of configurations that  
can be set up by the customer and stored for future use.  
Default Factory Configuration A read-only configuration area containing the factory  
default configuration options.  
You can load and edit the default factory configuration  
settings, but you can only save those changes to the  
Current, Customer 1, and Customer 2 configuration  
option areas.  
The Current, Customer 1, and Customer 2 configuration  
option areas are identical to the Default Factory  
Configuration until modified by the customer.  
Accessing and Displaying Configuration Options  
To access and display the configuration options, you must first load (copy) the  
applicable configuration option set into the edit area.  
NOTE:  
If your T1 access unit is operating at any speed other than the default  
(19.2 kbps) and you attempt to load factory default configuration options, you  
could lose your communication link.  
" Procedure  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Configuration  
2. The Load Configuration From screen appears. Select the configuration option  
area you want to load and press Return. The selected configuration option  
set is loaded into the configuration edit area and the Configuration  
Edit/Display screen appears.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Changing Configuration Options  
Once the Configuration is loaded, use the Configuration Edit/Display screen to  
display, change, and save a configuration in one of the configuration areas.  
" Procedure  
1. From the Configuration Edit/Display screen, select the configuration option  
set you want to view or make changes to and press Return.  
2. Select the configuration options applicable to your network, and make  
appropriate changes to the setting(s).  
3. Repeat Steps 1 and 2 until all changes are complete.  
Saving Configuration Options  
When all changes to the configuration options are complete, use the Save  
function key to save configuration option changes to either the Current,  
Customer 1, or Customer 2 configuration areas.  
" Procedure  
1. Press Ctrl-a to switch to the screen function key area.  
2. Select the Save function key from any of the Configuration branch screens  
and press Return. The Save Configuration To screen appears.  
3. Select the configuration option area where you want to save the changes to  
and press Return.  
When Save is complete, Command Complete appears in the message area  
at the bottom of the screen.  
NOTE:  
If you changed configuration options and try to exit the Configuration  
branch without saving those changes, a Save Configuration screen  
appears requiring a Yes or No response to saving the changes.  
If you select . . . Then the . . .  
No  
Main Menu screen appears. Changes are not saved.  
Yes  
Save Configuration To screen appears. Choose a  
configuration option area to save to (e.g., Customer  
Configuration 1).  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Configuring T1 and DSX-1 Interfaces  
You can configure the following interfaces:  
H
H
Network Interface  
DSX-1 Interface (if applicable)  
Configuring the Network Interface  
Use the Network Interface Options screen to configure the network interface on  
the T1 NAM (see Table 5-1).  
Configuration Edit/Display Network  
If you have a 9261 Dual T1 NAM, select the desired Network interface, 1 (default)  
or 2, in the NETWORK field. For the 9161 Single T1 NAM, this field is read-only  
and always displays a 1.  
Table 5-1. Network Interface Options (1 of 7)  
Interface Status  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable for Network interface 1  
Enable for Network interface 2  
Specifies whether the interface selected in the Network field is available for use.  
H Interface Status is read-only if Network is set to 1 (first interface on the 9261 Dual  
T1 NAM, or the interface on the 9161 Single T1 NAM).  
Enable – The interface is available.  
Disable – The interface is not available for use. When the interface is disabled, any  
existing cross-connect assignments for this interface will be cleared, no alarms or traps  
for this interface will be generated, no configuration options will be displayed, and all  
LEDs associated with this interface will remain off. If you attempt to disable the  
Network 2 interface for which cross connections exist, the message This action will  
clear all Network n Cross Connections. Are You Sure? No appears. If you select:  
No – The operation is cancelled.  
Yes – The following occurs:  
H All existing cross-connect assignments for this interface are cleared.  
H Alarms or traps associated with this interface are not generated.  
H LEDs associated with this interface are held in an “off’’ state.  
Line Framing Format  
Possible Settings: D4, ESF  
Default Setting: ESF  
Specifies the framing format for transmitted and received signals on the T1 network  
interface.  
D4 – Uses D4 framing format.  
ESF – Uses Extended Superframe (ESF) framing format.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-1. Network Interface Options (2 of 7)  
Line Coding Format  
Possible Settings: AMI, B8ZS  
Default Setting: B8ZS  
Specifies the line coding format for the network interface.  
AMI – Uses Alternate Mark Inversion (AMI) line coding format.  
B8ZS – Uses Bipolar 8 Zero Suppression (B8ZS) line coding format.  
Line Build Out (LBO)  
Possible Settings: 0.0, –7.5, –15, –22.5  
Default Setting: 0.0  
Specifies the line build out for the signal transmitted to the network.  
0.0, –7.5, –15, –22.5 – Specifies line build out in dB.  
Bit Stuffing  
Possible Settings: 62411, Part68, Disable  
Default Setting: 62411  
Determines the type of bit insertion to provide ones density requirements for data  
transmitted to the network.  
H Bit Stuffing does not appear if Line Coding Format is set to B8ZS.  
62411 – Inserts a one in the data after 15 consecutive zeros are received or the density  
of ones falls below 12.5%. This setting complies with AT&T TR 62411.  
Part68 – Inserts a one in the data if 80 consecutive zeros are received or the density of  
ones falls below 12.5%.  
Disable – Does not enforce ones density on the data sent to the network.  
Network Initiated LLB  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Allows the initiation and termination of the line loopback (LLB) to be controlled by the  
receipt of LLB-Actuate and LLB-Release commands from the network.  
Enable – LLB is controlled by LLB-Actuate and LLB-Release commands. Receiving a  
LLB-Actuate command causes the NAM to enter a line loopback (provided an LLB can  
be performed in the T1 access unit’s current state). Receiving a LLB-Release command  
terminates the LLB.  
Disable – The T1 access unit ignores the LLB-Actuate and LLB-Release commands.  
NOTE: When disabled, the NAM is not in compliance with ANSIT1.403 or  
AT&T TR 62411.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-1. Network Interface Options (3 of 7)  
Network Initiated PLB  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Allows the initiation and termination of the payload loopback (PLB) to be controlled by  
the receipt of PLB-Actuate and PLB-Release commands from the network.  
H Network Initiated PLB only appears if Line Framing Format is set to ESF.  
Enable – PLB is controlled by PLB-Actuate and PLB-Release commands. Receiving a  
PLB-Actuate command causes the T1 access unit to enter a payload loopback  
(provided a PLB can be performed in the NAM’s current state). Receiving a  
PLB-Release command terminates the PLB.  
Disable – The T1 access unit ignores the PLB-Actuate and PLB-Release commands.  
NOTE: When disabled, the unit is not in compliance with ANSIT1.403 or  
AT&T TR 54016.  
Transmit Timing  
Possible Settings: System, Network  
Default Setting: System  
Allows transmit timing to be selected from either the system master clock source or from  
the currently selected network interface.  
H Transmit Timing only appears for the 9261 Dual T1 NAM.  
System – Transmit timing is derived from the current system clock source (set using  
System Options, see Table 5-9).  
Network – Transmit timing is derived from this interface.  
NOTE: When Network is configured, the clock must be synchronized to the system  
clock source.  
ANSI Performance Report Messages  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies whether ANSI T1.403 compliance performance report messages (PRMs) are  
generated and sent to the network over the ESF FDL every second.  
H ANSI Performance Report Messages only appears if Line Framing Format is set  
to ESF.  
Enable – Generates and sends PRMs.  
Disable – Does not generate and send PRMs.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-1. Network Interface Options (4 of 7)  
Management Link  
Possible Settings: Disable, FDL, DDL  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies the network management link.  
NOTES: – If both FDL and DDL are not available selections, the configuration  
option is set to Disable and cannot be edited.  
– If Management Link for the local T1 access unit is set to FDL or DDL,  
configure the remote T1 access unit with the same settings.  
Disable – Does not use the management link.  
FDL – Uses FDL as the management link. FDL allows IP management traffic to flow  
over the 4 kbps data link provided by the FDL. FDL requires an end-to-end FDL  
connection and cannot be terminated within the network.  
H FDL does not appear if:  
– Line Framing Format is set to D4.  
– EDL on any synchronous data port is set to Enable.  
DDL – Uses DDL as the management link.  
H DDL does not appear if all network time slots are assigned.  
IP Address  
Possible Settings: 000.000.000.000 – 223.255.255.255, Clear  
Default Setting: 000.000.000.000  
Specifies the internet protocol address for the management link.  
H IP Address only appears if Management Link is set to FDL or DDL.  
000.000.000.000 – 223.255.255.255 – The IP address for the management link which  
you can view or edit. The first digit (i.e., xxx.255.255.255) cannot be 0 or 127, or greater  
than 223. However, 000.000.000.000 is valid, representing a null address.  
Clear – Resets the IP address and fills the address with zeros.  
Subnet Mask  
Possible Settings: 000.000.000.000 – 255.255.255.255, Clear  
Default Setting: 000.000.000.000  
Specifies the subnet mask for the management link.  
H Subnet Mask only appears if Management Link is set to FDL or DDL.  
000.000.000.000 – 255.255.255.255 – The subnet mask for the management link which  
you can view or edit.  
Clear – Resets the node subnet mask and fills the address with zeros  
(i.e., 000.000.000.000). When the subnet mask is all zeros, the IP protocol creates a  
default subnet mask based on the class of the IP address: Class A: 255.000.000.000,  
Class B: 255.255.000.000, or Class C: 255.255.255.000.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-1. Network Interface Options (5 of 7)  
Routing Information Protocol  
Possible Settings: None, Proprietary  
Default Setting: Proprietary  
Specifies whether routing information protocol (RIP) is used for routing of management  
information between NAMs.  
H Routing Information Protocol only appears if Management Link is set to FDL or  
DDL.  
None – No routing protocol is used. Use this setting when the device at the other end of  
the management link cannot accept routing information.  
Proprietary – A proprietary variant of RIP version 1 is used to communicate routing  
information between NAMs to enable the routing of IP traffic.  
Network Time Slot  
Possible Settings: 01 – 24  
Default Setting: lowest available time slot  
Specifies the time slot for the DDL management link.  
H Network Time Slot only appears appears if Management Link is set to DDL.  
NOTE: If Management Link is not set to DDL, the assigned time slot will be set to  
unassigned.  
01 – 24 – Valid settings consist of any unassigned time slot within the 01 – 24 range.  
Circuit Identifier  
Possible Settings: Text Field, Clear  
Default Setting: blank  
Identifies the transmission vendor’s circuit information for the purpose of facilitating  
troubleshooting.  
Text Field – Edit or display circuit identifier information (maximum 255 characters).  
Clear – Removes the circuit identifier information.  
Loss of Signal (LOS) Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Specifies whether an alarm message is generated when a loss of signal condition is  
detected on the network interface.  
Enable – Generates an ASCII alarm message.  
Disable – Does not generate an ASCII alarm message.  
Out of Frame (OOF) Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Specifies whether an alarm is generated when an out-of-frame condition is detected on  
the network interface.  
Enable – Generates an alarm message.  
Disable – Does not generate an ASCII alarm message.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-1. Network Interface Options (6 of 7)  
Alarm Indication Signal (AIS) Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Specifies whether an alarm message is generated when an alarm indication signal  
condition is detected on the network interface.  
Enable – Generates an ASCII alarm message.  
Disable – Does not generate an ASCII alarm message.  
Yellow Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Specifies whether an alarm message is generated when a yellow alarm condition is  
detected on the network interface.  
Enable – Generates an ASCII alarm message.  
Disable – Does not generate an ASCII alarm message.  
Excessive Error Rate (EER) Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Specifies whether an alarm message is generated when an excessive error rate  
condition is detected on the network interface.  
H Excessive Error Rate only appears if Line Framing Format is set to ESF.  
Enable – Generates an ASCII alarm message.  
Disable – Does not generate an ASCII alarm message.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-1. Network Interface Options (7 of 7)  
Excessive Error Rate Threshold  
Possible Settings: 10E-4, 10E-5, 10E-6, 10E-7, 10E-8, 10E-9  
Default Setting: 10E-4  
Sets the error rate threshold that determines when an excessive error rate (EER)  
condition is declared. The excessive error rate is determined by the ratio of the number  
of CRC6 errors to the total number of bits received over a set period of time.  
H Excessive Error Rate Threshold only appears if Line Framing Format is set to  
ESF.  
10E-4 – Declares an EER if more than 1,535 CRC6 errors are detected in a 10-second  
period. Clears when fewer than 1,536 CRC6 errors are detected within the same time  
period.  
10E-5 – Declares an EER if more than 921 CRC6 errors are detected in a 60-second  
–4  
period or a 10 condition occurs. Clears when fewer than 922 CRC6 errors are  
detected within the same time period.  
10E-6 – Declares an EER if more than 92 CRC6 errors are detected in a 60-second  
–5  
–4  
period or a 10 or 10 condition occurs. Clears when fewer than 93 CRC6 errors are  
detected within the same time period.  
10E-7 – Declares an EER if more than 9 CRC6 errors are detected in a 60-second  
–6  
–5  
–4  
period or a 10 , or 10 , or 10 condition occurs. Clears when fewer than 10 CRC6  
errors are detected within the same time period.  
10E-8 – Declares an EER if more than 41 CRC6 errors are detected in three 15-minute  
–7  
–6  
–5  
–4  
intervals or a 10 , 10 , 10 , 10 condition occurs. Clears when fewer than 42 CRC6  
errors are detected within the same time period.  
10E-9 – Declares an EER if more than 4 CRC6 errors are detected in three 15-minute  
–8  
–7  
–6  
–5  
–4  
intervals or a 10 , 10 , 10 , 10 , or 10 condition occurs. Clears when fewer than  
5 CRC6 errors are detected within the same time period.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Configuring the DSX-1 Interface  
Use the DSX-1 Interface Options screen to configure the DSX-1 interface on the  
T1 NAM (see Table 5-2).  
Configuration Edit/Display DSX-1  
NOTE:  
If the DSX-1 interface is disabled, Disable appears on the screen. No other  
options are shown.  
If you are using a Dual DSX APM, enter the port number of the desired DSX-1  
interface in the PORT field. For the DSX port on the 9161 Single T1 NAM, a 1 is  
displayed and is read-only.  
Table 5-2. DSX-1 Interface Options (1 of 3)  
Interface Status  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Determines if the DSX-1 interface is provided by the port.  
Enable – The DSX-1 interface port transmits and receives data.  
Disable – The DSX-1 interface port does not transmit or receive data. If time slots are  
assigned to the DSX-1 interface when an attempt is made to disable this configuration  
option, the message This action will clear all DSX-1 Cross Connections. Are You  
Sure? No appears. If you select:  
No – The operation is cancelled.  
Yes – The following occurs:  
H All existing DSX-1 interface cross-connect assignments are cleared.  
H Alarms or traps associated with the DSX-1 interface are not generated.  
H LEDs associated with the DSX-1 interface are held in an “off’’ state.  
Line Framing Format  
Possible Settings: D4, ESF  
Default Setting: ESF  
Specifies the framing format for transmitted and received signals on the DSX-1  
interface.  
D4 – Uses D4 framing format.  
ESF – Uses Extended Superframe (ESF) framing format.  
Line Coding Format  
Possible Settings: AMI, B8ZS  
Default Setting: B8ZS  
Specifies the line coding format for the DSX-1 interface.  
AMI – Uses Alternate Mark Inversion (AMI) line coding format.  
B8ZS – Uses Bipolar 8 Zero Suppression (B8ZS) line coding format.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-2. DSX-1 Interface Options (2 of 3)  
Line Equalization  
Possible Settings: 0–133, 133–266, 266–399, 399–533, 533–655  
Default Setting: 0–133  
Permits a standard DSX signal to be delivered over a distance of up to 655 feet.  
0–133 – Equalization on the DSX-1 side allows up to 133 feet of cable between the  
NAM and the DTE.  
133–266 – Equalization on the DSX-1 side allows up to 266 feet of cable between the  
NAM and the DTE.  
266–399 – Equalization on the DSX-1 side allows up to 399 feet of cable between the  
NAM and the DTE.  
399–533 – Equalization on the DSX-1 side allows up to 533 feet of cable between the  
NAM and the DTE.  
533–655 – Equalization on the DSX-1 side allows up to 655 feet of cable between the  
NAM and the DTE.  
Send All Ones on DSX-1 Failure  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Determines whether action is taken when a valid signal cannot be recovered for the  
DSX-1 (LOS, continuous OOF, or AIS).  
Enable – Sends all ones on the DS0 channels allocated to the DSX-1 interface in the  
event of an LOS, AIS, or continuous OOS condition on the DSX-1 interface.  
Disable – No action is taken when a signal fails on the DSX-1 interface. The data  
received is passed through the network interface channels unchanged.  
Loss of Signal (LOS) Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Specifies whether an alarm message is generated when a loss of signal condition is  
detected on the DSX-1 interface.  
Enable – Generates an ASCII alarm message.  
Disable – Does not generate an ASCII alarm message.  
Out of Frame (OOF) Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Specifies whether an alarm message is generated when an out-of-frame condition is  
detected on the DSX-1 interface.  
Enable – Generates an ASCII alarm message.  
Disable – Does not generate an ASCII alarm message.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-2. DSX-1 Interface Options (3 of 3)  
Alarm Indication Signal (AIS)  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Specifies whether an alarm message is generated when an alarm indication signal  
condition is detected on the DSX-1 interface.  
Enable – Generates an ASCII alarm message.  
Disable – Does not generate an ASCII alarm message.  
Yellow Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Specifies whether an alarm message is generated when a yellow alarm condition is  
detected on the DSX-1 interface.  
Enable – Generates an ASCII alarm message.  
Disable – Does not generate an ASCII alarm message.  
Configuring Ports  
Configure the following ports on the T1 NAM and any APMs that are installed in  
your system.  
H
H
Sync Data ports on the T1 NAM or the Sync Data APM  
Voice ports on the FXS, FXO and E&M APMs  
Once you have a port configured, you can copy that configuration to other ports  
of the same type (see Copying Port Configurations on page 5-35).  
Configuring Sync Data Ports  
Use the Synchronous Data Port Options to configure the synchronous data  
port(s) on the T1 NAM or on any Sync Data APM associated with the NAM (see  
Table 5-3).  
Configuration Edit/Display Sync Data Ports  
NOTE:  
If the selected Synchronous Data Port is disabled, Disable appears on the  
screen. No other options are shown.  
The Synchronous Data Port Options screen appears for Port 1 of the first slot  
containing a Sync Data APM. If desired, enter the slot and port number of  
another sync data port.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-3. Synchronous Data Port Options (1 of 7)  
Port Status  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Determines whether the synchronous data port is being used and can be configured.  
H Synchronous data port options do not appear if Port Status is set to Disable.  
Enable – The port is active, and can be used to transmit and receive data.  
Disable – The port is not active. When the port is disabled, the following will occur:  
H No alarms or traps configured for the port will be generated.  
H LED for the port will be held in an Off state.  
H Existing cross-connect assignments associated with the port will be cleared. The  
message This action will clear any Cross Connections for the Port. Are You  
Sure? No appears. If you select:  
No – The operation is cancelled. (Pressing either the Esc or Ctrl-a key acts as a  
No.)  
Yes – Port status is disabled.  
Port Type  
Possible Settings: E530, V.35, RS449, X.21  
Default Setting: E530  
Selects the synchronous data port type for the data port.  
E530 – The port is an EIA-530A-compatible DCE. An EIA-530-compatible DTE can be  
directly connected to the DB25 connector.  
V.35 – The port is a V.35-compatible DCE. A V.35-compatible DTE can be connected to  
the DB25 connector by using an MS34-to-DB25 adapter cable.  
RS449 – The port is an RS449-compatible DCE. An RS449-compatible DTE can be  
connected to the DB25 connector by using DB37-to-DB25 adapter cable.  
X.21 – The port is a V.11/X.21-compatible DCE. A V.11/X.21-compatible DTE can be  
connected to the DB25 connector by using a DB15-to-DB25 adapter cable.  
Port Base Rate  
Possible Settings: Nx64, Nx56  
Default Setting: Nx64  
Specifies the base rate for the synchronous data port. The data rate for the port is a  
multiple (from 1 to 24) of the base rated specified by this configuration option.  
Nx64 – The base rate for the port is 64 kbps. The data rate available for the port is  
Nx64, where N is the number of channels to which the port is cross-connected (1–24).  
Nx56 – The base rate for the port is 56 kbps. The data rate available for the port is  
Nx56, where N is a number between 1 and 24.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-3. Synchronous Data Port Options (2 of 7)  
Transmit Clock Source  
Possible Settings: Internal, External  
Default Setting: Internal  
Determines whether the transmitted data is clocked by the synchronous data port  
internal clock, or by the clock supplied by the DTE connected to the synchronous data  
port.  
Internal – The DCE clocks transmitted data, and uses the interchange circuit DB  
(CCITT 114) – Transmit Signal Element Timing (TXC) (DCE source) for timing the  
incoming transmitted data.  
External – The DTE externally provides the clock for the transmitted data, and the  
synchronous data port uses the interchange circuit DA (CCITT 113) – Transmit Signal  
Element Timing (XTXC) (DTE source) for timing the incoming transmitted data.  
NOTE: When external clock is used, it must be synchronized to the same clock  
source as the system.  
Invert Transmit Clock  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Determines whether the clock supplied by the DCE on interchange circuit DB  
(CCITT 114) – Transmit Signal Element Timing (DCE Source) TXC is phase inverted  
with respect to interchange circuit BA (CCITT 103) – Transmitted Data (TD). Use this  
configuration option when long cable lengths between the NAM and the DTE are  
causing data errors.  
Enable – Phase inverts the TXC clock on the DCE.  
Disable – Does not phase invert the TXC clock on the DCE.  
Invert Transmit and Received Data  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies whether the transmitted and received data for the synchronous data port is  
logically inverted before being transmitted or after being received from the network. Use  
this configuration option for applications where data is being transported using HDLC  
protocol, whereby inverting the data ensures that the ones density requirements for the  
network are met.  
Enable – Inverts the transmitted and received data for the port.  
Disable – Does not invert the transmitted and received data for the port.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-3. Synchronous Data Port Options (3 of 7)  
Send All Ones on Data Port Not Ready  
Possible Settings: Disable, DTR, RTS, Both  
Default Setting: Both  
Specifies the conditions on the synchronous data port that determine when valid data is  
not being sent from the DTE. When this condition is detected, all ones are sent to the  
network on the DS0 channels allocated to the port.  
Disable – Interchange circuits from the DTE are not monitored. Data sent from the DTE  
is always sent to the network for the port.  
DTR – Monitors DTE Ready (DTR) to determine when valid data is sent from the DTE.  
When DTR is off, all ones are sent to the network.  
H DTR does not appear if Port Type is set to X.21.  
RTS – Monitors Request to Send (RTS) to determine when valid data is sent from the  
DTE. When RTS is off, all ones are sent to the network.  
Both – Monitors both DTR and RTS to determine when valid data is sent from the DTE.  
If either DTR or RTS is off, all ones are sent to the network.  
H Both does not appear if Port Type is set to X.21.  
Action on Network Yellow Alarm  
Possible Settings: None, Halt  
Default Setting: Halt  
Specifies the action to take on the synchronous data port when a yellow alarm is  
received on the network interface. (A yellow alarm indicates a problem with the signal  
being transmitted to the network.)  
None – No action taken when a yellow alarm is received.  
Halt – Halts the transmission of data received on the synchronous data port and all  
ones are sent on circuit BB (ITU 104) – Receive Data (RD) and circuit CB (ITU 106) –  
Clear-to-Send (CTS) is deasserted to the port when a yellow alarm is received.  
Network Initiated Data Channel Loopback (DCLB)  
Possible Settings: Disable, V.54, FT1, Both  
Default Setting: Disable  
Allows the initiation and termination of the data channel loopback (V.54 loop 2) to be  
controlled by the receipt of a DCLB-actuate and DCLB-release sequence (either V.54,  
or FT1 [ANSI] compliant sequences) from the network or far end unit. When this  
configuration is enabled (V.54, FT1, or Both), receiving a DCLB-actuate sequence on a  
particular port causes the NAM to initiate a DCLB on that port (provided that a DCLB  
can be performed based on the current state of the port and NAM). Receiving a  
DCLB-release sequence terminates the DCLB.  
Disable – Ignores the DCLB-actuate and DCLB-release for the port.  
V.54 – DCLB-actuate and DCLB-release sequences that comply with the V.54 standard  
for “inter-DCE signaling for point-to-point circuits” are recognized and will control the  
initiation and termination of a DCLB (V.54 Loop 2) for the port.  
FT1 – DCLB-actuate and DCLB-release sequences that comply with either the  
ANSI.403, Annex B standard for “in-band signaling for fractional T1 (FT1) channel  
loopbacks” are recognized and will control the initiation and termination of a DCLB for  
the port.  
Both – DCLB-actuate and DCLB-release sequences that comply with either the ANSI  
or V.54 standard are recognized and will control the initiation and termination of a DCLB  
for the port.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-3. Synchronous Data Port Options (4 of 7)  
Port (DTE) Initiated Loopbacks  
Possible Settings: Disable, DTPLB, DCLB, Both  
Default Setting: Disable  
Allows the initiation and termination of a local Data Payload Loopback (DTPLB) or a  
remote Data Channel Loopback (DCLB) to be controlled by the DTE for the  
synchronous data port.  
Disable – The DTE attached to the port does not control the Local DTPLB and remote  
DCLBs.  
DTPLB – The DTE attached to the port may control the DTPLB for the port. The  
loopback is controlled by the interchange circuit LL (CCITT 141) – Local Loopback as  
specified by V.54. The port remains in DTPLB loopback as long as interchange circuit  
remains on.  
DCLB – The DTE attached to the port may control the DCLB for the connected remote  
port. The loopback is controlled by the interchange circuit RL (CCITT 140) – Remote  
Loopback as specified by V.54.  
NOTE: The remote equipment must support in-band V.54 loopback.  
Both – The DTE attached to the port may control both the local DTPLB and remote  
DCLBs.  
Embedded Data Link  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies whether the Embedded Data Link (EDL) is enabled for the synchronous data  
port. When the EDL is enabled, 8 kbps of the total bandwidth allocated for the port are  
not available to the synchronous data port. For example, if the port rate is 256 kbps  
(4 DS0 channels allocated) and the EDL is enabled, then only 248 kbps are available to  
the port. The EDL provides detection of frame synchronization, CRC of the data stream  
(excluding the 8 kbps EDL), and a 4 kbps inband data link between the local and remote  
units. The 4 kbps in-band data link can be used for performance report messages  
(PRMs) and as a management link for IP traffic.  
H EDL does not appear if Management Link is set to FDL.  
Enable – EDL is enabled for the port.  
NOTE: EDL must be enabled for both the local port and associated remote port.  
Disable – EDL is disabled for the port.  
EDL Management Link  
Possible Settings: Disable, Enable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies whether the EDL management link is enabled for IP traffic on the synchronous  
data port.  
H EDL Management Link does not appear if:  
– EDL is set to Disable.  
– Management Link is set to FDL.  
Enable – EDL management link is enabled for IP traffic flow over the 4 kbps in-band  
data link provided by the EDL.  
Disable – EDL management link is disabled for IP traffic.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-3. Synchronous Data Port Options (5 of 7)  
IP Address  
Possible Settings: 000.000.000.000 – 223.255.255.255, Clear  
Default Setting: 000.000.000.000  
Specifies the internet protocol address needed to access the EDL.  
H IP Address does not appear if EDL Management Link is set to Disable.  
000.000.000.000 – 223.255.255.255 – Enter the IP address for the EDL. The first digit  
(i.e., xxx.255.255.255) cannot be 0 or 127, or greater than 223. However,  
000.000.000.000 is valid, representing a null address.  
Clear – Clears the IP address and fills the address with zeros (i.e., 000.000.000.000).  
Subnet Mask  
Possible Settings: 000.000.000.000 – 255.255.255.255, Clear  
Default Setting: 000.000.000.000  
Specifies the subnet mask for the EDL.  
H Subnet Mask does not appear if EDL Management Link is set to Disable.  
000.000.000.000 – 255.255.255.255 – Enter the subnet mask for the EDL. Subnet Mask  
is based on the class of the IP address: Class A: 255.000.000.000,  
Class B: 255.255.000.000, or Class C: 255.255.255.000.  
Clear – Clears the subnet mask and fills the field with zeros (i.e., 000.000.000.000).  
Routing Information Protocol  
Possible Settings: None, Proprietary  
Default Setting: Proprietary  
Specifies which routing information protocol (RIP) is used to enable routing of  
management between devices.  
H Routing Information Protocol does not appear if:  
– EDL is set to Disable.  
– EDL Management Link is set to Disable.  
– Management Link is set to FDL.  
None – Does not use routing information protocol. Use this setting when the device at  
the other end of the management link cannot accept routing information.  
Proprietary – Uses a proprietary variant of RIP version 1 to communicate routing  
information between devices.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-3. Synchronous Data Port Options (6 of 7)  
Near-End Performance Statistics  
Possible Settings: Disable, Maintain, Send, Both  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies whether the T1 access unit maintains near-end performance statistics and  
sends Performance Report Messages (PRMs) for the synchronous data port.  
H Near-End Performance Statistics does not appear if:  
– EDL is set to Disable.  
– Management Link is set to FDL.  
NOTE: If the local T1 access unit is configured to send near-end performance  
statistics, then the remote T1 access unit must be configured to maintain  
far-end performance statistics.  
Disable – Does not maintain near-end performance statistics or send PRMs.  
Maintain – Maintain near-end performance statistics for the port.  
Send – Send PRMs over the port’s EDL every second. Each PRM contains the  
performance statistics for the previous 4 seconds.  
Both – Maintain near-end performance statistics and send PRMs over the port’s EDL.  
Far-End Performance Statistics  
Possible Settings: Disable, Maintain  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies whether the T1 access unit maintains far-end performance statistics and  
sends Performance Report Messages (PRMs) for the synchronous data port.  
H Far-End Performance Statistics does not appear if:  
– EDL is set to Disable.  
– Management Link is set to FDL.  
NOTE: If the local T1 access unit is configured to maintain far-end performance  
statistics, then the remote T1 access unit must be configured to send  
near-end performance statistics.  
Disable – Does not monitor the port’s EDL for PRMs or maintain far-end performance  
statistics.  
Maintain – Monitors the port’s EDL for PRMs and maintains far-end performance  
statistics.  
Out of Frame (OOF) Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Out of Frame (OOF). Specifies whether an alarm is generated when an out-of-frame  
condition is detected on the synchronous data port.  
H Out of Frame does not appear if:  
– Embedded Data Link is set to Disable.  
– Management Link is set to FDL on the Network Interface Options screen (see  
Table 5-1).  
Enable – Generates an alarm.  
Disable – Does not generate an alarm.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-3. Synchronous Data Port Options (7 of 7)  
Excessive Error Rate (EER) Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Specifies whether an alarm is generated when an excessive error rate condition is  
detected on the synchronous data port.  
H Excessive Error Rate does not appear if:  
– Embedded Data Link is set to Disable.  
– Management Link is set to FDL on the Network Interface Options screen (see  
Table 5-1).  
Enable – Generates an alarm.  
Disable – Does not generate an alarm.  
Excessive Error Rate Threshold  
Possible Settings: 10E-4, 10E-5, 10E-6, 10E-7, 10E-8, 10E-9  
Default Setting: 10E-4  
Sets the error rate threshold that determines when an excessive error rate (EER)  
condition is declared for a synchronous data port. The EER is determined by the ratio of  
the number of CRC5 errors to the total number of bits received over a set period of time.  
H Excessive Error Rate Threshold does not appear if:  
– Excessive Error Rate is set to Disable.  
– Embedded Data Link is set to Disable.  
– Management Link is set to FDL on the Network Interface Options screen (see  
Table 5-1).  
– Both Near-End and Far-End Performance Statistics are set to Disable.  
10E-4 – Declares an EER if more than 1,535 CRC5 errors are detected in a 10-second  
period. Clears when fewer than 1,536 CRC5 errors are detected within the same time  
period.  
10E-5 – Declares an EER if more than 921 CRC5 errors are detected in a 60-second  
–4  
period or a 10 condition occurs. Clears when fewer than 922 CRC5 errors are  
detected within the same time period.  
10E-6 – Declares an EER if more than 92 CRC5 errors are detected in a 60-second  
–5  
–4  
period or a 10 , or 10 condition occurs. Clears when fewer than 93 CRC5 errors are  
detected within the same time period.  
10E-7 – Declares an EER if more than 9 CRC5 errors are detected in a 60-second  
–6  
–5  
–4  
period or a 10 , 10 , or 10 condition occurs. Clears when fewer than 10 CRC5  
errors are detected within the same time period.  
10E-8 – Declares an EER if more than 41 CRC5 errors are detected in three 15-minute  
–7  
–6  
–5  
–4  
intervals or a 10 , 10 , 10 , or 10 condition occurs. Clears when fewer than  
42 CRC5 errors are detected within the same time period.  
10E-9 – Declares an EER if more than 4 CRC5 errors are detected in three 15-minute  
–8  
–7  
–6  
–5  
–4  
intervals or a 10 , 10 , 10 , 10 , or 10 condition occurs. Clears when fewer than  
5 CRC5 errors are detected within the same time period.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Configuring Voice Ports  
Use the E&M (Table 5-4), FXO (Table 5-5), and FXS (Table 5-6) Voice Options to  
configure the voice port on the voice APM in the selected slot.  
Configuration Edit/Display Voice Ports  
The Voice Port Options screen appears for Port 1 of the first slot containing a  
voice APM (either FXS, FXO or E&M). The displayed fields differ, depending on  
the type of voice APM in the selected slot.  
For E&M Voice Ports:  
Table 5-4. E&M Voice – Slot ss Port p Options (1 of 2)  
Port Status  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies whether the E&M voice port is in use, and can be configured and assigned to  
a time slot on the T1 or DSX-1 interface in order to transmit and receive voice frequency  
signals.  
H E&M Voice options do not appear if Port Status is set to Disable.  
Enable – The port is active, and can be configured and assigned to a timeslot.  
Disable – The port is not active, cannot be configured, and does not take up a time slot.  
H No alarms or traps configured for the port will be generated.  
H Existing cross-connect assignments associated with the port will be cleared. The  
message This action will clear any Cross Connections for the Port. Are You  
Sure? No appears. If you select:  
No – The operation is cancelled. (Pressing either the Esc or Ctrl-a key acts as a  
No.)  
Yes – Port status is disabled and any cross connections are cleared.  
Operating Mode  
Possible Settings: E&M, Transmit Only  
Default Setting: E&M  
Selects the operating mode for the E&M voice port.  
H Operating Mode only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
E&M – Enables normal earth and magnetic (E&M) mode.  
Transmit Only – Enables the mode used to support 4-wire private-line modems that do  
not require E&M signaling.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-4. E&M Voice – Slot ss Port p Options (2 of 2)  
Rx Gain (dB)  
Possible Settings: –17.0, –16.5, –16.0, –15.5, –15.0 ..., 0.0, ..., +6.5, +7.0, +7.5  
Default Setting: 0.0  
Determines the receive path analog signal amplification on the E&M voice port in  
decibels. This is the gain (increased signal level) or attenuation (decreased signal level)  
applied to the signal before it is presented to the user’s analog equipment.  
The range differs depending on the T1 NAM and E&M software revision, and the  
hardware revision. Go to Main Menu Status Identity System & NAM to view the  
revision levels.  
H Rx Gain (dB) only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
–17.0 to +7.5 – Increases or decreases the signal level. The more positive the number,  
the greater the signal level.  
Tx Attenuation (dB)  
Possible Settings: –17.0, –16.5, –16.0, –15.5, –15.0 ..., 0.0, ..., +6.5, +7.0, +7.5  
Default Setting: 0.0  
Determines the amount of attenuation, in dB, that the E&M voice receive port applies to  
the analog signal presented by the user’s analog equipment transmit port. Positive TX  
Attenuation settings reduce the level of the encoded analog signals sent towards the  
telephone network, and negative settings will introduce gain. The proper setting of this  
strap is crucial to ensuring compliance with Part 68, FCC Rules and Industry Canada’s  
CS-03 Specification.  
The range differs depending on the T1 NAM and E&M software revision, and the  
hardware revision. Go to Main Menu Status Identity System & NAM to view the  
revision levels.  
H Tx Attenuation (dB) only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
–17.0 to +7.5 – Increases or decreases the signal level. The more positive the number,  
the greater the signal level.  
Trunk Cond in CGA  
Possible Settings: Busy, Idle  
Default Setting: Busy  
Determines the trunk condition or state that the port is forced into as a result of the  
Carrier Group Alarm (CGA).  
H Trunk Cond in CGA only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
Busy – Forces the port to Busy during a CGA.  
Idle – Forces the port to Idle during a CGA.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
For FXO Voice Ports:  
Table 5-5. FXO Voice – Slot ss Port p Options (1 of 3)  
Port Status  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies whether the FXO voice port is in use, and can be configured and assigned to  
a time slot on the T1 or DSX interface in order to transmit and receive voice frequency  
signals.  
H FXO Voice options do not appear if Port Status is set to Disable.  
Enable – The port is active, and can be configured and assigned to a timeslot.  
Disable – The port is not active, cannot be configured, and does not take up a time slot.  
H No alarms or traps configured for the port will be generated.  
H Existing cross-connect assignments associated with the port will be cleared. The  
message This action will clear any Cross Connections for the Port. Are You  
Sure? No appears. If you select:  
No – The operation is cancelled. (Pressing either the Esc or Ctrl-a key acts as a  
No.)  
Yes – Port status is disabled and any cross connections are cleared.  
Operating Mode  
Possible Settings: FXO, FXODN, FXODN/WINK, DPT  
Default Setting: FXO  
Selects the operating mode for the FXO voice port.  
H Operating Mode only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
FXO – Enables the Foreign Exchange Office (FXO) mode, supporting a bidirectional  
connection to a PBX phone line. This mode uses 4-state signaling (A&B).  
FXODN – Enables Foreign Exchange Office Software-Defined Network (FXODN) mode  
for operation on software-defined networks. This mode is used by Class 4 switches and  
uses 2-state signaling (A=B).  
FXODN/WINK – Enables the mode FXODN with WINK which is similar to FXODN, but  
in addition provides an indication toward the network interface when the attached  
analog equipment is ready to receive signaling information. This consists of detecting an  
off-hook signal from the network interface, which initiates a configurable “wink delay”  
followed by a configurable off-hook signal back to the network interface.  
DPT – The Dial Pulse Terminating (DPT) mode is similar to FXO, except for supporting  
in-coming, one-way trunks to a PBX (direct inward dialing) or key system.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-5. FXO Voice – Slot ss Port p Options (2 of 3)  
Signaling Type  
Possible Settings: Loop-Start, Loop-Start/Fwd Disc, Ground-Start  
Default Setting: Loop-Start  
Determines the type of signaling for the FXO voice port.  
H Signaling Type only appears if:  
– Port Status is set to Enable.  
– Operating Mode is not set to DPT.  
Loop-Start – Enables the signaling used for basic telephone service stations, simple  
PBX trunks, or key systems.  
Loop-Start/Fwd Disc – Enables the signaling used for automated answering  
equipment.  
Ground-Start – Enables the signaling used for two-way PBX trunks. Helps to prevent  
“glaring”, i.e., call collision.  
Terminating Impedance (ohms)  
Possible Settings: 600, 900  
Default Setting: 600  
Determines the terminating impedance (in ohms) for the port.  
H Terminating Impedance only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
600 – The terminating impedance is 600 ohms.  
900 – The terminating impedance is 900 ohms.  
Wink Delay (10 ms)  
Possible Settings: 1 – 99  
Default Setting: 15  
Determines the amount of delay before the wink signal is generated towards the  
network, and when an off-hook signal from the CO is detected in increments of  
10 milliseconds.  
H Wink Delay only appears if:  
– Port Status is set to Enable.  
– Operating Mode is set to FXODN/WINK or DPT.  
10 to 990 – The valid range is from 10 to 990 ms, in 10 ms increments. The settings are  
numbers between 1 and 99, representing such increments. The default is 15, for a wink  
delay of 150 ms.  
Wink Duration (10 ms)  
Possible Settings: 1 – 99  
Default Setting: 20  
Determines the duration of the wink signal generated towards the network when an  
off-hook signal for the CO is detected and after the wink delay has elapsed in  
increments of 10 milliseconds.  
H Wink Duration only appears if:  
– Port Status is set to Enable.  
– Operating Mode is set to FXODN/WINK or DPT.  
10 to 990 ms – The valid range is from 10 to 990 ms, in 10 ms increments. The settings  
are numbers between 1 and 99, representing such increments. The default is 20, for a  
wink duration of 200 ms.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-5. FXO Voice – Slot ss Port p Options (3 of 3)  
Rx Gain (dB)  
Possible Settings: –10.00, –9.5, –9.0, –8.5, ..., 0.0, +0.5, +1.0, +1.5, +2.0  
Default Setting: 0.0  
Determines the receive path analog signal amplification, or gain, on the FXO voice port  
in decibels. This is the gain (increased signal level) or attenuation (decreased signal  
level) applied to the signal.  
H Rx Gain (dB) only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
–10.00 to +2.0 – Increases or decreases the signal level. The more positive the  
number, the greater the signal level.  
Tx Attenuation (dB)  
Possible Settings: –10.00, –9.5, –9.0, –8.5, ..., 0.0, ..., +4.0, +4.5, +5.0  
Default Setting: 0.0  
Determines the amount of attenuation, in dB, that the FXO voice port applies to the  
analog signal presented by the user’s analog equipment. Positive TX Attenuation  
settings reduce the level of the encoded analog signals sent towards the telephone  
network and negative settings introduce gain. When connecting permissive mode  
modems and fax machines, a setting of +3 dB should result in a compliant, encoded  
analog of less than –12 dBm. The proper setting of this strap is crucial to ensuring  
compliance with Part 68, FCC Rules and Industry Canada’s CS-03 Specification.  
H Tx Attenuation (dB) only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
–10.00 to +5.0 – Increases or decreases the signal level. The more negative the  
number, the greater the signal level (opposite of Rx Gain settings).  
Trunk Cond in CGA  
Possible Settings: Busy, Idle  
Default Setting: Busy  
Determines the trunk condition or state that the port is forced into as a result of the  
Carrier Group Alarm (CGA).  
H Trunk Cond in CGA only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
Busy – Forces the port to Busy during the Carrier Group Alarm.  
Idle – Forces the port to Idle during the Carrier Group Alarm.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
For FXS Voice Ports:  
Table 5-6. FXS Voice – Slot ss Port p Options (1 of 4)  
Port Status  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies whether the FXS voice port is in use, and can be configured and assigned to a  
time slot on the T1 or DSX-1 interface in order to transmit and receive voice frequency  
signals.  
H FXS Voice options do not appear if Port Status is set to Disable.  
Enable – The port is active, and can be configured and assigned to a timeslot.  
Disable – The port is not active, cannot be configured, and does not take up a time slot.  
H No alarms or traps configured for the port will be generated.  
H Existing cross-connect assignments associated with the port will be cleared. The  
message This action will clear any Cross Connections for the Port. Are You  
Sure? No appears. If you select:  
No – The operation is cancelled. (Pressing either the Esc or Ctrl-a key acts as a  
No.)  
Yes – Port status is disabled and any cross connections are cleared.  
Operating Mode  
Possible Settings: FXS, FXSDN, FXSDN/WINK, PLAR, DPO  
Default Setting: FXS  
Selects the operating mode for the FXS voice port.  
H Operating Mode only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
FXS – Enables the Foreign Exchange Station (FXS) mode, supporting a bidirectional  
connection to a telephone device, PBX, or key system trunk. This mode uses 4-state  
signaling (A&B).  
FXSDN – Enables Foreign Exchange Station Software-Defined Network (FXSDN)  
mode for operation on software-defined networks. This mode is used by Class 4  
switches and uses 2-state signaling (A=B).  
FXSDN/WINK – Enables the mode FXSDN with WINK which is similar to FXSDN, but in  
addition provides an indication to the central office (CO) when the station equipment is  
ready to receive signaling information. This consists of detecting an off-hook signal from  
the CO, which initiates a configurable “wink delay” followed by a configurable off-hook  
signal back to the CO.  
PLAR – Private Line Automatic Ring-down (PLAR) allows “hotline” point-to-point  
dedicated connection of two phones. When one phone goes off-hook, the other phone  
starts ringing.  
DPO – The Dial Pulse Originating (DPO) mode is similar to FXS, except for supporting  
out-going, one-way trunks from a PBX (direct outward dialing) or key system, or station  
instrument. No ringing is provided in this mode.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-6. FXS Voice – Slot ss Port p Options (2 of 4)  
Signaling Type  
Possible Settings: Loop-Start, Loop-Start/Fwd Disc, Ground-Start,  
Ground-Start-Immediate, Ground-Start-Automatic, d3, d4  
Default Setting: Loop-Start  
Determines the type of signaling for the FXS voice port.  
H Signaling Type only appears if:  
– Port Status is set to Enable.  
– Operating Mode is not set to DPO.  
Loop-Start – Enables the signaling used for basic telephone service stations, simple  
PBX trunks, or key systems. Loop Start only appears if Operating Mode is set to FXS,  
FXSDN, or FXSDN/WINK.  
Loop-Start/Fwd Disc – Enables the signaling used for automated answering  
equipment. This selection only appears if Operating Mode is set to FXS, FXSDN, or  
FXSDN/WINK.  
Ground-Start – Enables the signaling used for two-way PBX trunks. Helps to prevent  
“glaring”, i.e., call collision. This selection only appears if Operating Mode is set to FXS,  
FXSDN, or FXSDN/WINK.  
Ground-Start-Immediate – Enables the signaling used for fast response time to the  
PBX or station. This selection only appears if Operating Mode is set to FXS.  
Ground-Start-Automatic – Enables the signaling used for fast response time to the  
central office. This selection only appears if Operating Mode is set to FXS.  
d3 – The APM meets the pre-1988 specifications for PLAR circuits. This selection only  
appears if Operating Mode is set to PLAR.  
d4 – The APM meets the post-1988 specifications for PLAR circuits. This selection only  
appears if Operating Mode is set to PLAR.  
Terminating Impedance (ohms)  
Possible Settings: 600, 900  
Default Setting: 600  
Determines the terminating impedance (in ohms) for the port.  
H Terminating Impedance only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
600 – The terminating impedance is 600 ohms.  
900 – The terminating impedance is 900 ohms.  
Wink Delay (10 ms)  
Possible Settings: 1 – 99  
Default Setting: 15  
Determines the amount of delay before the wink signal is generated towards the  
network, and when an off-hook signal from the CO is detected in increments of  
10 milliseconds.  
H Wink Delay only appears if:  
– Port Status is set to Enable.  
– Operating Mode is set to FXSDN/WINK.  
10 to 990 – The valid range is from 10 to 990 ms, in 10 ms increments. The settings are  
numbers between 1 and 99, representing such increments. The default is 15, for a wink  
delay of 150 ms.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-6. FXS Voice – Slot ss Port p Options (3 of 4)  
Wink Duration (10 ms)  
Possible Settings: 1 – 99  
Default Setting: 20  
Determines the duration of the wink signal generated towards the network when an  
off-hook signal for the CO is detected and after the wink delay has elapsed in  
increments of 10 milliseconds.  
H Wink Duration only appears if:  
– Port Status is set to Enable.  
– Operating Mode is set to FXSDN/WINK.  
10 to 990 ms – The valid range is from 10 to 990 ms, in 10 ms increments. The settings  
are numbers between 1 and 99, representing such increments. The default is 20, for a  
wink duration of 200 ms.  
Rx Gain (dB)  
Possible Settings: –10.00, –9.5, –9.0, –8.5, ..., 0.0, +0.5, +1.0, +1.5, +2.0  
Default Setting: 0.0  
Determines the receive path analog signal amplification, or gain, on the FXS voice port  
in decibels. This is the gain (increased signal level) or attenuation (decreased signal  
level) applied to the signal.  
H Rx Gain (dB) only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
–10.00 to +2.0 – Increases or decreases the signal level. The more positive the  
number, the greater the signal level.  
Tx Attenuation (dB)  
Possible Settings: –10.00, –9.5, –9.0, –8.5, ..., 0.0, ..., +4.0, +4.5, +5.0  
Default Setting: 0.0  
Determines the amount of attenuation, in dB, that the FXS voice port applies to the  
analog signal presented by the user’s analog equipment. Positive TX Attenuation  
settings reduce the level of the encoded analog signals sent towards the telephone  
network and negative settings introduce gain. When connecting permissive mode  
modems and fax machines, a setting of +3 dB should result in a compliant, encoded  
analog of less than –12 dBm. The proper setting of this strap is crucial to ensuring  
compliance with Part 68, FCC Rules and Industry Canada’s CS-03 Specification.  
H Tx Attenuation (dB) only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
–10.00 to +5.0 – Increases or decreases the signal level. The more negative the  
number, the greater the signal level (opposite of Rx Gain settings).  
Ring-Back Tone  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Allows generation of an audible tone toward the network in response to an incoming call  
request, normally referred to as a ring-back. This feature is invoked only when the  
central office (CO) does not provide it, as with a Class 4 ESS switch. This tone indicates  
to the calling party that the called line has been reached and ringing has started. Use  
the ring-back tone when you have a PLAR application.  
H Ring-Back Tone only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
Enable – Generates a ring-back tone toward the network in response to an incoming  
call request.  
Disable – Does not generate a ring-back tone toward the network in response to an  
incoming call request.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-6. FXS Voice – Slot ss Port p Options (4 of 4)  
Trunk Cond in CGA  
Possible Settings: Busy, Idle  
Default Setting: Busy  
Determines the trunk condition or state that the port is forced into as a result of the  
Carrier Group Alarm (CGA).  
H Trunk Cond in CGA only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
Busy – Forces the port to Busy during the Carrier Group Alarm.  
Idle – Forces the port to Idle during the Carrier Group Alarm.  
Configuring OCU-DP Ports  
Use the OCU-DP Options (Table 5-7) to configure the ports (either two or six) on  
the OCU-DP APM in the selected slot.  
Configuration Edit/Display OCU-DP Ports  
The OCU-DP Options screen appears for Port 1 of the first slot containing an  
OCU-DP APM.  
Table 5-7. OCU-DP Options – Slot ss Port p Options (1 of 3)  
Port Status  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies whether the OCU-DP port is in use, and can be configured and used to  
transmit and receive data.  
H OCU-DP options do not appear if Port Status is set to Disable.  
Enable – The port is active, and can be configured used to  
Disable – The port is not active, cannot be configured, and cannot transmit/receive  
data.  
H No alarms or traps configured for the port will be generated.  
H Existing cross-connect assignments associated with the port will be cleared. The  
message This action will clear any Cross Connections for the Port. Are You  
Sure? No appears. If you select:  
No – The operation is cancelled. (Pressing either the Esc or Ctrl-a key acts as a  
No.)  
Yes – Port status is disabled and any cross connections are cleared.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-7. OCU-DP Options – Slot ss Port p Options (2 of 3)  
Port Rate  
Possible Settings: 56K, 64KCC, Switched_56  
Default Setting: 56K  
Selects the rate for the port.  
H Port Rate only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
56K – The setting for 56 kbps.  
64KCC – The setting for 64 kbps Clear Channel.  
Switched_56 – The rate for 4-wire Switched 56.  
Loopback Detection  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Determines whether the the T1 access unit will detect loopback activation codes coming  
from the network.  
H Loopback Detection only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
Enable – Loopback code detection is enabled.  
Disable – Loopback code detection is disabled.  
Loss of Signal Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Determines whether an ASCII alarm will be generated when a Loss of Signal condition  
is detected.  
H Loss of Signal Alarm only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
Enable – An alarm is generated when a Loss of Signal condition is detected on the  
interface.  
Disable – Alarms are not generated for a Loss of Signal condition.  
Abnormal Station Code Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Determines whether an ASCII alarm will be generated when an Abnormal Station code  
is received from the network.  
H Abnormal Station Code Alarm only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
Enable – An alarm is generated when an Abnormal Station Code is received from the  
network.  
Disable – Alarms are not generated when an Abnormal Station Code is received.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-7. OCU-DP Options – Slot ss Port p Options (3 of 3)  
64KCC Loop OOF Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Determines whether an ASCII alarm will be generated when a 64KCC Loop Out of  
Frame (OOF) condition is detected.  
H A 64KCC Loop Out of Frame (OOF) Alarm only appears if Port Status is set to  
Enable.  
Enable – An alarm is generated when a 64KCC Loop Out of Frame condition is  
detected on the interface.  
Disable – Alarms are not generated for a 64KCC Loop Out of Frame condition.  
DDS Network Failure Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Determines whether an ASCII alarm will be generated when a DDS Network Failure  
code is received from the network.  
H DDS Network Failure Alarm only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
Enable – An alarm is generated when a DDS Network Failure code is received from the  
network.  
Disable – Alarms are not generated for a DDS Network Failure.  
Loss of Loop Timing Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Determines whether an ASCII alarm will be generated when a Loss of Loop Timing  
condition is received from the network.  
H Loss of Loop Timing Alarm only appears if Port Status is set to Enable.  
Enable – An alarm is generated when a Loss of Loop Timing condition is detected on  
the interface.  
Disable – Alarms are not generated for a Loss of Loop Timing condition.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Copying Port Configurations  
Copy Ports provides an easy way to configure similar ports. Only enabled ports  
may be copied. They may be copied to either enabled or disabled ports.  
" Procedure  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Configuration Edit/Display Copy Ports  
2. The Copy Ports screen appears. Select the desired slot number to copy  
configuration options from. Upon entering the screen, the slot number of the  
T1 NAM is displayed. Use the spacebar to cycle through the slots. You can  
also type in the desired slot number.  
3. Select the desired port number to copy configuration options from. Use the  
spacebar to cycle through the ports available on the card in the selected slot.  
Only slots matching the type shown in the From: field are displayed. You can  
also type in the desired slot number.  
4. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 to select the slot and port to copy configuration options  
to.  
5. Press Enter to begin the copy process.  
If the . . .  
Then the . . .  
Copy To slot and Copy To port Copy To slot and port configuration options are  
are set to a specific slot and  
port number  
replaced by the Copy From slot and port  
configurations options.  
Copy To slot is set to a  
Configuration options of all ports on the Copy To  
specific number and the Copy slot are replaced by the Copy From slot and port  
To port is set to All  
configuration options.  
Copy To slot is set to All the  
Copy To port is set to a  
specific number  
Configuration options of the Copy To port of all  
slots containing the same type of port (Voice E&M,  
Voice FXO, Voice FXS, Sync Data, or OCU-DP) as  
on the Copy From slot are replaced by the Copy  
From slot and port configuration options.  
Copy To slot and the Copy To Configuration options of all ports of all slots  
port are both set to All  
containing the same type of port (Voice E&M, Voice  
FXS, Sync Data, or OCU-DP) as on the Copy From  
slot are replaced by the Copy From slot and port  
configuration options.  
6. Select Perform Copy Then Increment if you want to automatically change  
the values to the next higher port of the same type. If the last port of the  
highest slot was specified, the value will change to Port 1 of the lowest slot  
containing the same port type.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Assigning Cross Connections  
The system allows you to assign data paths between the various interfaces to  
share the T1 network. Assuming that both the Network and DSX-1 interfaces are  
enabled and that at least one voice port APM is installed, you can make the  
following cross connections:  
H
H
H
H
Assign DSX-1 time slots to the Network interface  
Assign Network 2 interface timeslots to the Network 1 interface  
Assign voice ports to DSX-1 or Network interface timeslots  
Assign Sync Data ports to DSX-1 or Network interface timeslots, or to  
another Sync Data port  
H
Assign OCU-DP data ports to DSX-1 or Network interface timeslots  
You can also clear cross-connection assignments.  
NOTE:  
Although it is not required, it is suggested that you progress through each  
screen in order, from top to bottom.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
The following figures illustrate various cross-connection assignments.  
T1  
Access Mux  
Sync Data  
Port  
Network T1 Interface  
DSX-1  
98-15983  
Assigning Sync Data Ports to Network Interface Timeslots  
T1  
Access Mux  
Sync Data  
Port  
Network T1 Interface  
DSX-1  
98-15984  
Assigning Sync Data Ports to DSX-1 or Network Interface Timeslots  
(9161 Single T1 NAM Only)  
T1  
Access Mux  
24 DS0s with 9161 Single T1 NAM  
16 DS0s with 9261 Dual TI NAM  
Sync Data  
Port  
Sync Data  
Port  
Network T1 Interface  
DSX-1  
98-15985  
Assigning Sync Data Ports to DSX-1 Timeslots or to Another Sync Data Port  
Use the worksheets in Appendix A and the following procedures to assign cross  
connections.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up  
Example Channel Allocation  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Assigning DSX-1 Timeslots to the Network Interface  
DSX-1 timeslots are assigned by channel allocation, where you specify individual  
timeslots. The DSX-1 interface must be enabled to assign DSX-1 timeslots to the  
Network interface.  
Value  
Meaning  
Nxx  
The lower field represents timeslot xx of the selected Network  
interface.  
Assigned  
The timeslot is already assigned to something other than a DSX-1  
timeslot, so it is unavailable. Assigned timeslots cannot be modified  
from this screen.  
Available  
Dss-p/yy  
The timeslot is currently unassigned.  
Timeslot yy of DSX-1 interface p in slot ss is assigned to the  
Network timeslot identified right above it (Nxx).  
Timeslot assignment rules:  
H
H
H
Valid Network timeslots are either labeled as Available, or contain a DSX-1  
timeslot assignment  
Valid DSX-1 timeslots are those that are unassigned, and the currently  
assigned timeslot  
Order of display is as follows:  
Available is the first selection  
— Then, from lowest DSX-1 interface to the highest DSX-1 interface  
— Then lowest available timeslot number to the highest available timeslot  
number  
For example, if the cursor is on a field with the Available value under assigned  
timeslot Nxx, pressing the Spacebar causes this field’s values to cycle through all  
valid DSX-1 timeslots, starting with Dss-p/yy, assuming it is unassigned. If  
Dss-p/yy is already assigned, the next valid timeslot in the order described above  
is displayed.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
" Procedure  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Configuration Edit/Display Cross Connect DSX-1 to Network  
Assignments  
2. The DSX-1 to Network Assignments screen appears. This screen contains a  
matrix of the current cross-connect status of all time slots on the Network  
interface.  
3. If you are using the 9261 Dual T1 NAM, you must choose which Network  
interface to use. Enter 1 or 2 in the NETWORK field.  
4. Move the cursor to the next editable timeslot (underlined). Use the spacebar  
or type in the desired timeslot to display the desired timeslot assignment.  
5. Repeat Step 3 until all desired timeslots are assigned. Select Save to save  
the assignments, or press ESC to save and return to the Cross Connect  
menu.  
DSX-1 Signaling Assignments and Trunk Conditioning  
The second page of the DSX-1 to Network 1/2 Assignments screen enables you  
to define the signaling assignments and trunk conditioning for each timeslot on  
the DSX-1 interface. You can specify whether robbed bit signaling information is  
being passed within a given DS0, and the value of the signaling bits that will be  
transmitted for that DS0 to the other cross-connected T1 interface if a Carrier  
Group Alarm (CGA) occurs on a T1 interface.  
Only those DSX-1-to-Network assignments from page 1 are displayed on this  
page, from left to right and top to bottom in ascending order, by network and  
timeslot.  
When a CGA condition (LOS, OOF or AIS) is declared for a T1 interface, the  
signaling bits being transmitted to the other T1 interface for the DS0 are forced to  
idle for two seconds (except for user-defined patterns which are transmitted  
immediately). This drops any call in progress. The signaling bits are then forced  
to the selected state (Busy or Idle), and remain in this state until the CGA  
condition clears. At this point, the received signaling bits from the T1 interface  
which formerly had the CGA condition are passed through to the other T1  
interface.  
NOTE:  
Trunk conditioning will only occur on DS0s that are cross-connected to  
another T1 interface. All other DS0s remain unaffected by trunk conditioning.  
Enter one of the values shown in Table 5-8 in each of the fields on both the  
Network side and the DSX-1 side. Although you can choose any value for the  
DSX-1 side, the default value displayed is based on a typical setting that would  
be used with the corresponding Network side value. Typical pairs of values are  
shown in the table below. If you change the setting of None to anything else, the  
DSX side value is changed to the corresponding default value.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-8. Signaling and Trunk Conditioning Values (1 of 2)  
Network  
DSX-1 Side  
Default  
Value  
Meaning  
Side Value  
None  
No signaling used on this DS0. Use this setting if there is  
no voice signaling information being passed on this DS0  
(clear channel).  
None  
RBS  
(default)  
Robbed Bit Signaling is used on this DS0, but no trunk  
conditioning. Signaling bits will be passed to the T1  
interface to which this DS0 is cross-connected when this  
T1 interface is not in CGA, but the signaling bits will be all  
ones when CGA is present.  
RBS  
The following values will configure the cross-connect for RBS, as well as perform the  
trunk conditioning indicated when a CGA condition occurs. Although the ABCD signaling  
bits for each setting are described, only AB bits are transmitted when the  
cross-connected T1 interface is using D4 framing.  
E&M-idle  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the idle state for an E&M  
interface (ABCD = 0000).  
E&M idle  
E&M-busy  
FXOg-idle  
FXOg-busy  
FXOl-idle  
FXOl-busy  
FXSg-idle  
FXSg-busy  
FXSl-idle  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the busy state for an  
E&M interface (ABCD = 1111).  
E&M busy  
FXSg-idle  
FXSg-busy  
FXSl-idle  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the idle state for an FXO  
Ground-Start interface (ABCD = 1111).  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the busy state for an  
FXO Ground-Start interface (ABCD = 0101).  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the idle state for an FXO  
Loop-Start interface (ABCD = 0101).  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the busy state for an  
FXO Loop-Start interface (ABCD = 0101).  
FXSl-busy  
FXOg-idle  
FXOg-busy  
FXOl-idle  
FXOl-busy  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the idle state for an FXS  
Ground-Start interface (ABCD = 0101).  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the busy state for an  
FXS Ground-Start interface (ABCD = 1111).  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the idle state for an FXS  
Loop-Start interface (ABCD = 0101).  
FXSl-busy  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the busy state for an  
FXS Loop-Start interface (ABCD = 1111).  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up  
Table 5-8. Signaling and Trunk Conditioning Values (2 of 2)  
Network  
DSX-1 Side  
Default  
Value  
Meaning  
Side Value  
FXOD-idle  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the idle state for an  
FXODN interface (ABCD = 0000).  
FXSD-idle  
FXSD-busy  
FXOD-idle  
FXOD-busy  
PLAR3idle  
PLAR3busy  
PLAR4idle  
PLAR4busy  
DPT-idle  
FXOD-busy The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the busy state for an  
FXODN interface (ABCD = 1111).  
FXSD-idle  
FXSD-busy  
PLAR3idle  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the idle state for an  
FXSDN interface (ABCD = 0000).  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the busy state for an  
FXSDN interface (ABCD = 1111).  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the idle state for a PLAR  
D3 interface (ABCD = 0000).  
PLAR3busy The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the busy state for an  
PLAR D3 interface (ABCD = 1111).  
PLAR4idle  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the idle state for a PLAR  
D4 interface (ABCD = 1111).  
PLAR4busy The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the busy state for an  
PLAR D4 interface (ABCD = 0000).  
DPO-idle  
DPO-busy  
DPT-idle  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the idle state for a DPO  
interface (ABCD = 0000).  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the busy state for a DPO  
interface (ABCD = 1111).  
DPT-busy  
DPO-idle  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the idle state for a DPT  
interface (ABCD = 0000).  
DPT-busy  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent the busy state for a DPT  
interface (ABCD = 1111).  
DPO-busy  
1
USER-xxxx  
The signaling bits transmitted to the cross-connected T1  
interface during a CGA represent a user-defined pattern of  
ABCD = xxxx.  
USER-xxxx  
1
xxxx is the same value on both the Network and the DSX-1 sides.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up  
Assigning Network 2 Timeslots to Network 1 Interface Timeslots  
If you are using a 9261 Dual T1 NAM, you can assign Network 2 interface  
timeslots to Network 1 interface timeslots.  
" Procedure  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Configuration Edit/Display Cross Connect Network to Network  
Assignments  
2. The Network to Network Assignments screen appears. This screen contains  
a matrix of the current cross-connect status of all time slots on the Network 1  
interface.  
3. Move the cursor to the next editable timeslot (underlined). Use the spacebar  
or type in the desired timeslot to display the desired timeslot assignment.  
4. Repeat Step 3 until all desired timeslots are assigned. Select Save to save  
the assignments, or press ESC to save and return to the Cross Connect  
menu.  
Network to Network Signaling Assignments and Trunk Conditioning  
The second page of the Network to Network Assignments screen enables you to  
define the signaling assignments and trunk conditioning for each timeslot on the  
Network 1 interface.  
Only those Network-to-Network assignments from page 1 are displayed on this  
page, from left to right and top to bottom in ascending order, by network timeslot.  
See DSX-1 Signaling Assignments and Trunk Conditioning on page 5-40 for more  
information.  
Enter one of the values shown in Table 5-8 in each of the fields on both the  
Network 1 side and the Network 2 side. Although you can choose any value for  
the Network 2 side (except None), the default value displayed is based on a  
typical setting that would be used with the corresponding Network 1 side value.  
Typical pairs of values are shown in Table 5-8, with the Network 1 side on the left  
side of the table and the Network 2 side on the right side of the table. If you  
change the setting of None to anything else, the Network 2 side value is changed  
to the corresponding default value.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Assigning Voice Ports to DSX-1 or Network Interface Timeslots  
Use the Voice Port Assignments screen to view the status of all DS0 assignments  
on the Network or DSX-1 interface. You can also use this screen to assign voice  
ports to selected timeslots.  
NOTE:  
You can assign voice ports to the DSX-1 interface on the 9161 Single T1  
NAM. Voice port assignments on the Dual DSX APM are not supported.  
" Procedure  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Configuration Edit/Display Cross Connect Voice Port Assignment  
2. The Cross Connect menu appears. Select Voice Port Assignment and press  
Return. The Voice Port Assignments screen appears.  
3. Enter Net1, Net2, or DSX01-1 into the Assign To field to assign voice ports to  
the Network 1, Network 2, or DSX-1 interface, respectively.  
4. Move the cursor to the next editable timeslot (underlined). Use the spacebar  
or type in the desired slot and port. Repeat this step until all desired timeslots  
are assigned.  
5. Select Save to save the assignments, or press ESC to save and return to the  
Cross Connect menu.  
Assigning Sync Data Ports  
Use the Sync Data Port Assignments screen to view the status of  
H
H
H
All DS0 assignments on the Network interface  
All DS0 assignments on the DSX-1 interface  
A port-to-port assignment  
You can also use this screen to assign synchronous data ports to  
H
H
Network interface timeslots  
DSX-1 interface timeslots  
NOTE:  
You can assign sync data ports to the DSX-1 interface on the 9161 Single  
T1 NAM. Sync data port assignments on the Dual DSX APM are not  
supported.  
H
Another synchronous data port  
NOTE:  
Only one port-to-port assignment is allowed, with a maximum of 24 DS0s  
for 9161 Single T1 NAM, 16 DS0s for 9261 Dual T1 NAM.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
" Procedure  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Configuration Edit/Display Cross Connect Sync Data Port  
Assignment  
2. The Sync Data Port Assignments screen appears. Enter one of the following  
into the Assign To field:  
If you want to assign to . . .  
Then enter . . .  
Net1 or Net2  
DSX01-1  
Network interface timeslots  
DSX-1 interface timeslots on the 9161  
Single T1 NAM  
Another Sync Data port  
Port  
3. Enter the number of DS0s to allocate.  
4. Enter one of the following into the Assign By field:  
Enter . . .  
To . . .  
Channel  
Assign ports individually. However, a Sync Data port can be  
assigned to multiple timeslots which do not have to be  
contiguous. As you assign multiple timeslots to a port, the data  
port rate increases by the Port Base Rate defined on the  
Synchronous Data Port Options screen (see Configuring Sync  
Data Ports on page 5-16).  
Block  
Assign a block of contiguous channels by specifying the number  
of DS0s. The number of DS0s is limited to the largest  
contiguous block of timeslots, and only starting timeslots that  
have enough contiguous timeslots following will be selectable.  
ACAMI  
Assign a block of contiguous channels as in the Block method,  
except that the number of channels assigned is twice the  
number of DS0s to allocate. Every other timeslot is filled with all  
ones to maintain ones density on the interface.  
5. Move the cursor to the next editable timeslot (underlined). Use the spacebar  
or type in the desired slot and port. Repeat this step until all desired timeslots  
are assigned.  
6. Select Save to save the assignments, or press ESC to save and return to the  
Cross Connect menu.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up  
Assigning OCU-DP Data Ports  
Use the OCU-DP Port Assignments screen to view the status of:  
H
H
All DS0 assignments on the Network interface  
All DS0 assignments on the DSX-1 interface  
You can also use this screen to assign OCU-DP data ports to:  
H
H
Network interface timeslots  
DSX-1 interface timeslots  
NOTES:  
You can assign OCU-DP ports to the DSX-1 interface on the 9161 Single  
T1 NAM. OCU-DP port assignments on the Dual DSX APM are not  
supported.  
" Procedure  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Configuration Edit/Display Cross Connect OCU-DP Port Assignment  
2. The OCU-DP Port Assignments screen appears. Enter one of the following  
into the Assign To field:  
If you want to assign to . . .  
Then enter . . .  
Net1 or Net2  
DSX01-1  
Network interface timeslots  
DSX-1 interface timeslots on the 9161  
Single T1 NAM  
3. Move the cursor to the next editable timeslot (underlined). Use the spacebar  
or type in the desired slot and port. Repeat this step until all desired timeslots  
are assigned.  
4. Select Save to save the assignments, or press ESC to save and return to the  
Cross Connect menu.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Clearing Port Assignments  
Clearing port assignments sets the selected timeslots to unassigned. You can  
clear all port assignments for:  
H
H
H
This device  
A specified slot  
A specified interface  
" Procedure  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Configuration Edit/Display Cross Connect Clear Assignments  
2. Select one of the following:  
To clear . . .  
Then select . . .  
All assignments for the DSX-1 time slots, Clear All  
Network time slots, voice ports, and  
Sync Data ports  
All assignments for the Network 1  
Interface time slots  
Clear Network 1 Interface Time Slots  
All assignments for the Network 2  
Interface time slots  
Clear Network 2 Interface Time Slots  
Clear DSX01-1 Time Slots  
All assignments for the DSX01-1 time  
slots on a 9161 Single T1 NAM  
Assignments for the synchronous data  
ports on the NAM in slot ss  
Clear Slot ss – NAM Sync Data Ports  
Clear DSXss-1 Interface Time Slots  
Clear DSXss-2 Interface Time Slots  
All assignments for the DSX-1  
interface 1 time slots in slot ss  
All assignments for the DSX-1  
interface 2 time slots in slot ss  
Assignments for timeslots or ports on the Clear Slot ss xxxxx  
APM in slot ss  
where xxxxx = name or type of APM  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Setting System Options  
Use the System Options screen (see Table 5-9) to set the:  
H
H
H
H
Generation of yellow alarm signals  
User-initiated test timeout  
Clock Source (primary, secondary, external clock rate)  
Generation of primary/secondary clock failure ASCII alarm messages  
Use the following menu selection sequence:  
Configuration Edit/Display System Options  
Table 5-9. System Options (1 of 4)  
Generate Yellow Alarm Signals  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Determines whether the T1 access unit generates yellow alarm signals on the network  
and DSX-1 Drop/Insert T1 interfaces. The yellow alarm signal is generated in  
accordance with AT&T Pub TR 62411 when a continuous LOS/OOF condition (red  
Carrier Failure Alarm (CFA) or AIS signal (Blue CFA)) is detected.  
H Generate Yellow Alarm Signals does not appear if:  
– DSX-1 Interface on the 9161 Single T1 NAM is set to Disable or,  
– 9261 Dual T1 NAM is installed  
Enable – The T1 access unit generates yellow alarm signals.  
Disable – The T1 access unit does not generate yellow alarm signals.  
NOTE: When this configuration option is disabled, the DTE equipment connected  
to the DSX-1 interface is responsible for generation of the yellow alarm  
signal for CFAs on the network T1.  
Test Timeout  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Determines whether or not user-initiated loopback and pattern tests have a duration  
after which they are terminated. This option does not pertain to a DTE-initiated  
loopback.  
Enable – User-initiated loopback and pattern tests have a timeout. This setting is  
recommended when the T1 access unit is managed remotely through an in-band data  
stream such as EDL, FDL, or DDL. If the T1 access unit is accidently commanded to  
execute a test on the interface providing the management access, control can be  
regained after the timeout expires, terminating the test.  
Disable – Loopback and pattern tests must be manually terminated.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-9. System Options (2 of 4)  
Test Duration (min)  
Possible Settings: 1 – 120  
Default Setting: 10  
Specifies the duration of the user-initiated loopback or pattern tests.  
H Test Duration (min) only appears if Test Timeout is set to Enable.  
1 to 120 – Timeout values in minutes.  
Primary Clock Source  
Possible Settings: Net1, Net2, DSXss-p, Internal, External, Sync Data  
Default Setting: Net1  
The source selected for this configuration option provides all of the timing within the  
T1 access unit and the clocks for all of the external interfaces. Failure of the clock  
specified by this configuration option results in automatic fallback to the Secondary  
Clock Source configuration option setting. Only one APM clock source can be selected  
for either primary or secondary clock.  
NOTE: For the Primary and Secondary Clock Source options, only Sync Data and  
Internal can be selected for both options. All other selections must have  
different settings (e.g., if Primary Clock Source is set to Net1, Secondary  
Clock Source cannot be set to Net1).  
Net1 – The primary clock for the unit is derived from the Network 1 T1 interface.  
Net2 – The primary clock for the unit is derived from the Network 2 T1 interface.  
DSXss-p – The primary clock for the unit is derived from the DSX-T1 interface, where  
ss is the slot number and p is the port number. This selection is only available if a  
DSX-1 interface is enabled.  
Internal – The primary clock for the unit is the internal clock.  
External – The primary clock for the unit is the external clock (XTXC) provided through  
one of the synchronous data ports (specified in the Port options). Only a disabled port  
can be selected, and the port cannot be used for data. This selection only appears if at  
least one synchronous data port is disabled.  
Sync Data – The primary clock for the unit is derived from the XTXC signal of a  
synchronous data port (specified in the Port configuration options). Only an enabled port  
can be selected. This selection only appears if at least one synchronous data port is  
enabled.  
NOTE: If an EDL for the port is enabled, the external device must provide a clock  
8 kbps less than the expected data port rate. For example, if 64 kbps is the  
selected port rate, the external clock source should supply a 56 kbps clock  
signal.  
Port (for Primary Clock Source)  
Possible Settings: SssPp  
Default Setting: the first available port  
Selects a slot and a port number for the Primary Clock Source.  
H Port only appears if Primary Clock Source is set to Sync Data or External.  
SssPp – Where ss is the slot number and p is the port number for the Primary Clock  
Source.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-9. System Options (3 of 4)  
Secondary Clock Source  
Possible Settings: Net1, Net2, DSXss-p, Internal, External, Sync Data  
Default Setting: Internal  
Provides a secondary clock source when the primary clock source fails. The source  
selected for this configuration option provides all of the timing within the unit and the  
clocks for all of the external interfaces. Only one APM clock source can be selected as  
the clock source for either primary or secondary clock. The clock source will switch back  
to primary when the primary clock source returns and is stable for 10 seconds. If the  
secondary clock source fails, the clock source will switch to internal. The clock source  
will switch back to primary when the primary clock source returns and is stable for  
10 seconds.  
NOTE: For the Primary and Secondary Clock Source options, only Sync Data and  
Internal can be selected for both options. All other selections must have  
different settings (e.g., if Primary Clock Source is set to Net1, Secondary  
Clock Source cannot be set to Net1).  
Net1 – The secondary clock for the unit is derived from the Network 1 T1 interface.  
Net2 – The secondary clock for the unit is derived from the Network 2 T1 interface.  
DSXss-p – The secondary clock for the unit is derived from the DSX-1 interface, where  
ss is the slot number and p is the port number. This selection is only available if a  
DSX-1 interface is enabled.  
Internal – The secondary clock for the unit is the internal clock.  
External – The secondary clock for the unit is the external clock (XTXC) provided  
through one of the synchronous data ports (specified in the Port configuration option).  
Only a disabled port can be selected and the port cannot be used for data. This  
selection only appears if at least one synchronous data port is disabled.  
Sync Data – The secondary clock for the unit is derived from the XTXC signal of a  
synchronous data port (specified in the Port configuration options). Only an enabled port  
can be selected. This selection only appears if at least one synchronous data port is  
enabled.  
NOTE: If an EDL for the port is enabled, the external device must provide a clock  
8 kbps less than the expected data port rate. For example, if 64 kbps is the  
selected port rate, the external clock source should supply a 56 kbps clock  
signal.  
Port (for Secondary Clock Source)  
Possible Settings: SssPp  
Default Setting: the first available port  
Selects a slot and a port number for the Secondary Clock Source.  
H Port only appears if Secondary Clock Source is set to Sync Data or External.  
SssPp – Where ss is the slot number and p is the port number for the Secondary Clock  
Source.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-9. System Options (4 of 4)  
External Clock Rate (KHz)  
Possible Settings: 8, 1544, 2048  
Default Setting: 1544  
Determines the clock rate when a clock source is configured for an external clock in  
kilohertz.  
H External Clock Rate only appears if Primary or Secondary Clock Source is set to  
External.  
8 – The external clock rate is 8 KHz.  
1544 – The external clock rate is 1544 KHz.  
2048 – The external clock rate is 2048 KHz.  
Primary Clock Failure Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Specifies whether an ASCII alarm message is generated when a Primary Clock Failure  
is detected.  
Enable – Generates an ASCII alarm message.  
Disable – Does not generate an ASCII alarm message.  
Secondary Clock Failure Alarm  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Specifies whether an ASCII alarm message is generated when a Secondary Clock  
Failure is detected.  
Enable – Generates an ASCII alarm message.  
Disable – Does not generate an ASCII alarm message.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Setting User Interface Options  
Use the User Interface options to set up:  
H
H
H
The Communication Port  
Support an external device connected to the Communication Port  
Support a Telnet or FTP session through an interconnected IP network  
Setting Up the Communication Port  
Use the Communication Port Options screen (see Table 5-10) to configure the  
COM port for one of the following functions:  
H
H
H
ASCII terminal interface  
Network communication link to an IP network or IP device  
Alarm port for sending ASCII alarm messages  
This screen differs depending upon whether the COM port is configured for  
synchronous or asynchronous operation.  
Configuration Edit/Display User Interface Communication Port Options  
Table 5-10. Communication Port Options (1 of 5)  
Port Use  
Possible Settings: Terminal, Net Link, Alarm  
Default Setting: Terminal  
Assigns a specific use to the communication (COM) port.  
Terminal – The COM port is the asynchronous terminal interface port.  
NOTES: – ASCII alarm messages may also be supported when the asynchronous  
terminal interface is not in use.  
– If the Default Network Destination is set to COM (see Table 5-14) and  
you change Port Use to Terminal or Alarm, the Default Network  
Destination is forced to None.  
Net Link – The COM port is the network communication link to the IP network or  
IP device port.  
CAUTION: If Net Link is used with an external modem attached to the COM port, be  
aware of the potential security risk of unwanted access to the NMS, or to  
other devices on the LAN to which the access device has routing table  
entries for subnet or host routes.  
Alarm – The COM port is the ASCII alarm message port.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-10. Communication Port Options (2 of 5)  
Port Type  
Possible Settings: Asynchronous, Synchronous  
Default Setting: Asynchronous  
Specifies whether the port transmits synchronous or asynchronous data.  
Asynchronous – The port uses asynchronous communication.  
Synchronous – The port uses synchronous communication. Synchronous is only valid  
when Port Use is set to Net Link.  
Clock Source  
Possible Settings: Internal, External  
Default Setting: Internal  
Specifies whether the port uses internal or external clocking when the COM port is set  
for synchronous transmission. For synchronous operation, the COM port is always  
defined as a DCE. This configuration option reverses the direction of the clock (TXC,  
and RXC) interchange circuits and allows the COM port to accept clocking from an  
external device.  
Connection to another DCE requires the use of a crossover cable.  
H Clock Source does not appear if Port Type is set to Asynchronous.  
Internal – The COM port uses internal clocking.  
External – The COM port uses external clocking.  
Data Rate (Kbps)  
Possible Settings: 9.6, 14.4, 19.2, 28.8, 38.4, 57.6, 115.2  
Default Setting: 19.2  
Specifies the bits per second rate for the COM port.  
H Data Rate (Kbps) does not appear if:  
– Port Type is set to Synchronous and,  
– Clock Source is set to External.  
9.6 – Sets the COM port rate to 9600 bps.  
14.4 – Sets the COM port rate to 14,400 bps.  
19.2 – Sets the COM port rate to 19,200 bps.  
28.8 – Sets the COM port rate to 28,800 bps. (Running above 28.8 may cause problems  
on older PCs.)  
38.4 – Sets the COM port rate to 38,400 bps.  
CAUTION: The following speeds (57.6 and 115.2 Kbps) are intended to be used for  
FTP file transfers only. If you configure one of these rates, be sure to  
use the standard 14COM port cable or an equivalent short, low  
capacitance cable.  
57.6 – Sets the COM port rate to 57,600 bps.  
115.2 – Sets the COM port rate to 115,200 bps.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-10. Communication Port Options (3 of 5)  
Character Length  
Possible Settings: 7, 8  
Default Setting: 8  
Specifies the number of bits needed to represent one character. The character length  
must be set to 8 bits when using the communication port as the network communication  
link.  
H Character length defaults to 8 and cannot be changed if Port Use is set to Net Link  
and Port Type is set to Asynchronous.  
7 – Sets the character length to seven bits.  
8 – Sets the character length to eight bits. You must use this setting if using the COM  
port as the network communication link.  
Parity  
Possible Settings: None, Even, Odd  
Default Setting: None  
Provides a method of checking the accuracy of binary numbers for the COM port.  
None – Provides no Parity.  
Even – Makes the sum of all 1 bits in the character and its corresponding parity bit  
always even.  
Odd – Makes the sum of all 1 bits in the character and its corresponding parity bit  
always odd.  
Stop Bits  
Possible Settings: 1, 1.5, 2  
Default Setting: 1  
Determines the number of stop bits used for the COM port.  
1 – Provides one stop bit.  
1.5 – Provides one and a half stop bits.  
2 – Provides two stop bits.  
Ignore Control Leads  
Possible Settings: Disable, DTR  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies whether Data Terminal Ready (DTR) is used.  
Disable – Treats control leads as standard operation.  
DTR – Ignores DTR. This may be necessary when connecting to some PAD (Packet  
Assembly and Disassembly) devices.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-10. Communication Port Options (4 of 5)  
Login Required  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Determines whether a user ID and password is required in order to log on to the  
asynchronous terminal interface on the COM port.  
H Login Required does not appear if Port Use is set to Net Link or Alarms.  
Enable – Requires a user ID and password to access the asynchronous terminal  
interface.  
Disable – Does not require a user ID and password to access the asynchronous  
terminal interface.  
Port Access Level  
Possible Settings: Level 1, Level 2, Level 3  
Default Setting: Level 1  
Specifies level of user access privilege for the asynchronous terminal interface.  
H Port Access Level does not appear if Port Use is set to Net Link or Alarms.  
Level-1 – Allows full access and control of the device, including monitoring, diagnostics,  
and configuration. The user can add, change, and display configuration options, save,  
and perform device testing.  
Level-2 – Allows limited access and control of the device. The user can monitor and  
perform diagnostics, display status and configuration options information.  
Level-3 – Allows limited access with monitoring control only. The user can monitor and  
display status and configuration screens only.  
Inactivity Timeout  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Determines whether a user session is disconnected after a specified time of inactivity  
(no keyboard activity).  
H Inactivity Timeout does not appear if Port Use is set to Net Link or Alarms.  
NOTE: Changing this setting does not affect the current session; it changes all  
subsequent sessions.  
Enable – Disconnects user session after the specified time of inactivity.  
Disable – Does not disconnect user session.  
Disconnect Time (Minutes)  
Possible Settings: 1 – 60  
Default Setting: 5  
Determines the amount of lapsed time before disconnecting a user session in minutes.  
H Disconnect Time (Minutes) does not appear if:  
– Port Use is set to Net Link or Alarms.  
– Inactivity Time is set to Disable.  
1 – 60 – Set the time from 1 to 60 minutes.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-10. Communication Port Options (5 of 5)  
RIP  
Possible Settings: None, Proprietary  
Default Setting: None  
Specifies which routing information protocol (RIP) is used to enable routing of  
management between devices.  
H RIP only appears if Port Use is set to Net Link.  
NOTE: Changing this setting does not affect the current session; it changes all  
subsequent sessions.  
None – No routing is used. Use this setting when the device at the other end of the  
management link is not a Paradyne device.  
Proprietary – A proprietary variant of RIP version 1 is used to communicate routing  
information between devices to enable routing of IP traffic.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Setting Up the Communication Port to Support an External Device  
NOTE:  
To detect when the external device connection has been lost, the  
communication port’s DTR lead should be connected to the external device’s  
DSR lead using a standard EIA-232 crossover cable (the communication  
port’s DTR lead is monitored for loss of connection). The external device  
must be configured to drop DSR when a disconnect occurs, and to ignore  
DTR.  
Use the External Device Options screen (see Table 5-11) to set up the COM port  
to support an external device such as a modem or a PAD. These options control  
call processing for an external device.  
Configuration Edit/Display User Interface External Device  
Table 5-11. External Device (COM Port) Options (1 of 3)  
External Device Commands  
Possible Settings: Disable, AT, Other  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies the external device commands to be sent out from the COM port to control the  
device.  
NOTE: The Carrier Detect (CD) lead detects loss of the external device, therefore  
the external device must not force CD on.  
Disable – Commands are not sent out from the communication port.  
NOTE: You must use this setting if you have an async terminal connected to the  
COM port.  
AT – AT commands are sent out from the COM port. All AT command strings end with a  
carriage return (hex 0x0D) and a line feed (hex 0x0A).  
Other – Commands configured by the user are sent out from the COM port.  
CAUTION: You must not use this setting if you have an async terminal connected to  
the COM port.  
NOTE: Connect Prefix, Connect Indication String, Escape Sequence, Escape  
Sequence Delay, and Disconnect String options will only be used when the  
setting is Other. Refer to the Control Characters table on page 5-60.  
Dial-In Access  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Controls whether external devices can dial-in to the T1 access unit through the  
communication port (based on the Communication Use configuration option setting).  
Enable – Answers incoming calls and establishes connection to the remote terminal or  
IP address.  
Disable – Does not answer incoming calls. Refer to the Control Characters table on  
page 5-60.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-11. External Device (COM Port) Options (2 of 3)  
Connect Prefix  
Possible Settings: ASCII text entry, Clear  
Default Setting: Clear  
Specifies the Connect Prefix to dial the directory telephone number. Only used by the  
T1 access unit when External Device Commands is set to Other.  
ASCII Text Field – Changes the Connect Prefix (maximum 20 characters). Refer to the  
Control Characters table.  
Clear – Clears the connect prefix. No connect prefix is used. Refer to the Control  
Characters table on page 5-60.  
H Connect Prefix only appears if External Device Commands is set to Other.  
Connect Indication String  
Possible Settings: ASCII text entry, Clear  
Default Setting: Clear  
Specifies the connect indication string and determines whether a connection (alarms or  
traps have been dialed out) is established through the COM port. The T1 access unit  
searches the COM port’s receive data stream for the Connect Indication String. If not  
received within 1 minute, the connection times out. Only used by the T1 access unit  
when External Device Commands is set to Other.  
ASCII Text Field – Adds to or changes the Connection Indication String (maximum  
20 characters). Refer to the Control Characters table on page 5-60.  
Clear – Clears the connect prefix. The COM port’s receive data stream is not searched,  
and the Carrier Detect (CD) lead is used to determine that a connection has been  
established.  
H Connect Indication String only appears if External Device Commands is set to  
Other.  
Escape Sequence  
Possible Settings: ASCII text entry, Clear  
Default Setting: Clear  
Specifies the COM port’s escape sequence used to switch an external device to  
command mode before commanding the external device to disconnect. Only used by the  
T1 access unit when External Device Commands is set to Other.  
ASCII Text Field – Changes the Escape Sequence (maximum 20 characters).  
Clear – Clears and sets the Escape Sequence. No Escape Sequence is sent out.  
H Escape Sequence only appears if External Device Commands is set to Other.  
Escape Sequence Delay (Sec)  
Possible Settings: None, 0.2, 0.4, 0.6, 0.8, 1.0  
Default Setting: None  
Specifies the delay before sending the first character of the escape sequence and the  
delay after the last character of the escape in seconds. During the delay, no data is sent  
from the communication port. Only used by the T1 access unit when External Device  
Commands is set to Other.  
None – No communication port escape delay.  
x.x – The delay (0.2, 0.4. 0.6, 0.8, 1.0) used during the COM port’s escape sequence.  
This delay must be configured for a delay greater than or equal to the escape guard time  
required by the external device.  
H Escape Sequence Delay only appears if External Device Commands is set to  
Other.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-11. External Device (COM Port) Options (3 of 3)  
Disconnect String  
Possible Settings: ASCII text entry, Clear  
Default Setting: Clear  
Specifies the command used to disconnect an external device. Only used by the  
T1 access unit when External Device Commands is set to Other.  
ASCII Text Field – Adds to or changes the Disconnect String (maximum 20 characters).  
Refer to the Control Characters table on page 5-60.  
Clear – Clears and sets the Disconnect String.  
H Disconnect String only appears if External Device Commands is set to Other.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Control Characters  
ASCII  
Sequence  
^A or ^a  
^B or ^b  
^C or ^c  
^D or ^d  
^E or ^e  
^F or ^f  
^G or ^g  
^H or ^h  
^I or ^i  
Hex  
SOH  
STX  
ETX  
EOT  
ENQ  
ACK  
BEL  
BS  
0x01  
0x02  
0x03  
0x04  
0x05  
0x06  
0x07  
0x08  
0x09  
0x0A  
0x0B  
0x0C  
0x0D  
0x0E  
0x0F  
0x10  
0x11  
0x12  
0x13  
0x14  
0x15  
0x16  
0x17  
0x18  
0x19  
0x1A  
0x1B  
0x1C  
0x1D  
0x1E  
0x1F  
HT  
^J or ^j  
^K or ^k  
^L or ^l  
^M or ^m  
^N or ^n  
^O or ^o  
^P or ^p  
^Q or ^q  
^R or ^r  
^S or ^s  
^T or ^t  
^U or ^u  
^V or ^v  
^W or ^w  
^X or ^x  
^Y or ^y  
^Z or ^z  
^{ or ^[  
LF or NL  
VT  
FF or NP  
CR  
SO  
SI  
DLE  
DC1  
DC2  
DC3  
DC4  
NAK  
SYN  
ETB  
CAN  
EM  
SUB  
ESC  
FS  
^\ or ^|  
^] or ^}  
GS  
^^ or ^~  
^–  
RS  
US  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Setting Up to Support a Telnet or FTP Session  
Use the Telnet/FTP Session Options screen to allow a Telnet or FTP session  
through an interconnected IP network. These options also set up security for the  
Telnet or FTP session (see Table 5-12). Only one Telnet session can be active at  
any one time.  
" Procedure  
1. Set the Node IP Address, Node Subnet Mask, Default Network Destination,  
and the Communication Protocol Port Link (see Table 5-14). Follow this menu  
selection sequence:  
Configuration Edit/Display Management and  
Communication Communication Protocol  
2. Set the Telnet/FTP configuration options (see Table 5-12). Follow this menu  
selection sequence:  
Configuration Edit/Display User Interface Telnet Session  
3. The Telnet/FTP Session Options screen appears. Enter the desired setting in  
each selected field.  
4. Set the Port Use configuration option to Net Link (see Table 5-10). Follow this  
menu selection sequence:  
Configuration Edit/Display User Interface Communication Port  
Or, set the Management Link configuration option to FDL or DDL, and set the  
IP address (see Table 5-12). Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Configuration Edit/Display Network Interface Options  
Or, set the Embedded Data Link configuration option to Enable for the  
Synchronous Data Port, and set the IP address (see Table 5-3). Follow this  
menu selection sequence:  
Configuration Edit/Display Synchronous Data Port Options  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-12. Telnet/FTP Session Options (1 of 2)  
Telnet Session  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies whether the unit responds to a Telnet session request from a Telnet client on  
an interconnected IP network.  
Enable – Allows Telnet sessions between the unit and Telnet client.  
Disable Telnet sessions are not allowed.  
Telnet Login Required  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies whether a user ID and password is required to sign on the async terminal  
interface through a Telnet session. If required, the login used is the same login used for  
an async terminal interface session.  
Enable – Requires a user ID and password to sign on a Telnet session.  
Disable – Does not require a user ID and password to sign on a Telnet session.  
Session Access Level  
Possible Settings: Level-1, Level-2, Level-3  
Default Setting: Level-1  
Specifies the highest access level allowed during a Telnet session. Effective access  
level is the lower of either your personal or Telnet session access levels.  
Level-1 – Allows Telnet access by users with Login ID access levels of 1, 2, and 3, with  
the capability to view system information, change configuration options, and run tests.  
This is the highest access level allowed. Use this setting when downloading files.  
Level-2 – Allows Telnet access by users with Login ID access levels of 1, 2, and 3, with  
the capability to view system information and run tests only; they cannot change  
configuration options.  
Level-3 – Allows Telnet access by users with Login ID access levels of 1, 2, and 3, with  
the capability to view system information only; they cannot change configuration options  
or run tests.  
Inactivity Timeout  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Determines whether a Telnet session is disconnected after a specified period of  
keyboard inactivity.  
NOTE: Changing this setting does not affect the current session; it changes all  
subsequent sessions.  
Enable Terminates Telnet session after the specified time of inactivity.  
Disable – Does not terminate Telnet session during inactivity.  
Disconnect Time (Minutes)  
Possible Settings: 1 – 60  
Default Setting: 5  
Determines the amount of keyboard inactive time before disconnecting.  
H Disconnect Time (Minutes) does not appear if Inactivity Timeout is set to Disable.  
1 – 60 – Sets the time from 1 to 60 minutes.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-12. Telnet/FTP Session Options (2 of 2)  
FTP Session  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Determines whether the T1 access unit responds as a server to an FTP session request  
from an FTP client on an interconnected IP network. Must be enabled when  
downloading files.  
Enable – Allows an FTP session between the T1 access unit and an FTP client.  
Disable – Does not allow an FTP session.  
FTP Login Required  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Determines whether a user ID and password is required for an FTP session. If required,  
the login used is the same login used for an async terminal interface session.  
Enable – User is prompted for a user ID and password for an FTP session.  
Disable – User is not prompted for a user ID and password for an FTP session.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Configuring for Alarms and Traps  
Use the Alarm options screen (see Table 5-13) to control when and how alarm  
and trap conditions are automatically initiated by the system.  
Configuration Edit/Display Alarm  
Table 5-13. Alarm Options (1 of 3)  
ASCII Alarm Message  
Possible Settings: Com Port, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Controls the generation and routing of alarm messages to an ASCII terminal or printer  
attached to the COM port (either local or remote via an external device).  
Com Port – Generates and sends alarm messages to COM port when the Port Use  
option is set to Alarm (see Table 5-10).  
Disable – Does not generate alarm messages.  
Alarm & Trap Dial Out  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Controls whether alarm or SNMP trap messages initiate a call if a connection on the  
COM port’s external device has not already been established. If the call is incomplete  
and the Call Retry configuration option is set to Enable, the alarm or SNMP trap  
message is held until the call completes or the maximum retry count is exceeded. If  
more that one alarm message is received while waiting for a call retry, only the highest  
priority alarm message received is held; all previous messages are discarded. When the  
port is configured as a network communication link, up to 10 SNMP messages are held  
(queued) at the interface.  
Enable – Automatically calls the phone number contained in the Alarm directory.  
Disable – Holds (queues) SNMP trap messages sent to the COM port external device if  
the COM port external device was not previously established. Does not hold alarm  
messages.  
Trap Disconnect  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Enable  
Determines whether the COM port external device connection is disconnected after  
sending an SNMP trap message. This configuration option only applies to COM port  
external device connections initiated as a result of sending the SNMP trap message.  
Enable – Disconnects the COM port external device call after sending an SNMP trap  
message.  
Disable – Does not disconnect the COM port external device call after sending an  
SNMP trap message and holds the line until it is disconnected manually or by the  
remote modem. This enables the NMS to poll the NAM for more information after  
receiving the SNMP traps.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-13. Alarm Options (2 of 3)  
Call Retry  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Controls whether an incomplete call (busy, no answer, etc.) from the alarm or SNMP  
trap to the COM port’s external device is retried. Attempts the call up to 5 times per  
alarm or SNMP trap message.  
Enable – Retries incomplete calls with a delay as specified by the Dial-Out Delay Time  
configuration option between call attempts.  
Disable – Does not retry an incomplete call.  
Dial-Out Delay TIme (Min)  
Possible Settings: 1 – 10  
Default Setting: 5  
Specifies the number of minutes to wait between successive dial-out alarms and SNMP  
trap messages and call retry attempts in minutes.  
1 – 10 – The number of minutes to delay between calls.  
Alternate Dial-Out Directory  
Possible Settings: None, 1 – 5  
Default Setting: None  
Specifies whether an incomplete call (busy, or no answer, etc.) from the alarm or SNMP  
trap to the COM port’s external device is retried using an alternate telephone number.  
Attempts the call up to 5 times per alarm or SNMP trap message.  
None – Alternate alarm dial out is not performed.  
1 – 5 – Specifies the call directory containing the telephone number to call in the event  
that a call cannot be completed to the phone number contained in the Alarm directory.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-13. Alarm Options (3 of 3)  
System Alarm Relay  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Specifies whether an alarm condition for the T1 access unit will activate the system  
alarm relay. The alarm relay is deactivated when the condition causing the alarm is  
corrected. If more than one alarm condition is present, the alarm relay remains active  
until all alarm conditions are cleared for that T1 access unit. You can also deactivate an  
alarm via the System Alarm Relay Cut-Off selection from the Control menu.  
H System Alarm Relay only appears if the NAM is installed in a 5-slot housing or  
access carrier.  
Alarm conditions are:  
H Power supply/fan tray alarm.  
H Continuous Loss of Signal (LOS) condition at either the Network or DSX-1  
interface, or on any OCU-DP port.  
H Continuous Out of Frame (OOF) condition at either the Network or DSX-1  
interface.  
H Yellow alarm on either the Network or DSX-1 interface.  
H Continuous Out of Frame (OOF) condition at any synchronous data port that has  
the EDL set to Enable.  
H Alarm Indication Signal (AIS) received at either the Network or DSX-1 interface.  
H Excessive Error Rate (EER) detected at the Network interface.  
H Excessive Error Rate (EER) detected at any synchronous data port that has  
Embedded Data Link set to Enable (see Table 5-3).  
H Primary or Secondary Clock Failure.  
H Failure of an APM.  
H An APM is inserted that does not match the configuration.  
H Abnormal Station Code on any OCU-DP port.  
H DDS Network Failure on any OCU-DP port.  
H Loss of Loop Timing on any OCU-DP port.  
Enable – Activates alarm conditions on the system alarm relay when an alarm condition  
occurs.  
Disable – Does not activate alarm conditions on the system alarm relay when an alarm  
condition occurs.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Setting Management and Communication Options  
Use the Management and Communication Options to set up:  
H
H
H
H
H
Communication Protocol  
General SNMP Management  
SNMP NMS Security  
SNMP Traps  
Telnet/FTP  
Setting Communication Protocol  
Use the Communication Protocol Options (see Table 5-14) to specify what is  
needed to support the IP communication network.  
Configuration Edit/Display Management and Communication →  
Communication Protocol  
NOTE:  
Be sure to choose an operational link for the default. Should the default link  
become disabled, unrouteable data will be discarded.  
Table 5-14. Communication Protocol Options (1 of 3)  
Node IP Address  
Possible Settings: 000.000.000.000 – 223.255.255.255, Clear  
Default Setting: 000.000.000.000  
Specifies the IP address needed to access the node. Since this IP address is not bound  
to a particular port, it can be used for remote access via a logical management link.  
000.000.000.000 – 223.255.255.255 – Shows the IP address for the node, which you  
can view or edit. The first digit (i.e., xxx.255.255.255) cannot be 0 or 127, or greater  
than 223. However, 000 is valid, representing a null address.  
Clear – Clears the Node IP address and fills the address with zeros  
(i.e., 000.000.000.000).  
Node Subnet Mask  
Possible Settings: 000.000.000.000 – 255.255.255.255, Clear  
Default Setting: 000.000.000.000  
Node Subnet Mask. Specifies the subnet mask needed to access the node. Since this  
subnet mask is not bound to a particular port, it can be used for remote access via a  
logical management link.  
000.000.000.000 – 255.255.255.255 – Shows the subnet mask for the node, which you  
can view or edit.  
Clear – Clears the node subnet mask and fills the address with zeros. When the node  
subnet mask is all zeros (i.e., 000.000.000.000), the IP protocol creates a default subnet  
mask based on the class of the IP address: Class A: 255.000.000.000,  
Class B: 255.255.000.000, or Class C: 255.255.255.000.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-14. Communication Protocol Options (2 of 3)  
Default Network Destination  
Possible Settings: None, COM, FDL1, FDL2, DDL, EDLss-p  
Default Setting: None  
Specifies where the default network is connected.  
H Default Network Destination is forced to None if:  
– Default Network Destination is set to FDL1, FDL2 or DDL and Network  
Interface is set to Disable on the Network Interface Options screen (see  
Table 5-1).  
– Management Link on the Network Interface Options screen is changed to a  
value inconsistent with the value of Network Interface Destination.  
– Default Network Destination is set to COM and COM Port Use is set to  
Terminal or Alarms on the Communication Port Options screen (see  
Table 5-10).  
– Default Network Destination is set to EDLss-p and EDL Management Link is  
set to Disable on the Synchronous Data Port Options screen for Port p of  
Slot ss (see Table 5-3).  
None – No default network destination. Data that cannot be routed is discarded.  
COM – The communication port is the default network destination. This selection only  
appears if Port Use is set to Net Link on the Communication Port Options screen (see  
Table 5-10).  
FDL1 – The FDL is the default network destination on Network Interface 1. This  
selection only appears if Management Link is set to FDL on the Network Interface 1  
Options screen (see Table 5-1).  
FDL2 – The FDL is the default network destination on Network Interface 2. This  
selection only appears if Management Link is set to FDL on the Network Interface 2  
Options screen (see Table 5-1).  
DDL – The DDL is the default network destination. This selection only appears if  
Management Link is set to DDL on the Network Interface Options screen (see  
Table 5-1).  
EDLss-p –The EDL-ss-p port (where ss is the slot number of the NAM or the  
synchronous data APM belonging to the ports, and p is the number of the port). This  
selection only appears if EDL Management Link is set to Enable on the Synchronous  
Data Port Options screen (see Table 5-3) for port p of slot ss.  
Communication Port IP Address  
Possible Settings: 000.000.000.000 – 223.255.255.255, Clear  
Default Setting: 000.000.000.000  
Specifies the IP address needed to access the unit when the COM port is configured as  
a network communication link. The IP address is only in effect when the Communication  
Port Use configuration option is set to Net Link (see Table 5-10).  
000.000.000.000 – 223.255.255.255 – Shows the communication port IP address,  
which you can view or edit. The first digit (i.e., xxx.255.255.255) cannot be 0 or 127, or  
greater than 223. However, 000 is valid, representing a null address.  
Clear – Clears the IP address for the communication port and fills the address with  
zeros (i.e., 000.000.000.000).  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-14. Communication Protocol Options (3 of 3)  
Communication Port Subnet Mask  
Possible Settings: 000.000.000.000 – 255.255.255.255, Clear  
Default Setting: 000.000.000.000  
Specifies the subnet mask needed to access the unit when the port is configured as a  
network communication link. The subnet mask is only in effect when the Communication  
Port Use configuration option is set to Net Link (see Table 5-10).  
000.000.000.000 – 255.255.255.255 – Shows the subnet mask for the node, which you  
can view or edit.  
Clear – Clears the subnet mask for the communication port and fills the address with  
zeros. When the node subnet mask is all zeros (i.e., 000.000.000.000), the IP protocol  
creates a default subnet mask based on the class of the IP address:  
Class A: 255.000.000.000, Class B: 255.255.000.000, or Class C: 255.255.255.000.  
Communication Port Link Protocol  
Possible Settings: PPP, SLIP  
Default Setting: PPP  
Specifies the link layer protocol to use when the communication port is configured as a  
network communication link.  
PPP – Point-to-Point Protocol.  
SLIP – Serial Line IP Protocol.  
H This protocol is only in effect when the Communication Port Use configuration  
option is set to Net Link (see Table 5-10).  
Alternate Communication Port IP Address  
Possible Settings: 000.000.000.000 – 223.255.255.255, Clear  
Default Setting: 000.000.000.000  
Specifies the alternate IP address for the communication port. The Alternate IP Address  
is used when a call attempt does not complete on the primary alarm/trap telephone  
number contained in the Alarm directory and the alternate dial-out directory is used to  
try another telephone number.  
000.000.000.000 – 223.255.255.255 – Shows the communication port IP address,  
which you can view or edit. The first digit (i.e., xxx.255.255.255) cannot be 0 or 127, or  
greater than 223. However, 000 is valid, representing a null address.  
Clear – Clears the alternate IP address for the communication port and fills the address  
with zeros (i.e., 000.000.000.000).  
Alternate Communication Port Subnet Mask  
Possible Settings: 000.000.000.000 – 255.255.255.255, clear  
Default Setting: 000.000.000.000  
Specifies the alternate subnet mask needed for the communication port. The alternate  
subnet mask is used when a call attempt does not complete on the primary alarm/trap  
telephone number contained in the Alarm directory and the alternate dial-out directory is  
used to try another telephone number.  
000.000.000.000 – 255.255.255.255 – View or edit the alternate subnet mask for the  
node.  
Clear – Clears the alternate subnet mask for the communication port and fills the  
address with zeros (i.e., 000.000.000.000). When the alternate subnet mask is all zeros,  
the IP protocol creates a default subnet mask based on the class of the IP address:  
Class A: 255.000.000.000, Class B: 255.255.000.000, or Class C: 255.255.255.000.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Setting Up for SNMP Management  
Use the General SNMP Management Options (see Table 5-15) to specify what is  
needed to allow the system to be managed as an SNMP agent by an NMS  
supporting the SNMP protocol.  
Configuration Edit/Display Management and Communication General  
SNMP Management  
Table 5-15. General SNMP Management Options (1 of 2)  
SNMP Management  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Determines whether SNMP can be used for management of the T1 access unit.  
Enable – The T1 access unit can be managed as an SNMP agent by an SNMP  
compatible NMS.  
Disable – The T1 access unit will not respond to SNMP messages or send SNMP  
traps.  
Community Name 1  
Possible Settings: ASCII text entry, Clear  
Default Setting: [public] in ASCII text entry  
Specifies the first of two names that are allowed to access the objects in the unit’s  
Management Information Base (MIB). The community name must be supplied by an  
external SNMP manager whenever that manager tries to access an object in the MIB.  
ASCII Text Field – Adds to or changes the Community 1 name (maximum  
255 characters).  
Clear – Clears the Community Name 1 field.  
Name 1 Access  
Possible Settings: Read, Read/Write  
Default Setting: Read  
Specifies the type of access allowed for community name 1. This is the type of access  
allowed for external SNMP managers accessing objects in the MIB using the  
Community Name 1 configuration option.  
Read – Allows read-only access to the objects in the MIB for the NAM when using the  
Community Name 1 configuration option. This includes all objects specified as either  
read-only or read/write in the MIB RFCs.  
Read/Write – Allows read and write access to the objects in the MIB for the NAM when  
using the Community Name 1 configuration option. Allows access for all objects  
specified as read/write in the MIB RFCs. However, access for all read-only objects is  
specified as read-only.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-15. General SNMP Management Options (2 of 2)  
Community Name 2  
Possible Settings: ASCII text entry, Clear  
Default Setting: blank  
Specifies the second of two names that are allowed to access the objects in the unit’s  
Management Information Base (MIB). The community name must be supplied by an  
external SNMP manager whenever the manager tries to access an object in the MIB.  
ASCII Text Field – Add or change the community 2 name (maximum 255 characters).  
Clear – Clears the Community Name 2 field.  
Name 2 Access  
Possible Settings: Read, Read/Write  
Default Setting: Read  
Specifies the type of access allowed for Community Name 2. This is the type of access  
allowed for external SNMP managers accessing objects in the MIB using the  
Community Name 2 configuration option.  
Read – Allows read-only access to the objects in the MIB for the NAM when using the  
Community Name 2 configuration option. This includes all objects specified as either  
read-only or read/write in the MIB RFCs.  
Read/Write – Allows read and write access to the objects in the MIB for the NAM when  
using the Community Name 2 configuration option. Allows access for all objects  
specified as read/write in the MIB RFCs. However, access for all read-only objects is  
specified as read-only.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Setting Up SNMP NMS Security  
Use the SNMP NMS Security Options (see Table 5-16) to specify whether a  
security check is performed on the IP address of SNMP management systems  
attempting to access the node.  
Configuration Edit/Display Management and Communication SNMP  
NMS Security  
Table 5-16. SNMP NMS Security Options (1 of 2)  
NMS IP Validation  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Determines whether security checks are performed on the IP address of SNMP  
management systems attempting to access the node. Allows access only if IP address  
of the sending manager is listed on the SNMP NMS Security Options screen.  
Enable – Performs security checks.  
Disable – Does not perform security checks.  
Number of Managers  
Possible Settings: 1 – 10  
Default Setting: 1  
Specifies the number of SNMP management systems that are authorized to send  
SNMP messages to the T1 access unit. An IP address must be configured for each  
management system allowed to send messages. Configure the IP addresses in the  
NMS n IP Address configuration option.  
1 – 10 – Specifies the number of managers allowed to send SNMP messages.  
NMS n IP Address  
Possible Settings: 000.000.000.000 – 223.255.255.255, Clear  
Default Setting: 000.000.000.000  
Specifies the IP address that identifies the SNMP manager(s) authorized to send SNMP  
messages. If an SNMP message is received from the NMS whose IP address does not  
match an address contained in this field, access is denied and an authenticationFailure  
trap is generated. If a match is found, the type of access (read-only or read/write) is  
determined by the corresponding access level.  
000.000.000.000 – 223.255.255.255 – Adds or changes the NMS IP address. The first  
digit (i.e., xxx.255.255.255) cannot be 127; 127 is a reserved number.  
Clear – Clears the NMS IP address and fills the address with zeros  
(i.e., 000.000.000.000).  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-16. SNMP NMS Security Options (2 of 2)  
Access Level  
Possible Settings: Read, Read/Write  
Default Setting: Read  
Specifies the access allowed for an authorized NMS when IP address validation is  
performed. If the IP address for the NMS sending an SNMP message is on the list of  
allowed managers, this configuration option determines the type of access allowed for  
that manager.  
Read – Read-only access to the objects in the MIB for the T1 access unit. This includes  
all objects specified as either read-only or read/write in the MIB RFCs.  
Read/Write – Read and write access to the objects in the MIB for the T1 access unit.  
Allows write access for all objects specified as read/write in the MIB RFCs. However,  
access for all read-only objects is specified as read-only.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Setting Up for SNMP Traps  
Use the SNMP Traps Options (see Table 5-17) to specify the information needed  
to support SNMP traps. Use the SNMP Trap Options screen to configure the  
necessary configuration options needed to support the SNMP traps.  
Configuration Edit/Display Management and Communication SNMP  
Traps  
To configure the T1 access unit for SNMP traps you must set:  
H
The number of SNMP managers that are to receive SNMP traps from the T1  
access unit.  
H
H
An IP address for each SNMP manager specified.  
The type of SNMP traps to be sent from the T1 access unit.  
NOTE:  
Be sure to choose an operational link for the default. Should the default link  
become disabled, unrouteable traps will be discarded.  
To . . .  
Set the configuration option . . .  
Enable sending of SNMP trap  
messages  
SNMP Traps to Enable.  
Specify the number of SNMP  
Number of SNMP Managers to the desired  
managers that will receive SNMP trap number (maximum of 6) of SNMP  
messages from the T1 access unit managers to receive SNMP traps.  
Specify an IP address for each SNMP NMS n IP Address to the IP address that  
manager specified in the Number of identifies each SNMP manager(s) indicated  
SNMP Managers configuration option in the Number of SNMP Managers  
configuration option.  
Specify the network destination for  
the Trap Manager  
Destination to one of the following:  
Default  
COM  
FDL  
EDL (slot and port number)  
Select the type of SNMP trap  
messages to be sent from the T1  
access unit  
H General Traps to enable or disable  
warmStart and authenticationFailure  
traps.  
H Enterprise Specific Traps to enable or  
disable enterpriseSpecific traps.  
H Link Traps to enable or disable linkDown  
and linkUp traps.  
H Link Traps Interfaces to specify which  
interfaces will generate linkDown, linkUp  
and enterpriseSpecific traps.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-17. SNMP Trap Options (1 of 3)  
SNMP Traps  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Determines if SNMP trap messages are sent to the currently configured trap  
manager(s).  
Enable – Sends trap messages.  
Disable – Does not send trap messages.  
Number of Trap Managers  
Possible Settings: 1 – 6  
Default Setting: 1  
Specifies the number of SNMP management systems to receive SNMP trap messages  
from the NAM. An NMS IP Address must be configured in the NMS n IP Address  
configuration option for each trap manager to receive trap messages.  
1 – 6 – Specifies the number of trap managers.  
NMS n IP Address  
Possible Settings: 000.000.000.000 – 223.255.255.255, Clear  
Default Setting: 000.000.000.000  
Specifies the IP address that identifies the SNMP manager(s) to receive SNMP traps.  
H NMS n IP Address appears for each trap manager specified in the Number of Trap  
Managers configuration option.  
000.000.000.000 – 223.255.255.255 – Adds to or changes the IP address for the trap  
manager. The first digit (i.e., xxx.255.255.255) cannot be 0 or 127, or greater than 223.  
However, 000 is valid, representing a null address.  
Clear – Clears the IP address and fills the address with zeros (i.e., 000.000.000.000).  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-17. SNMP Trap Options (2 of 3)  
Destination  
Possible Settings: Default, COM, FDL1, FDL2, DDL, EDLss-p  
Default Setting: Default  
Specifies the network destination for the Trap Manager number configuration option.  
H Destination appears for each trap manager specified in the Number of Trap  
Managers configuration option.  
Default – Uses the default network.  
COM – Uses the communication port as the network destination. This selection only  
appears if the Communication Port Use configuration option is set to Net Link.  
FDL1 – Uses FDL as the network destination on Network Interface 1. This selection  
only appears if the Management Link configuration option is set to FDL for the network  
interface (see Table 5-1).  
FDL2 – Uses FDL as the network destination on Network Interface 2. This selection  
only appears if the Management Link configuration option is set to FDL for the network  
interface (see Table 5-1).  
DDL – Uses DDL as the network destination. This selection only appears if the  
management link configuration option is set to DDL for the Network interface (see  
Table 5-1).  
EDLss-p – Uses EDL as the network destination for the synchronous port in slot ss,  
port p.  
H This selection only appears if the EDL Management Link configuration option is  
set to Enable for the given slot and port (see Table 5-3).  
NOTE: If the selected network destination link is disabled, the SNMP traps are  
discarded. Ensure that an operational link is selected as the default route,  
or change the default route if the link becomes nonoperational.  
General Traps  
Possible Settings: Disable, Warm, AuthFail, Both  
Default Setting: Both  
Determines if SNMP trap messages for warmStart and/or authenticationFailure events  
are sent to the currently configured trap manager(s).  
Disable – Does not send trap messages for warmStart or AuthenticationFailure events.  
Warm – Sends trap messages for warmStart events.  
AuthFail – Sends trap messages for authenticationFailure events.  
Both – Sends trap messages for both warmStart and AuthenticationFailure events.  
Enterprise Specific Traps  
Possible Settings: Enable, Disable  
Default Setting: Disable  
Determines if trap messages for enterpriseSpecific events are sent to the currently  
configured trap manager(s).  
Enable – Sends trap messages for enterpriseSpecific events.  
Disable – Does not send trap messages for enterpriseSpecific events.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Table 5-17. SNMP Trap Options (3 of 3)  
Link Traps  
Possible Settings: Disable, Up, Down, Both  
Default Setting: Both  
Determines whether SNMP linkDown or linkUp traps are sent to the currently configured  
trap manager(s). A linkDown trap indicates that the T1 access unit recognizes a failure  
in one of the communication interfaces. A linkUp trap indicates that the unit recognizes  
one of its communication interfaces is active. Use the Link Traps Interface configuration  
option to specify which interface will monitor linkUp and linkDown traps messages.  
Disable – Does not send linkDown or linkUp trap messages.  
Up – Sends SNMP trap messages for linkUp events.  
Down – Sends SNMP trap messages for linkDown events.  
Both – Sends SNMP trap messages for linkUp and linkDown events.  
Link Traps Interfaces  
Possible Settings: Network, DSX-1, T1s, Ports, All  
Default Setting: All  
Specifies which interface monitors and generates linkUp, linkDown, and  
enterpriseSpecific trap messages.  
NOTE: These traps are supported on the T1 interfaces, synchronous data ports,  
and OCU ports only. They are not supported for the voice ports or  
communication port.  
Network – Generates trap messages for linkUp, linkDown, and enterpriseSpecific  
events on the T1 interface.  
DSX-1 – Generates trap messages for linkUp, linkDown, and enterpriseSpecific events  
on the DSX-1 interfaces.  
T1s – Generates trap messages for linkUp, linkDown, and enterpriseSpecific events on  
both the T1 Network and DSX-1 interfaces.  
Ports – Generates trap messages for linkUp, linkDown and enterpriseSpecific events  
on the synchronous data ports and OCU ports.  
All – Generate SNMP trap messages for linkUp and enterpriseSpecific events on the  
synchronous data ports, the OCU ports, the T1 network interface, and the DSX-1  
interface.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
5-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Setting Up and Placing a Call  
Configure your external device. Then, use the Call Setup screen to:  
H
H
H
Look up the desired telephone number  
Dial a call  
Disconnect a call  
" Procedure  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main ControlCall Setup  
2. The Control menu appears. Select Call Setup and press Return.  
3. The Call Setup screen appears. Enter the number of the directory containing  
the desired telephone number in the Directory Number field. The telephone  
number appears in the Directory Phone Number field. See Displaying  
Directory Numbers and Changing Directory Numbers in Chapter 9,  
Troubleshooting and Maintenance, for information about the call directory.  
4. Select Dial and press the Enter key to initiate dialing.  
5. To end the call, select Disconnect and press the Enter key.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
5-78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Security  
6
Limiting Access  
The T1 access unit provides several methods of security by limiting user access  
through the following user interfaces:  
H
H
H
H
Async Terminal Interface  
Telnet  
External Devices  
SNMP  
Limiting Async Terminal Direct Access  
The access unit provides the following methods for limiting async terminal direct  
access on the communication (COM) port.  
H
H
H
Disabling the async terminal direct connection.  
Requiring a user login ID and password.  
Assigning an access level to the port.  
The Communication Port Options screen provides the configuration options to  
limit async terminal access on the COM port.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
6-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Security  
" Procedure  
To limit COM port async terminal access:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Configuration  
2. Select the desired configuration area and press Return.  
Load Configuration From [Current Configuration/  
Customer Configuration 1/Customer Configuration 2]  
3. Follow this menu selection sequence, pressing Return after each selection:  
Configuration Edit/Display User Interface Communication Port  
The Communication Port Options screen appears.  
4. Select and set the following configuration options, as appropriate.  
To . . .  
Set the configuration option . . .  
Disable an async terminal interface  
direct connection  
Port Use to Alarms.  
Require a user’s login ID and  
Login Required to Enable.  
password to access the COM port  
NOTE: User login ID and password  
combinations must be defined.  
Refer to Creating a Login on  
page 6-8.  
Limit the effective access level to  
Level 2 or lower  
Port Access Level to Level-2.  
1
Limit the effective access level to  
Level 3  
Port Access Level to Level-3.  
1
1
Make sure you have at least one login with Level 1 security set. The effective  
access level of the session is the lower of either the level set to access the port  
(COM port or Telnet), or the login access level.  
NOTE:  
See Restoring Access to the User Interface in Chapter 8, Operation and  
Maintenance, should you inadvertently be locked out.  
5. Press Ctrl-a to switch to the screen function key area.  
6. To save changes, select Save and press Return.  
7. Select the configuration area where you want to save the changes to and  
press Return.  
Save Configuration To [Current Configuration/  
Customer Configuration 1/Customer Configuration 2]  
When Save is complete, Command Complete appears at the bottom of the  
screen.  
Refer to Chapter 5, Setting Up, for more information about Communication Port  
configuration options.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
6-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Security  
Limiting Telnet Access  
The T1 access unit provides the following methods for limiting access through a  
Telnet session:  
H
H
H
Disabling Telnet access completely.  
Requiring a user login ID and password.  
Assigning an access level for the port.  
" Procedure  
To limit access through a Telnet Session:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Configuration  
2. Select the desired configuration area and press Return.  
Load Configuration From [Current Configuration/  
Customer Configuration 1/Customer Configuration 2]  
3. Follow this menu selection sequence, pressing Return after each selection:  
Configuration Edit/Display User Interface Telnet/FTP Session  
The Telnet/FTP Session Options screen appears.  
4. Select and set the following configuration options, as appropriate.  
To . . .  
Set the configuration option . . .  
Disable Telnet  
Telnet Session to Disable.  
Require a user’s login ID and  
password  
Telnet Login Required to Enable.  
NOTE: User login ID and password  
combinations must be defined.  
Refer to Creating a Login on  
page 6-8.  
Assign an access level for all Telnet Session Access Level to Level-1, Level-2,  
sessions or Level-3.  
5. Press Ctrl-a to switch to the screen function key area.  
6. To save changes, select Save and press Return.  
7. Select the configuration area where you want to save the changes to and  
press Return.  
Save Configuration To [Current Configuration/  
Customer Configuration 1/Customer Configuration 2]  
When Save is complete, Command Complete appears at the bottom of the  
screen.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
6-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Security  
Controlling External Device Access  
The T1 access unit allows you to control whether dial-in access for an external  
device (modem) is allowed on the communication port. To connect to an external  
device,  
H
H
Use the appropriate cable to attach to the COM port as defined in  
Appendix E, Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments.  
Set the modem for DTR Disconnect using the AT command AT\D2.  
Use the External Device Options screen to set the necessary configuration  
options that allow dial-in access through the COM port.  
" Procedure  
To control dial-in access:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Configuration  
2. Select the desired configuration area and press Return.  
Load Configuration From [Current Configuration/  
Customer Configuration 1/Customer Configuration 2]  
3. Follow this menu selection sequence, pressing Return after each selection:  
Configuration Edit/Display User Interface External Device  
(Com Port)  
The External Device Options screen appears.  
4. Select a setting for the Dial-In Access configuration option.  
To . . .  
Set the Dial-In Access configuration option to . . .  
Enable dial-in access  
Disable dial-in access  
Enable.  
Disable.  
NOTE:  
The data that you enter determines which options display and their order.  
5. Press Ctrl-a to switch to the screen function key area.  
6. To save changes, select Save and press Return.  
7. Select the configuration area where you want to save the changes to and  
press Return.  
Save Configuration To [Current Configuration/  
Customer Configuration 1/Customer Configuration 2]  
When Save is complete, Command Complete appears at the bottom of the  
screen.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
6-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Security  
See Limiting Async Terminal Direct Access on page 6-1 if you want to limit  
access to the dial-in session.  
Refer to Setting Up the Communication Port to Support an External Device in  
Chapter 5, Setting Up, for more information.  
Controlling SNMP Access  
The T1 access unit supports SNMP Version 1, which only provides limited  
security through the use of community names. There are three methods for  
limiting SNMP access:  
H
H
H
Disabling SNMP access.  
Assigning SNMP community names and access levels.  
Assigning IP addresses of NMSs that can access the unit.  
Disabling SNMP Access  
The General SNMP Options screen provides the configuration option to disable  
SNMP access to the unit. When this configuration option is disabled, the access  
unit will not respond to any SNMP messages and will not send SNMP traps.  
" Procedure  
To disable SNMP access:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Configuration  
2. Select the desired configuration area and press Return.  
Load Configuration From [Current Configuration/  
Customer Configuration 1/Customer Configuration 2]  
3. Follow this menu selection sequence, pressing Return after each selection:  
Configuration Edit/Display Management and  
Communication General SNMP Management  
The General SNMP Management Options screen appears.  
4. Set the SNMP Management configuration option to Disable; Disable is the  
factory default setting.  
5. Press Ctrl-a to switch to the screen function key area.  
6. To save changes, select Save and press Return.  
7. Select the configuration area where you want to save the changes to and  
press Return.  
Save Configuration To [Current Configuration/  
Customer Configuration 1/Customer Configuration 2]  
When Save is complete, Command Complete appears at the bottom of the  
screen.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
6-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Security  
Refer to Setting Up for SNMP Management in Chapter 5, Setting Up, for more  
information about SNMP configuration options.  
Assigning SNMP Community Names and Access Levels  
The General SNMP Options screen provides the configuration options that allow  
the T1 access unit to be managed by an SNMP manager supporting the SNMP  
protocol. Use this screen to:  
H
H
Assign the SNMP community names that are allowed to access the unit’s  
Management Information Base (MIB).  
Specify the type of access allowed for each SNMP community name.  
NOTE:  
Community names are case-sensitive.  
" Procedure  
To assign SNMP community names and access levels:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Configuration  
2. Select the desired configuration area and press Return.  
Load Configuration From [Current Configuration/  
Customer Configuration 1/Customer Configuration 2]  
3. Follow this menu selection sequence, pressing Return after each selection:  
Configuration Edit/Display Management and  
Communication General SNMP Management  
The General SNMP Management Options screen appears.  
4. Select and set the following configuration options, as appropriate.  
To . . .  
Set the configuration option . . .  
Enable SNMP management for the  
access unit  
SNMP Management to Enable.  
Assign SNMP community names  
Community Name 1 and Community  
Name 2 to a community name text up to  
255 characters in length.  
Assign the type of access allowed for Name 1 Access and Name 2 Access to  
the SNMP community names Read or Read/Write.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
6-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Security  
5. Press Ctrl-a to switch to the screen function key area.  
6. To save changes, select Save and press Return.  
7. Select the configuration area where you want to save the changes to and  
press Return.  
Save Configuration To [Current Configuration/  
Customer Configuration 1/Customer Configuration 2]  
When Save is complete, Command Complete appears at the bottom of the  
screen.  
Refer to Setting Up for SNMP Management in Chapter 5, Setting Up, for more  
information about SNMP configuration options.  
Limiting SNMP Access Through IP Addresses  
The access unit provides an additional level of security by:  
H
H
Limiting the IP addresses of the NMSs that can access the unit.  
Performing validation checks on the IP address of SNMP management  
systems attempting to access the unit.  
H
Specifying the access allowed for the authorized NMS when IP address  
validation is performed.  
The SNMP NMS Security Options screen provides the configuration options that  
determine whether security checking is performed on the IP address of SNMP  
management systems attempting to communicate with the unit.  
Make sure that the SNMP Management configuration option is set to Enable.  
Menu selection sequence:  
Main MenuConfigurationDesired configuration area→  
Management and CommunicationGeneral SNMP Management→  
SNMP ManagementEnable  
" Procedure  
To limit SNMP access through IP addresses:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Configuration  
2. Select the desired configuration area and press Return.  
Load Configuration From [Current Configuration/  
Customer Configuration 1/Customer Configuration 2]  
3. Follow this menu selection sequence, pressing Return after each selection:  
Configuration Edit/Display Management and Communication →  
SNMP NMS Security  
The SNMP NMS Security Options screen appears.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
6-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Security  
4. Select and set the following configuration options, as appropriate.  
To . . .  
Set the configuration option . . .  
Enable IP address checking  
NMS IP Validation to Enable.  
Specify the number (between 1 and 10) of  
SNMP management systems that are  
authorized to send SNMP messages to the  
access unit  
Number of Managers to the desired  
number.  
Specify the IP address(es) that identifies  
the SNMP manager(s) authorized to send  
SNMP messages to the access unit  
NMS n IP Address to the appropriate  
IP address.  
Specify the access allowed for an  
authorized NMS when IP address validates  
is performed  
Access Type to Read or Read/Write.  
5. Press Ctrl-a to switch to the screen function key area.  
6. To save changes, select Save and press Return.  
7. Select the configuration area where you want to save the changes to and  
press Return.  
Save Configuration To [Current Configuration/  
Customer Configuration 1/Customer Configuration 2]  
When Save is complete, Command Complete appears at the bottom of the  
screen.  
Refer to Setting Up for SNMP Management in Chapter 5, Setting Up, for more  
information about SNMP configuration options.  
Creating a Login  
A login ID and password is required if security is enabled.* You can define up to  
six logins (login ID/password combinations). Each login must be unique and have  
a specified access level.  
" Procedure  
To create a login:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Control Admin Login  
2. Press Ctrl-a to switch to the screen function key area.  
3. Select New and press Return.  
4. Enter login ID, password, and security level information.  
* Security is enabled by the configuration options Login Required for the Communication Port, and Telnet Login  
Required or FTP Login Required for a Telnet/FTP Session.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
6-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Security  
In the field . . .  
Login ID  
Enter the . . .  
ID of 1 to 10 characters.  
Password from 1 to 10 characters.  
Password  
Re-enter Password  
Password again to verify that you entered the  
correct password into the device.  
Access Level  
Access level: 1, 2, or 3.  
5. Press Ctrl-a to switch to the screen function key area.  
6. To save login information, select Save and press Return.  
When Save is complete, Command Complete appears in the message area  
at the bottom of the screen. The cursor is repositioned at the Login ID field,  
ready for another entry.  
Refer to Chapter 5, Setting Up, for more information about security and login  
configuration options.  
Deleting a Login  
A login record can be deleted.  
NOTE:  
To change a login, delete the current login and create a new one.  
" Procedure  
To delete a login record:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Control Admin Login  
2. Press Ctrl-a to switch to the screen function key area.  
3. Select PgUp or PgDn and press Return to page through login pages/records  
until you find the one to be deleted.  
4. Once the correct record is displayed, select Delete and press Return.  
5. To save the deletion, select Save and press Return.  
When the deletion is complete, Command Complete appears in the message  
area at the bottom of the screen. The number of login pages/records reflects  
one less record, and the record following the deleted record appears.  
Example:  
Page 2 of 4 is changed to Page 2 of 3.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
6-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Security  
This page intentionally left blank.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
6-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displaying System Information  
7
Displaying System and NAM Identity Information  
Use the System & NAM Identity screen to display identification information about  
the system and T1 NAM. This information is useful if you are purchasing  
additional or replacement units and/or making firmware upgrades. Use the  
following menu sequence to display System and NAM identity information.  
Main Menu Status Identity System & NAM  
View this field . . .  
System Name  
To find the . . .  
System name configured for the unit.  
Contact person for the unit.  
System location of the unit.  
NAM’s 4-digit model number (9161 or 9261).  
NAM’s 7-digit serial number.  
NAM’s software version.  
System Contact  
System Location  
Model Number  
Serial Number  
Software Revision  
Hardware Revision  
NAM’s hardware version.  
The above information is entered using the following menu sequence.  
Main Menu Control Device Name  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
7-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
Displaying APM Identity Information  
Use the APM Identity screen to display identification information about a  
particular APM. This information is useful if you are purchasing additional or  
replacement APMs.  
" Procedure  
1. Follow this menu sequence to display the APM Identity Slot screen.  
Main Menu Status Identity APM  
2. Press the spacebar to cycle through the set of slots consisting of the NAM  
and all APMs associated with it. The slot order sequence consists of the slot  
assignment for the APMs in order from lowest (02) to highest (05 for 5-slot  
housing) slot number.  
The following information is available for viewing. Use the right and left arrow  
keys to scroll additional text into view.  
View this field . . .  
To find the . . .  
1
APM Type  
APM type (Sync Data, DSX-1, E&M Voice, FXS Voice,  
FXO Voice, OCU (2) or OCU (6)).  
Serial Number  
APM’s 7-digit serial number.  
Software Revision  
APM’s software version level (6-digit) of the installed  
firmware. The software revision will be the same as the  
NAM software revision if the APM has no  
processor/code of its own.  
Hardware Revision  
APM’s hardware revision level (7-digit) of the main  
circuit card assembly (CCA).  
1
The APM Type field can also display:  
Empty – If the APM slot is empty and was not previously configured.  
Unsupport – If an unrecognized APM is installed.  
Misconfig – If a misconfiguration condition occurs. Refer to ASCII Alarm Messages  
in Chapter 9, Troubleshooting.  
Failed – The APM was removed from the slot, or the APM is not operational.  
Displaying System and Test Status  
Use the System and Test Status screen to display information concerning:  
H
H
H
System Health and Status  
Self-Test results  
Status of tests currently running  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
7-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
Chapter 7, Maintenance and Troubleshooting, contains a list of all status  
messages and recommended action for you to take. Use the following menu  
sequence to display system and test status information.  
Main Menu Status System and Test Status  
Displaying Voice APM Status  
Use the Voice APM Status screen to display information concerning voice cards  
that you have installed in your system.  
" Procedure  
1. Follow this menu sequence to display the Voice APM Status screen.  
Main Menu Status Voice Status  
2. Enter the slot number of the desired voice APM in the SLOT field. The Voice  
Port Status screen differs, depending on whether you are accessing an E&M,  
FXO or FXS Voice APM.  
View this field . . .  
For the E&M Voice APM  
Port Status  
To find the . . .  
Status of the port.  
Assigned To  
Interface the port is assigned to.  
Operating Mode  
Operating mode of the voice port that was configured  
using the Operating Mode configuration option on the  
Voice Ports screen. See the Technical Reference for  
configuration information.  
Signaling Type  
Type of signaling used by the voice port that was  
configured using the switches on the E&M APM. See  
the 9109 E&M Analog Voice Application Module (APM)  
Installation Instructions for more information.  
Call Progress  
TX ABCD bits  
Current condition of the port.  
Current value of the ABCD bits that are being  
transmitted to the T1 interface.  
RX ABCD bits  
Current value of the ABCD bits that are being received  
from the T1 interface.  
E-Lead State  
Current status of the E-lead (On or Off).  
Current status of the M-lead (On or Off).  
M-Lead State  
Trunk Cond CGA  
Displays the status of trunk conditioning (On for CGA,  
Off for no CGA).  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
7-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
View this field . . .  
To find the . . .  
For the FXO Voice APM  
Port Status  
Status of the port.  
Assigned To  
Interface the port is assigned to.  
Operating Mode  
Operating mode of the voice port that was configured  
using the Operating Mode configuration option on the  
Voice Ports screen. See the Technical Reference for  
configuration information.  
Signaling Type  
Type of signaling used by the voice port that was  
configured using the Signaling Type configuration option  
on the Voice Ports screen. See the Technical Reference  
for configuration information.  
Call Progress  
TX ABCD bits  
Current condition of the port.  
Current value of the ABCD signaling bits that are being  
transmitted to the T1 interface.  
RX ABCD bits  
T-R Control  
Current value of the ABCD signaling bits that are being  
received from the T1 interface.  
Current status of the tip and ring leads:  
H Loop. Tip and Ring are connected together.  
H Rgnd. Ring lead is attached to ground.  
H Open. Ring lead is not connected to either the Tip  
lead or the ground.  
H Lpgnd. Tip and Ring are connected together, and are  
connected to ground.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
7-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displaying System Information  
View this field . . .  
To find the . . .  
For the FXO Voice APM (Cont’d)  
T-R Receive  
Status of what the attached device is doing with the Tip  
and Ring leads of the FXO port.  
H RbTo. Attached device has battery applied to the  
Ring lead and the Tip lead is opened  
H RbTg. Attached device has battery applied to the  
Ring lead and the Tip lead is grounded  
H TbRg. Attached device has battery applied to the Tip  
lead and the Ring lead is grounded  
H Ring. Attached device is applying Ringing voltage  
between Tip and Ring  
H ToRo. Attached device has both Tip and Ring leads  
open.  
H TgRo. Attached device has the Tip lead grounded  
and the Ring lead open.  
H TgR*. Attached device has the Tip lead grounded  
and the Ring lead state is unknown.  
H ToR*. Attached device has the Tip lead open and the  
Ring lead state is unknown.  
H RoT*. Attached device has the Ring lead open and  
the Tip lead state is unknown.  
Trunk Cond CGA  
Displays the status of trunk conditioning (On during  
CGA, Off for no CGA).  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
7-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displaying System Information  
View this field . . .  
To find the . . .  
For the FXS Voice APM  
Port Status  
Status of the port.  
Assigned To  
Interface the port is assigned to.  
Operating Mode  
Operating mode of the voice port that was configured  
using the Operating Mode configuration option on the  
Voice Ports screen. See the Technical Reference for  
configuration information.  
Signaling Type  
Type of signaling used by the voice port that was  
configured using the Signaling Type configuration option  
on the Voice Ports screen. See the Technical Reference  
for configuration information.  
Call Progress  
TX ABCD bits  
Current condition of the port.  
Current value of the ABCD signaling bits that are being  
transmitted to the T1 interface.  
RX ABCD bits  
T-R Control  
Current value of the ABCD signaling bits that are being  
received from the T1 interface.  
Current status of the tip and ring leads:  
H RbTo. A 48 Vdc battery is applied to the Ring lead  
and the Tip lead is opened  
H RbTg. A 48 Vdc battery is applied to the Ring lead  
and the Tip lead is grounded  
H TbRg. A 48 Vdc battery is applied to the Tip lead  
and the Ring lead is grounded  
H Ring. Ringing voltage is applied between Tip and  
Ring  
T-R Receive  
Status of what the attached device is doing with the Tip  
and Ring leads of the FXS port.  
H Loop. Tip and Ring are connected together  
H Rgnd. Ring lead is grounded by attached device  
H Open. Ring lead is not connected to either the Tip  
lead or the ground  
Trunk Cond CGA  
Displays the status of trunk conditioning (On for CGA,  
Off for no CGA).  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
7-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displaying System Information  
Displaying Cross Connect Status  
Slot assignments are made using the Cross Connect configuration option. See  
Assigning Cross Connections in Chapter 5, Setting Up, for making time slot  
assignments. Use the Cross Connect Status screen to display time slot  
assignments for:  
H
H
H
Network Channels  
DSX-1 Channels  
Ports  
Displaying Network Channels  
Use the Network Channel Display screen to display DS0 assignments for each  
DS0 on the network interface. This screen also provides information on the slot  
assignment for each NAM or APM type.  
Use the following menu sequence to display network channel information.  
Main Menu Status Cross Connect Status Network Channel Display  
Select the desired network interface: 1 for Network 1, 2 for Network 2 (only the  
Model 926x provides Network 2).  
The Network Channel Display screen displays 24 two-field entries in three rows.  
Together, each two-field entry defines the assignment for one Network interface  
time slot. The top field represents the time slot of the Network Interface. The  
bottom field represents the cross connect status of the associated (top field)  
network time slot.  
The following information is available for viewing.  
The Network Time Slot Fields (top) . . . Indicates . . .  
N01 to N24  
The Network Interface time slot (01 to 24).  
The Cross Connect Status Field  
(bottom) . . .  
Indicates . . .  
Unassgn  
SssPp  
The time slot is unassigned.  
The voice or sync data port (p) of slot (ss)  
is assigned to the Network Interface time  
slot (01 to 24).  
Netn/yy  
Network n (1 or 2) time slot yy is assigned  
to the Network Interface time slot (01 to  
24), using Clear Channel.  
Netn/yyr  
Network n (1 or 2) time slot yy is assigned  
to the Network Interface time slot (01 to  
24), using Robbed Bit Signaling (r ).  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
7-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
The Cross Connect Status Field  
(bottom) . . .  
Indicates . . .  
Dss-p/yy  
The DSX-1 on slot ss, port p, time slot yy  
is assigned to the Network Interface time  
slot (01 to 24).  
Dss-p/yyr  
RsvdAPM  
The DSX-1 on slot ss, port p, time slot yy  
is assigned to the Network Interface time  
slot (01 to 24), using Robbed Bit Signaling  
(r ).  
The time slot is assigned to an APM which  
is either:  
H failed,  
H removed or not installed, or  
H has been replaced by an APM type that  
is not compatible with the configuration.  
DDL  
The time slot is reserved for a  
management path using Direct Data Link  
(DDL).  
Slot Assignment information. NAM or APM physical slot assignment  
information appears below the time slot fields.  
The following information is available for viewing.  
Physical Slot . . .  
Identifies the assigned card type . . .  
01 to 14 (based on model)  
T1 NAM – T1 NAM.  
Empty – The slot is empty.  
02 to 05 (based on model)  
Sync Data – 4-port synchronous data APM.  
DSX-1 – 2-port Dual DSX APM.  
E&M Voice – 8-port E&M Voice APM.  
FXO Voice – 8-port FXO Voice APM.  
FXS Voice – 8-port FXS Voice APM.  
OCU (2) – 2-port OCU-DP APM.  
OCU (6) – 6-port OCU-DP APM.  
Empty – The slot is empty.  
Misconfig – The slot contains a misconfigured APM.  
Unsupport – The slot contains an unrecognized APM.  
Failed – The slot contained an APM that has been  
removed or is no longer operational.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
7-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displaying System Information  
Displaying DSX-1 Channels  
Use the Network Channel Display screen to display all of the DS0 assignments  
for each DS0 on the DSX-1 interface. This screen also provides information on  
the slot assignment for each NAM or APM type.  
Use the following menu sequence to display DSX-1 channel information.  
Main Menu Status Cross Connect Status DSX-1 Channel Display  
Select the desired DSX-1 slot and port.  
NOTE:  
The DSX-1 Channel screen will not appear if the Interface Status field on the  
DSX-1 Interface Option screen is set to Disable.  
The DSX-1 Channel Display screen displays 24 two-field entries in three rows.  
Together, each two-field entry defines the assignment for one DSX-1 interface  
time slot. The top field represents the time slot of the DSX-1 Interface. The  
bottom field represents the cross-connect status of the associated (top field)  
DSX-1 time slot.  
The following information is available for viewing.  
The DSX-1 Time Slot Fields (top) . . .  
Indicate . . .  
D01 to D24  
The DSX-1 Interface time slot (01 to 24).  
The Cross Connect Status Field  
(bottom) . . .  
Indicates the . . .  
blank  
Time slot is unassigned.  
SssPp  
Voice or sync data port (p) of slot (ss) is  
assigned to DSX-1 time slot (01 to 24).  
Netnyy  
Network Interface n (1 or 2), time slot (yy )  
is assigned to DSX-1 time slot (01 to 24),  
using Clear Channel.  
Netnyyr  
RsvdAPM  
Network Interface n (1 or 2), time slot (yy)  
is assigned to DSX-1 time slot (01 to 24),  
using Robbed Bit Signaling (r ).  
Time slot is assigned to an APM which is  
either:  
H failed,  
H removed or not installed, or  
H has been replaced by an APM type that  
is not compatible with the configuration.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
7-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
Slot Assignment information. NAM or APM physical slot assignment  
information appears below the DSX-1 interface time slot fields.  
The following information is available for viewing.  
Physical Slot . . .  
Identifies the assigned card type . . .  
01 to 14 (based on model)  
T1 NAM – T1 NAM.  
Empty – The slot is empty.  
02 to 05 (based on model)  
Sync Data – 4-port synchronous data APM.  
DSX-1 – 2-port Dual DSX APM.  
E&M Voice – 8-port E&M Voice APM.  
FXO Voice – 8-port FXO Voice APM.  
FXS Voice – 8-port FXS Voice APM.  
OCU (2) – 2-port OCU-DP APM.  
OCU (6) – 6-port OCU-DP APM.  
Empty – The slot is empty.  
Misconfig – The slot contains a misconfigured APM.  
Unsupport – The slot contains an unrecognized APM.  
Failed – The slot contained an APM that has been  
removed or is no longer operational.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
7-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
Displaying Port Assignments  
Use the Port Assignments Display screen to display port assignment information  
for each voice and data port on the NAM and APMs.  
Use the following menu sequence to display port assignment information.  
Main Menu Status Cross Connect Status Port Assignment Display  
The following information is available for viewing.  
View this field . . .  
To find the . . .  
Slot  
Slot number.  
Type  
Type of NAM or APM occupying the slot. Possible  
values are:  
T1 NAM – T1 NAM.  
Sync Data – 4-port synchronous data APM.  
DSX-1 – 2-port DSX APM.  
E&M Voice – 8-port E&M APM.  
FXO Voice – 8-port FXO Voice APM.  
FXS Voice – 8-port FXS Voice APM.  
OCU (2) – 2-port OCU-DP APM.  
OCU (6) – 6-port OCU-DP APM.  
Empty – The slot is empty.  
Misconfig – The slot contains a misconfigured APM.  
Unsupport – The slot contains an unrecognized APM.  
Failed – The slot contained an APM that has been  
removed or is no longer operational.  
Assignment  
Port assignment. Possible values are:  
Blank – slot is empty or port does not exist on the NAM  
or the APM.  
Disable – The port is disabled.  
Unassgn – The port is unassigned.  
Netn – The port is assigned to the Network Interface 1  
or 2.  
DSXss-p – The port is assigned to the DSX-1 interface  
in slot ss (always 01), port p on a clear channel time  
slot. Ports cannot be cross-connected to the DSX APM.  
SssPp – The port-to-port assignment of the slot (ss)  
and sync data port (p) shown in this field.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
7-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
Displaying Device Name and SNMP System Identification Information  
Use the Device Name screen to display the name of the device, SNMP system  
name, location, and contact name for the device.  
Use the following menu sequence to display device name and SNMP system  
identification information.  
Main Menu Control Device Name  
The following information is available for viewing.  
View this field . . .  
Device Name  
To find the administratively-assigned. . .  
Name of the device for device identification.  
Name for this SNMP-managed node.  
System Name  
System Location  
System Contact  
Physical location of this SNMP-managed node.  
System contact person for this SNMP node.  
Viewing Network and Sync Data Performance  
Statistics  
Use the Network Performance Statistics screen to display a complete view of the  
performance of the network interface and the port interface over the previous  
24-hour period. Use the Sync Data Performance Statistics screen to display a  
complete view of the performance of the network interface and the port interface  
over the previous 8-hour period. Statistics are defined in AT&T Technical  
Reference (TR) 54016.  
What Statistics Can Be Collected?  
You can collect the following metrics:  
H
H
H
Errored Seconds (ES) – Any second with one or more ESF Error events.  
Unavailable Seconds (UAS) – Any second in which service is unavailable.  
Severely Errored Seconds (SES) – Any second with 320 or more CRC  
errors or one or more Out Of Frame (OOF) events.  
H
H
Bursty Errored Seconds (BES) – Any second with more than one but less  
than 320 CRC errors.  
Controlled Slip Seconds (CSS) – Any second with one or more controlled  
slips (a replication or deletion of a DS1 frame by the receiving device). This is  
collected for network performance statistics only.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
7-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
H
H
Loss of Frame Count (LOFC) – The number of Loss of Frame conditions.  
Complete – Indicates whether or not the 15 minutes worth of far-end  
statistics contain 900 seconds worth of statistics. Bad T1 network conditions  
or a loopback test can prevent far-end statistics from reaching the T1 access  
unit. If one or more seconds of far-end performance statistics are missing,  
then this field displays No. Otherwise, Yes is displayed. This field appears on  
the Sync Data Performance Statistics screen only.  
Network Performance Statistics  
For the network performance statistics, these metrics are kept for each 15-minute  
interval over the past 24-hour period. A Telco set and a user set are kept for each  
metric. The user set is a copy of the Telco set, but the user set can be cleared.  
In addition to the metrics kept for the network interface, the value of the Status  
Event Register is kept for each 15-minute interval (user count only). The system  
records the occurrence of the following events in the Status column:  
H
H
H
H
H
H
Yellow Alarm (Y)  
Loss of Signal (L)  
Excessive Error Rate (E)  
Frame Synchronization Bit Error (F)  
Line Code Violation (V)  
None  
NOTE:  
Network performance statistics are only available for those interfaces using  
ESF framing. Verify that the Line Framing Format field on the Network  
Interface screen is set to ESF.  
To help you in selecting trouble spots, a Worst Interval is displayed on Line 18.  
The Worst Interval contains the largest number of seconds for either ES, UAS,  
SES, BES, or CSS, or the greatest Loss of Frame Count (LOFC). If more than  
one interval contains the same worst value, then the oldest interval is displayed.  
Sync Data Performance Statistics  
For the sync data performance statistics, these metrics are kept for each  
15-minute interval over the past 8-hour period. Both near-end and far-end  
statistics are kept.  
To help you in selecting trouble spots, a Worst Interval is displayed on Line 18 for  
both near-end and far-end values. The Worst Interval contains the largest number  
of seconds for either ES, UAS, SES, BES, or the greatest LOFC. If more than  
one interval contains the same worst value, then the oldest interval is displayed.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
7-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
Displaying Performance Statistics  
Use the following menu sequence to display network performance statistics.  
Main Menu Status Performance Statistics Network  
For Network statistics, you must select the Network Interface (1 or 2) for which  
you want to display statistics. Only the Model 926x provides Network 2.  
Use the following menu sequence to display sync data performance statistics.  
Main Menu Status Performance Statistics Sync Data Port  
For Sync Data statistics, you must select the desired slot and port for which to  
collect statistics.  
Selecting Performance Statistics Intervals for Display  
Only seven intervals appear on the screen at any one time. You can choose  
which intervals to display on your screen by entering:  
H
H
Interval Number, or  
Time  
NOTE:  
Interval 01 is the interval occurring just prior to the current one; Interval 02 is  
2 intervals prior to the current one, etc.  
To select intervals . . .  
You must enter an interval or time on . . .  
Occurring on and after a  
selected interval or time  
Line 16. The display will include the selected interval plus  
the 6 intervals recorded after it.  
Occurring on and before a  
selected interval or time  
Line 10. The display will include the selected interval plus  
the 6 intervals recorded before it.  
Bracketing a selected  
interval or time  
Line 13. The display will include the selected interval plus  
the 3 intervals recorded before it and the 3 intervals  
recorded after it.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
7-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
Example of Network Performance Statistics Screen  
main/status/performance/network  
Device Name: Node A  
9162  
01/26/96 23:32  
NETWORK 1 PERFORMANCE STATISTICS  
ESF Error Events  
Telco = 15 User = 12  
Current Interval Timer  
Telco=124 User = 124  
–––ES–– ––UAS–– ––SES–– ––BES–– ––CSS–– –LOFC–– -Status-  
Time  
Tel Usr Tel Usr Tel Usr Tel Usr Tel Usr Tel Usr  
(User)  
Y
Current: 10:37  
Int 01: 10:35  
Int 02: 10:20  
Int 03: 10:05  
Int 04: 09:50  
Int 05: 09:35  
Int 06: 09:20  
Int 07: 09:05  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
none  
none  
none  
none  
none  
none  
none  
Line 10  
Line 13  
Line 16  
Line 18  
Worst Interval: 24 24  
Tel Tot(valid 96): 00010  
Usr Tot(valid 96): 00010  
14 14  
00000  
00000  
14 14  
00000  
00000  
09 09  
00000  
00000  
18 16  
002  
002  
44 44  
003  
003  
––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––  
Ctrl-a to access these functions, ESC for previous menu MainMenu Exit  
Refresh PgDn PgUp ClrStats  
Example of Sync Data Performance Statistics Screen  
main/status/performance/port  
Device Name: Node A  
9162  
01/26/96 23:32  
SYNC DATA PORT PERFORMANCE STATISTICS  
Current Interval Timer  
Error Events  
Near=3 Far=10  
Near=32  
Far=120  
Slot 03 Data Port 4  
–––ES–– ––UAS–– ––SES–– ––BES–– ––LOFC–– -Complete-  
Near Far Near Far Near Far Near Far Near Far  
Far  
no  
Current: 10:37  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Int 01: 10:35  
Int 02: 10:20  
Int 03: 10:05  
Int 04: 09:50  
Int 05: 09:35  
Int 06: 09:20  
Int 07: 09:05  
yes  
yes  
yes  
yes  
yes  
yes  
yes  
Line 10  
Line 13  
Line 16  
Line 18  
Worst Interval: 28 09  
Near Tot(valid 32): 00010  
Far Tot(valid 32): 00010  
14 18  
00009  
00009  
18 18  
00004  
00004  
24 24  
00000  
00000  
10 10  
000  
000  
no  
––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––  
Ctrl-a to access these functions, ESC for previous menu MainMenu Exit  
Refresh  
PgDn PgUp  
ClrNear ClrFar  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
7-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displaying System Information  
Clearing Performance Statistics  
Use the following menu sequence to clear performance statistics.  
Main Menu Status Clear Statistics  
You can also use the ClrStats function at the bottom of the Performance Statistics  
screen.  
To clear all . . .  
Select . . .  
User performance registers, including  
network and ports statistics  
All  
User performance registers for the  
selected Network Interface  
Network 1 or Network 2 (only the Model  
926x provides Network 2)  
Performance registers for all Sync Data  
ports  
All Sync Data Ports  
NOTE:  
You can only clear User statistics. Telco statistics cannot be cleared.  
Status Information  
Select system and test status information from the Status menu:  
Main Menu Status System and Test Status  
System Status Messages  
These messages, listed in alphabetical order, appear in the messages area at the  
bottom of the screens (see Table 7-1).  
Table 7-1. System Status Messages (1 of 2)  
Message  
What It Indicates  
What To Do  
Already Active  
The selected test is currently  
running.  
1. Allow test to continue.  
2. Stop the test.  
Command Complete  
Connection Refused  
A system command (save,  
clear, abort) completed  
normally.  
No action needed.  
User interface is in use. This  
will only appear during  
Wait and try again.  
initiation of a Telnet session.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
7-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
Table 7-1. System Status Messages (2 of 2)  
Message  
What It Indicates  
What To Do  
Please Wait  
Command takes longer than  
5 seconds.  
1. Wait until message clears.  
2. If the message does not  
clear within 2 minutes, reset  
the device.  
User Interface Already Access to the user interface  
1. Wait and try again.  
in Use  
via Telnet is in use; access to  
the interface is denied.  
2. Contact IP address user  
and request that they log  
off.  
IP address and login of the  
user currently accessing the  
interface are also provided.  
User Interface Idle  
Previously active session is  
now closed/ended, and  
access via the COM port is  
now available.  
Log onto the access unit.  
Session has ended due to  
timeout.  
Normal condition; no action  
needed.  
System Health and Test Status Messages  
The System and Test Status screen (Path: mainstatussystemtest status)  
displays the following types of messages:  
H
H
H
Health and Status – Displays Health and status information in priority order  
(highest to lowest).  
Self-Test Results – Displays the results of the power-up self-test  
diagnostics.  
Test Status – Indicates which tests are currently active.  
Health and Status Messages  
These messages appear in the first column of the System and Test Status screen  
in priority (highest to lowest) order, as shown in Table 7-2.  
Clear device failure messages from the System Health and Status screen using  
the following menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Control Clear Device Fail  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
7-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
Table 7-2. Health and Status Messages (1 of 5)  
Message  
What It Indicates  
What To Do  
System Operational  
Power Supply Alarm  
This message appears when  
there are no status messages  
to report.  
No action needed.  
A power supply or fan tray  
problem is detected on the  
system.  
1. Check that the power  
supply or fan tray is  
mounted correctly in the  
housing.  
2. Contact your service  
representative.  
LOS at Networkn  
A Loss of Signal (LOS)  
condition is detected on  
Network Interface 1 or 2.  
Clears when the ratio of ones  
to zeros received is greater  
than or equal to 12.5%.  
1. Network cable problem.  
1. Check that the network  
cable is securely attached  
at both ends.  
2. No signal is being  
transmitted at the far-end  
T1 access unit.  
2. Check far-end T1 access  
unit status.  
3. T1 facility problem.  
3. Contact your network  
provider.  
LOS at DSXss-p  
A Loss of Signal (LOS)  
condition is detected on the  
DSX-1 interface in slot ss,  
port p. Clears when the ratio of  
ones to zeros received is  
greater than or equal to  
12.5%.  
1. DSX-1 cable problem.  
1. Check that the DSX-1 cable  
is securely attached at both  
ends.  
2. No signal being transmitted 2. Check the DTE status.  
from the DTE.  
OOF at Networkn  
An Out of Frame (OOF)  
condition is detected on  
Network Interface 1 or 2.  
1. Incompatible framing format 1. Check that the framing  
between the network and  
the T1 access unit.  
format for the network  
interface is correct.  
2. Network cabling problem.  
3. T1 facility problem.  
2. Check that the network  
cable is securely attached  
at both ends.  
3. Contact your network  
provider.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
7-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displaying System Information  
Table 7-2. Health and Status Messages (2 of 5)  
Message  
What It Indicates  
What To Do  
OOF at DSXss-p  
An Out of Frame (OOF)  
condition is detected on the  
DSX-1 interface in slot ss,  
port p.  
1. Incompatible framing format 1. Check that the framing  
between the DTE and the  
T1 access unit.  
format for the DSX-1 (DTE)  
interface is correct.  
2. DSX-1 cabling problem.  
2. Check that the DSX-1 cable  
is securely attached at both  
ends.  
AIS at Networkn  
An Alarm Indication Signal  
(AIS) is received by Network  
Interface 1 or 2. AIS is an  
unframed, all ones signal.  
1. Upstream T1 access unit is 1. Check status of upstream  
transmitting AIS (keep-alive  
signal).  
T1 access unit(s).  
2. The network is transmitting 2. Report problem to carrier.  
an AIS.  
AIS at DSXss-p  
An Alarm Indication Signal  
Check the DTE attached to  
(AIS) is received by the DSX-1 the DSX-1 interface.  
interface in slot ss, port p. AIS  
is an unframed, all ones  
signal.  
EER at Networkn  
The error rate of the received  
network signal exceeds the  
currently configured threshold.  
This condition only occurs if  
Network Interface 1 or 2 is  
configured for ESF framing.  
This condition clears when the  
error rate falls below the  
threshold value.  
Contact network provider.  
Yellow at Networkn  
A yellow alarm signal is  
received on Network  
Interface 1 or 2.  
1. Network cable problem.  
1. Check that your network  
cable is securely attached  
at both ends.  
2. Far-end T1 access unit has 2. Check the status of the  
lost framing sync on the T1  
line.  
far-end device.  
3. T1 facility problem.  
3. Contact your network  
provider.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
7-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displaying System Information  
Table 7-2. Health and Status Messages (3 of 5)  
Message  
What It Indicates  
What To Do  
Yellow at DSXss-p  
A yellow alarm signal is  
received on the DSX-1  
interface in slot ss, port p.  
DTE has detected an LOS or  
OOF condition.  
1. Check that the DSX-1 cable  
is securely attached at both  
ends.  
2. Check the status of the  
attached equipment.  
APM Card Failed,  
Slot ss  
The NAM detects an APM  
failure for the identified slot.  
1. Check if APM is removed  
from the slot.  
1
2. Remove, then reinstall the  
APM.  
3. Contact your service  
representative.  
OOF(EDL), Slot ss  
Port p  
An Out of Frame (OOF)  
condition is detected for the  
1
identified slot and port. This  
condition occurs when any two  
of five consecutive frame  
synchronizing bits received  
from the remote unit are  
incorrect. This condition clears  
when a reframe occurs.  
1. Cabling problem.  
2. T1 facility problem.  
1. Check that the far end is  
configured for EDL.  
2. Contact your network  
provider.  
EER, Slot ss Port p  
An Excessive Error Rate  
(EER) condition is detected for  
the identified slot and port.  
Contact network provider.  
1
Loss of Signal, Slot ss A Loss of Signal (LOS)  
1. Check that the DSU is  
powered up.  
Port p  
condition has been detected  
on the identified OCU-DP  
interface. An LOS is declared  
when a signal has been  
absent on the local loop for  
more than two consecutive  
seconds.  
2. Check the cable.  
Abnormal Station  
Code, Slot ss Port p  
An Abnormal Station Code is  
being received from the  
network DS0 for the identified  
OCU-DP interface. This  
condition indicates that the  
far-end DSU is disconnected  
or powered-off.  
1. Check the that the far-end  
DSU is operational.  
2. Check the cable to the  
far-end DSU.  
1
ss represents physical slots.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
7-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displaying System Information  
Table 7-2. Health and Status Messages (4 of 5)  
Message  
What It Indicates  
What To Do  
64KCC Loop OOF,  
Slot ss Port p  
An Out of Frame (OOF)  
condition has been detected  
for the identified OCU-DP  
interface.  
1. Check the that DSU is  
configured for the correct  
speed.  
2. Check the cable to ensure  
that the pairs are not  
crossed.  
DDS Net Failure, Slot  
ss Port p, cccccc  
The identified OCU-DP  
Contact the DDS service  
provider.  
interface is receiving a DDS  
network code of cccccc from  
the network. This is a 6-bit  
code representing bits 2–7 of  
the DS0 code defined in AT&T  
PUB 62310. The least  
significant bit is to the left.  
Loss of Loop Timing,  
Slot ss Port p, cccccc  
The identified OCU-DP  
interface cannot recover  
timing from the received signal rate.  
on the local loop. This typically  
occurs when the CPE  
Check that the CPE CSU/DSU  
rate matches the OCU-DP  
CSU/DSU is misconfigured for  
the wrong rate (e.g., 19.2  
kbps) when the OCU-DP is  
configured for 56K or  
Switched 56 operation.  
Primary Clock Failed  
A failure of the primary clock  
source configured for the NAM  
is detected and the secondary  
clock is providing the timing  
for the NAM. This condition  
clears when the configured  
primary clock is restored.  
1. If the primary clock was  
derived from the network,  
contact the network  
provider.  
2. Check the clock source  
connector.  
Secondary Clock  
Failed  
A failure of the secondary  
clock source configured for the  
NAM is detected and the  
internal clock is providing the  
timing for the NAM. The clock  
source will not automatically  
switch from internal until the  
primary clock source returns.  
1. If the secondary clock was  
derived from the network,  
contact the network  
provider.  
2. Check the clock source  
connector.  
Network Com Link  
Down  
The network communication  
link is down for the COM port.  
This condition occurs only  
when the COM port is  
configured for Net Link and  
communications between the  
management system and the  
T1 access unit is not currently  
possible for the port.  
1. Check that the Port Use  
configuration option is  
properly set (see the  
Technical Reference for  
configuration option  
information).  
2. Check cables.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
7-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displaying System Information  
Table 7-2. Health and Status Messages (5 of 5)  
Message  
What It Indicates  
What To Do  
Device Fail yyyyyyyy  
The operating software  
Contact your service  
representative.  
detects an internal error.  
(yyyyyyyy represents an  
eight-digit hexadecimal failure  
code for use by service  
personnel) This condition  
clears after a reset of the unit.  
Module MisConfig,  
Slot ss  
The APM in slot xx is not the  
one specified in the NAM’s  
configuration table.  
1. Replace the APM with the  
type of APM specified by  
the configuration table.  
1, 2  
2. Change the current  
configuration to reflect the  
type of APM in the slot. To  
do this, edit the  
configuration, accept the  
APM, then save the  
configuration.  
Module Unsupported,  
Slot ss  
The NAM does not recognize  
the APM.  
1. Check that an E&M Voice  
APM, FXS Voice APM,  
1, 2  
FXO Voice APM, Dual DSX  
APM, or Sync Data APM is  
1
installed in Slot ss.  
2. For Model 926x T1 Access  
Mux, check that there is not  
more than one DSX APM  
installed (only one is  
supported).  
3. Re-download the NAM  
software if new APMs are  
supported in later releases.  
4. Replace the APM.  
5. Contact your service  
representative.  
A Dual DSX APM has been  
installed in a Model 916x T1  
Access Unit.  
Remove the Dual DSX APM.  
1
ss represents physical slots.  
Does not apply to the access carrier.  
2
Self-Test Results Messages  
All self-test results messages appear in the middle column of the System and  
Test Status screen (see Table 7-3).  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
7-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
Table 7-3. Self-Test Results Messages  
Message  
What It Indicates  
What To Do  
CPU Fail  
The CPU failed internal  
testing.  
1. Reset the unit and try  
again.  
2. Call your service  
representative for  
assistance.  
3. Return the unit to the  
factory.  
NAM Fail  
One or more of the NAM’s  
integrated circuit chips failed  
internal device level testing.  
1. Reset the unit and try  
again.  
2. Call your service  
representative for  
assistance.  
3. Return the unit to the  
factory.  
Networkn T1 Fail  
DSXss-p T1 Fail  
Memory Fail  
The NAM failed to internally  
loop data on the selected  
Network T1 circuit.  
1. Reset the unit and try  
again.  
2. Call your service  
representative for  
assistance.  
3. Return the unit to the  
factory.  
The NAM failed to internally  
loop data on the selected  
DSX-1 circuit.  
1. Reset the unit and try  
again.  
2. Call your service  
representative for  
assistance.  
3. Return the unit to the  
factory.  
The unit failed memory  
verification.  
1. Reset the unit and try  
again.  
2. Call your service  
representative for  
assistance.  
3. Return the unit to the  
factory.  
Failure xxxxxxxx  
Passed  
An internal failure occurred.  
(xxxxxxxx represents an  
eight-digit hexadecimal failure representative.  
code for use by service  
personnel.)  
Record the failure code and  
contact your service  
No problems were found  
during power-up.  
No action needed; no  
problems were found during  
power-up or reset.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
7-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
Test Status Messages  
The right-most column of the System and Test Status screen display the tests  
that are currently active on the card (NAM or APM) (see Table 7-4).  
Table 7-4. Test Status Messages (1 of 2)  
Message  
What It Indicates  
No Test Active  
No tests are currently running.  
Networkn LLB Test Active  
A network Line Loopback (LLB) test is active on specified  
Network interface (n).  
DSXss-p LLB Test Active  
Networkn PLB Test Active  
DSXss-p PLB Test Active  
Networkn RLB Test Active  
DSXss-p RLB Test Active  
DCLB, Slot ss Port p  
A DSX-1 Line Loopback (LLB) test is active on slot ss,  
port p.  
A network Payload Loopback (PLB) test is active on  
specified Network interface (n).  
A DSX-1 Payload Loopback (PLB) test is active on slot ss,  
port p.  
A network Repeater Loopback (RLB) test is active on  
specified network interface (n).  
A DSX-1 Repeater Loopback (RLB) test is active on slot  
ss, port p.  
A Data Channel Loopback (DCLB) test is active on slot ss,  
port p.  
DTLB, Slot ss Port p  
A Data Terminal Loopback (DTLB) test is active on slot ss,  
port p.  
DTPLB, Slot ss Port p  
A Data Terminal Payload Loopback (DTPLB) test is active  
on slot ss, port p.  
Latching OCU LB, Slot ss  
Port p  
A Latching OCU Loopback test is on the OCU-DP  
interface in slot ss, port p.  
Non-Latching OCU LB,  
Slot ss Port p  
A Nonlatching OCU Loopback test is on the OCU-DP  
interface in slot ss, port p.  
Latching CSU LB, Slot ss  
Port p  
A Latching CSU Loopback test is on the OCU-DP  
interface in slot ss, port p.  
Non-Latching CSU LB,  
Slot ss Port p  
A Nonlatching CSU Loopback test is on the OCU-DP  
interface in slot ss, port p.  
Latching DSU LB, Slot ss  
Port p  
A Latching DSU Loopback test is on the OCU-DP  
interface in slot ss, port p.  
Non-Latching DSU LB,  
Slot ss Port p  
A Nonlatching DSU Loopback test is on the OCU-DP  
interface in slot ss, port p.  
OCU Line LB, Slot ss  
Port p  
An OCU Line Loopback test is on the OCU-DP interface in  
slot ss, port p.  
OCU Data LB, Slot ss  
Port p  
An OCU Data Loopback test is on the OCU-DP interface  
in slot ss, port p.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
7-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
Table 7-4. Test Status Messages (2 of 2)  
Message  
What It Indicates  
OCU DS-0 LB, Slot ss  
Port p  
An DS0 Loopback test is on the OCU-DP interface in  
slot ss, port p.  
Voice DLB, Slot ss Port p  
A voice Digital Loopback (DLB) test is active on slot ss,  
port p.  
Voice ALB, Slot ss Port p  
Voice LLB, Slot ss Port p  
A voice Analog Loopback (ALB) is active on slot ss, port p.  
A voice Line Loopback (LLB) test is active on slot ss,  
port p.  
Voice DRS, Slot ss Port p  
Voice Quiet, Slot ss Port p  
A voice Digital Reference (DRS) test is active on slot ss,  
port p.  
A voice quiet tone test is active on slot ss, port p.  
A forced signaling test is active on slot ss, port p.  
Forced Signal, Slot ss  
Port p  
Pttn Active, [Networkn]  
A pttn test (test patterns for Network 1 or Network 2 ) is  
active on Network n.  
Pttn Active, [DSXss-p]  
A pttn test (test patterns for the DSX-1 interface in slot ss,  
port p) is active.  
Pttn Active, [Slot ss Port p] A pttn test (test patterns for Sync Data port) is active on  
slot ss, port p.  
Mon Pttn, [Network n]  
Mon Pttn, [DSXss-p]  
Mon Pttn, [Slot ss Port p]  
Lamp Test Active  
A Monitor pttn (test patterns for the Network 1 or  
Network 2) is active on Network n.  
A Monitor pttn (test patterns for the DSX-1 interface in  
slot ss, port p) is active.  
A Monitor pttn (test patterns for the Sync Data port) is  
active on slot ss, port p.  
The Lamp Test is active, causing all LEDs on the T1 NAM  
and APMs to blink.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
7-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displaying System Information  
This page intentionally left blank.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
7-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operation and Maintenance  
8
Startup  
If security requiring logins has been set up, follow the instructions in Logging In  
below. Otherwise, follow the instructions in Starting a Session on page 8-2.  
Logging In  
When there is no contention for the user interface and a login is required, you are  
presented with the Login screen. Up to 10 characters can be entered in the  
Login ID and Password fields. Valid characters include the following:  
H
H
H
0 through 9  
a through z  
A through Z  
" Procedure  
To log in:  
1. Enter your assigned login ID, and press Return.  
2. Enter your password, and press Return.  
An asterisk (*) appears in the field for each character entered.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
8-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation and Maintenance  
If the Login ID/Password  
combination is . . .  
Then the . . .  
Valid  
Main Menu appears. Begin your session.  
Invalid  
Message Invalid Password is displayed on line 24,  
and the Login screen is redisplayed.  
If an invalid Login ID/Password combination is  
entered 3 consecutive times,  
– The current Telnet session is closed.  
– The User Interface Idle screen appears with a  
directly-connected terminal.  
– An external modem is disconnected.  
– An SNMP trap will be generated, if so  
configured.  
Access is denied. See your system administrator to  
verify your login (Login ID/Password combination).  
Logging Out  
When a login is required and a timeout occurs, you are automatically logged out.  
You will be prompted for your login next time you try to use the interface.  
You can also end a session using the screen function area of the user interface.  
" Procedure  
To log out:  
1. Press Ctrl-a to switch from the screen area to the screen function key area.  
2. Select Exit by entering e or E and pressing Return. The session is ended.  
Starting a Session  
Depending on how your T1 access unit is configured, you can start a session  
using one of the following methods:  
H
H
H
H
Dialing in through an external modem to the COM port.  
Direct connection over the COM port.  
Telnet session over the COM port.  
Telnet session through an in-band management channel through the T1  
network.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
8-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation and Maintenance  
" Procedure  
Upon beginning a session, the User Interface Idle screen is displayed. To  
activate:  
1. Press Return.  
2. One of the following occurs:  
If . . .  
Then . . .  
What to do now?  
Security is disabled  
The Main Menu screen  
appears.  
Begin your session.  
Security is enabled  
You are prompted for a  
login ID and password.  
Enter your ID and password.  
If Invalid Password  
appears, see System Error  
Messages in Chapter 9,  
Troubleshooting.  
You are attempting to  
access through Telnet  
and the user interface is  
currently in session  
The message  
Wait and try again.  
Connection refused:  
appears. (T1 access unit  
allows only one  
connection at a time.)  
You are attempting direct The message User  
access through the COM Interface Already In  
See System Status  
Messages in Chapter 7,  
Displaying System  
port and the user  
Use appears with the  
interface is currently in  
session via an in-band  
Telnet session  
active user’s IP address. Information.  
The T1 access unit has  
the Communication Port appears.  
and Login Required  
configuration options  
enabled and there is no  
contention for the user  
interface  
The Login screen  
Enter your ID and password.  
If Invalid Password  
appears, see System Error  
Messages in Chapter 9,  
Troubleshooting.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
8-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation and Maintenance  
Ending a Session  
Use the Exit function key from any screen to terminate the session.  
" Procedure  
To end a session:  
1. Press Ctrl-a to go to the screen function key area.  
2. Select Exit and press Return.  
If connected through . . . Then the . . .  
Direct connection via the  
COM port  
Idle screen appears.  
Telnet or some other  
modem connection  
Connection is dropped and the screen is cleared.  
3. If ending a configuration editing session, the Save Configuration screen  
appears with the Save Changes? prompt.  
If you select . . .  
Then the . . .  
No  
Session is terminated without the configuration option  
changes being saved.  
Yes  
Save Configuration To screen appears. Select a  
configuration option area to save your changes to  
(Current, Customer 1, or Customer 2), and press  
Return.  
Configuration option changes are saved and the  
session is terminated.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
8-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation and Maintenance  
Supported SNMP Traps  
A trap is an unsolicited message that is sent from the T1 access unit to the SNMP  
trap manager when the T1 access unit detects certain prespecified conditions.  
These traps enable the SNMP manager to gauge the state of the network.  
The T1 access unit supports the following traps:  
H
H
H
H
H
warm-start  
authentication-failure  
enterprise-specific (those specific to T1 access unit)  
link-up  
link-down  
Refer to Appendix D, SNMP Cross-Reference, for more information on traps.  
Dialing Out and Sending SNMP Traps  
You can control whether generated SNMP trap messages will initiate a call if a  
connection on the COM port external device has not already been established.  
Use the Alarms Options screen to enable the T1 access unit’s automatic call  
initiation (dial out) on the COM port external device to send an SNMP trap  
message.  
" Procedure  
1. Assign SNMP Trap Managers. See Setting Up SNMP NMS Security in  
Chapter 5, Setting Up.  
2. Select desired SNMP traps.  
Main Menu Configuration Management and Communication →  
SNMP Traps  
3. Configure the phone directories for dialing out alarms via the Control COM  
Port Call Setup branch. Set up the A directory as the primary alarm directory.  
You can also set up an alternate directory; refer to Displaying Directory  
Numbers on page 8-6 and Changing Directory Numbers on page 8-7.  
4. Specify the IP address(es) of the NMS to send traps to when dialing out. Use  
the Configuration Management and Communication SNMP NMS  
Security branch; refer to Appendix C, SNMP Traps.  
5. Enable the Call Retry and Alarm & Trap Dial-Out configuration options to hold  
the call if it cannot be completed. The call is held until completed, or the  
maximum retry count (maximum 5) has been exceeded. You can also set the  
delay time and specify an alternate directory, if desired.  
Follow this menu selection sequence to display the Load Configuration From  
screen:  
Main Menu Configuration [Current Configuration/  
Customer Configuration 1/Customer Configuration 2]  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
8-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation and Maintenance  
6. Follow this menu selection sequence, pressing Return after each selection:  
Configuration Edit/Display Alarm  
The Alarm Options screen appears.  
7. Select and set the following configuration options, as appropriate.  
To . . .  
Set the configuration option . . .  
Alarm & Trap Dial-Out to Enable.  
H Call Retry to Enable  
Automatically initiate a call (dial out)  
Retry the call if the call cannot be  
completed  
H Dial-Out Delay Time to the desired  
number of minutes  
H Alternate Dial-Out Directory to the  
desired directory  
Specify whether to disconnect  
immediately after dialing out traps, or to  
allow a manual disconnect to occur. (A  
connection remains until manually  
disconnected.)  
Trap Disconnect to Enable.  
8. Press Ctrl-a to switch to the screen function key area.  
9. To save changes, select Save and press Return.  
10. Select the configuration area where you want to save the changes to and  
press Return.  
When Save is complete, Command Complete appears at the bottom of the  
screen.  
Maintaining COM Port Directories  
Two Control menu selections are dedicated to dialing a remote device for  
management:  
Select . . .  
To . . .  
COM Port Call Setup  
Select a phone directory and view its phone number, or  
to initiate and terminate external modem connections  
over the FrameSaver unit’s COM port. Used for  
management.  
COM Port Call Directories  
Change the phone number contained in a selected  
directory when using an external modem.  
Displaying Directory Numbers  
Use the COM Port Call Setup screen to display the telephone number of the  
remote device.  
Main Menu Control COM Port Call Setup  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
8-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation and Maintenance  
Changing Directory Numbers  
Use the COM Port Call Directories screen to change the phone number  
contained in a selected directory. The T1 access unit ships with all directory  
phone numbers blank.  
" Procedure  
To change directory phone numbers:  
1. Use the following menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Control COM Port Call Directories  
2. To select the directory to be changed, press the number of the desired  
directory (1 through 5, or A for Alarm) and press Return. The phone number  
for that directory appears.  
3. Review or change the phone number. Enter a number of up to 40 characters.  
Make sure only valid characters are entered when changing the phone  
number. Valid characters:  
— Numbers 0–9  
— Lowercase letters a–z  
— Uppercase letters A–Z  
— Space ( ) character  
— ASCII symbols with the exception of the caret (^)  
— Control sequence using the caret (^)  
4. Press Ctrl-a to switch to the screen function key area.  
5. To save changes, select Save and press Return.  
When Save is complete, Command Complete appears at the bottom of the  
screen.  
Changing Device Name  
Use the Device Name screen to change the  
H
H
H
H
Device Name  
System Name  
System Location  
System Contact  
Use any ASCII characters. Your entry in each field will overwrite existing  
information. Use Clear to erase all characters in the current field.  
Main Menu Control Device Name  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
8-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation and Maintenance  
Hot Swapping of APMs  
The T1 access unit allows you to insert and remove APM cards and their  
matching I/O cards without powering down the unit or interrupting data on the  
network or on other APMs. The T1 access unit automatically recognizes when an  
APM is inserted or removed, and can display the configuration option settings  
and MIB objects applicable to the APM that was inserted or removed.  
NOTE:  
You do not have access to screens and configuration options that are not  
valid for the given configuration, nor can you preconfigure or predelete a  
configuration for an APM prior to inserting it in the housing. To see  
configuration options for an inserted APM, you must exit the configuration  
screen, then reenter it.  
APM Insertion  
Insertion of an APM into a housing occurs under one of the following three  
conditions.  
If the slot previously . . . Then . . .  
Was unassigned  
The configuration options for this new APM will be set to  
factory defaults and will be accessible from the MIB and the  
async terminal.  
Contained the same type The existing configuration options will be used and will be  
of APM accessible from the MIB and the async terminal.  
Contained a different type The system will generate a Module Misconfiguration alarm  
of APM  
and trap for the selected slot. The screens and field choices  
applicable to this APM will not be displayed until you accept  
the APM upon loading or saving a configuration, or via an  
enterprise MIB. When you accept the new APM, the  
previous APM’s configuration is deleted, the new APM’s  
configuration options are set to factory defaults, and the  
screens and field choices applicable to the new APM will be  
displayed.  
If you reject the APM, the configuration options for the  
previous APM can be edited, but all other configuration  
options and screens will not display fields or choices or MIB  
objects applicable to either the previous or the current APM.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
8-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation and Maintenance  
APM Removal  
When you remove an APM from its slot, you can still edit the applicable  
configuration options. If you are displaying a Status or Test screen when you  
remove an APM,  
H
H
H
The message APM Removed will display after the screen is refreshed and  
all fields relating to the APM will be cleared.  
Only the ESC (Previous menu), Main Menu, and Exit virtual functions will be  
available when no other valid slots are available to select.  
MIB objects applicable to the removed APM, and attempts to do a get or set  
of those objects will display the message No Such Name.  
NAM Removal  
Although you can safely remove the T1 NAM from the housing with power on, the  
T1 access unit does not support hot swapping of the T1 NAM. All APM  
configurations travel with the NAM.  
Downloading Software  
The access unit is capable of accepting a software download from a PC through  
its COM port to support a file transfer or software upgrade. The Download feature  
is used only by your service representative to update your access unit.  
File Transfer  
The T1 access unit supports a standard File Transfer Protocol (FTP) server over  
Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) to allow you to transfer configuration and  
program files to/from a T1 access unit node. A complete binary image of the  
configuration can be copied to a host to provide a backup. The T1 access unit  
must be configured to support FTP sessions.  
Initiate an FTP session to a T1 access unit node in the same way as you would  
initiate an FTP to any other IP-addressable device.  
Be aware of the following rules when doing a file transfer:  
H
H
H
You must have Access Level 1 permission to use the put command.  
You cannot put a file to the factory.cfg file under the system directory.  
You can only put a NAM program file (nam1_ctl.ocd, nam2_low.ocd, or  
nam3_hi.ocd) to a T1 access unit. It cannot be uploaded from a node to a  
host.  
H
H
You must change to the /system directory.  
Before putting a download file, you must use the bin binary command to  
place the data connection in Binary mode.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
8-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation and Maintenance  
" Procedure  
To initiate an FTP session:  
1. Start the FTP client program on your host. For example, on a Unix host, type  
ftp, followed by the IP address of the T1 access unit.  
2. If a login and password are required (see Creating a Login in Chapter 6,  
Security), you are prompted to enter them here. The FTP prompt appears.  
3. The starting directory is the root directory (/). The following are available in  
the /system directory: nam1_ctl.ocd, nam2_low.ocd, nam3_hi.ocd,  
current.cfg, factory.cfg, cust1.cfg, cust2.cfg. Use the standard FTP  
commands during the FTP session, as well as the following remote FTP  
commands.  
Command  
Definition  
cd directory  
Change the current directory on the access unit to directory.  
dir [directory] or  
ls-1  
Print a listing of the directory contents in the directory directory.  
If no directory is specified, the current one is used.  
get file1 [file2]  
Copy a file from the remote directory of the T1 access unit  
node to the local directory on the host.  
remotehelp  
[command]  
Print the meaning of the command. If no argument is given, a  
list of all known commands is printed.  
ls [directory]  
Print an abbreviated list of the directory contents in the  
specified directory. If no directory is specified, the current one  
is used.  
put file1 [file2]  
Copy file1 from a local directory on the host to file 2 in the  
current directory of the T1 access unit.  
recv file1 [file 2]  
send file1 [file 2]  
pwd  
Same as a get.  
Same as a put.  
Print the name of the current directory of the T1 access unit.  
Performing an Upgrade  
If you need to upgrade the NAM program code, you must transfer the following  
files in the order specified by using the put command:  
1. NAM control file (nam1_ctl.ocd)  
2. NAM Program-Low Bank (nam2_low.ocd)  
3. NAM Program-Hi Bank (nam3_hi.ocd)  
These files must all be the same version (from the same revision level) for a  
successful download.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
8-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation and Maintenance  
" Procedure  
To perform a download:  
1. Initiate an FTP session to the device that you are upgrading.  
2. Type bin to enter binary mode.  
3. Type cd system to change to the system directory.  
4. Type put nam1_ctl.ocd to perform a put to the nam1_ctl.ocd to start the  
download. If the control file is valid, the message nam1_ctl.ocd: File  
Transfer Completedisplays, the write permission will be set on the  
nam1_low.ocd, and the device will reset and enter Minimum mode. The  
Alarm LED will light and the OK LED will blink to indicate that the device has  
entered Minimum mode.  
5. Reestablish an FTP session to the device. Type open <IP address>.  
6. Type bin to enter binary mode.  
7. Type cd system to change to the system directory.  
8. Type put nam2_low.ocd to perform a put to the nam2_low.ocd to start the  
download. If a valid nam2_low.ocd (that is, it has the revision level as  
nam1_ctl.ocd) is successfully put and has the proper checksum, then the  
message nam2_low.ocd: File Transfer Completedisplays, the file  
is loaded into system memory, the write permission will be set on the  
nam3_hi.ocd, the system performs a memory bank switch, a  
reset/reinitialization occurs, and the system will stay in Minimum mode.  
9. Reestablish an FTP session to the device. Type open <IP address>.  
10. Type bin to enter binary mode.  
11. Type cd system to change to the system directory.  
12. Type put nam3_hi.ocd to perform a put to the nam3_hi.ocd to start the  
download. If a valid nam3_hi.ocd (that is, it has the revision level as the  
nam1_ctl.ocd and nam2_low.ocd files) is successfully put and has the proper  
checksum, then the message nam3_hi.ocd: File Transfer  
Completedisplays, the file is loaded into system memory, the write  
permission will be removed for both the nam2_low.ocd and the nam3_hi.ocd  
files, the system performs a reset/reinitialization, and the system will be in  
Normal mode and operating from the new program load. The download has  
successfully completed.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
8-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation and Maintenance  
Backing Up Your Configuration  
You may choose to back up your configuration files in case recovery is needed.  
The following configuration files correspond to the configuration areas in your T1  
access unit.  
Configuration File  
current.cfg  
Configuration Area  
Current  
cust1.cfg  
Customer 1  
Customer 2  
Factory  
cust2.cfg  
1
factory.cfg  
1
You cannot put to this file since it is read-only  
NOTE:  
If you maintain a backup copy of your configuration files, you should upload a  
new backup copy of your configuration from the T1 access unit after you  
upgrade to a new release of software.  
" Procedure  
To copy configuration files from the T1 access unit:  
1. Initiate an FTP session to the device that you are backing up.  
2. Type bin to enter binary mode.  
3. Type cd system to change to the system directory.  
4. Type get <filename> to perform a get of the desired file(s).  
5. Type quit to exit the FTP session.  
" Procedure  
To restore configuration files to the T1 access unit:  
1. Initiate an FTP session to the device that you are backing up.  
2. Type bin to enter binary mode.  
3. Type cd system to change to the system directory.  
4. Type put <filename> to perform a get of the desired file(s).  
5. Type quit to exit the FTP session.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
8-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation and Maintenance  
Resetting the T1 Access Unit  
You can reset the T1 access unit in four ways:  
H
H
H
Reset it from the Control menu to perform a self test  
Cycle the power to perform a self test  
Reset the configuration options to reestablish connectivity with the user  
interface  
H
Set the MIB from NMS  
Resetting the T1 Access Unit from the Control Menu  
Use this procedure to initiate a power-on selftest of the unit. This procedure also  
resets the T1 access unit.  
" Procedure  
To reset the T1 access unit from the Control menu:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Control Reset Device  
2. Select Yes. The T1 access unit reinitializes itself, performing a Device  
Self-Test.  
Restoring Access to the User Interface  
Misconfiguring the T1 access unit could render the user interface inaccessible,  
leaving it in a state where a session cannot be started via the COM port or a  
Telnet session. If this occurs, T1 access unit connectivity can be restored via a  
directly-connected terminal.  
Two methods can be used to restore access to the user interface:  
H
H
Reset COM Port – Allows you to reset the configuration options related to  
COM port usage. This also causes a device reset, where the T1 access unit  
performs a Device Self-Test. No security-related configuration options are  
changed.  
Reload Factory Defaults – Allows you to reload the Default Factory  
Configuration, resetting all of the configuration and control settings. This  
method is also useful when the user’s password(s) have been forgotten.  
Selecting this method also causes a device reset. Reload destroys the  
current configuration.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
8-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation and Maintenance  
" Procedure  
To reset COM port settings:  
1. Attach the async terminal to the COM port.  
2. At the async terminal, configure the terminal to operate at 19.2 kbps, using  
character length of 8 bits, with one stop-bit, and no parity.  
3. Ensure that any hardware or software flow control is disabled.  
4. Reset the T1 access unit, then immediately and repeatedly press Return at a  
rate of at least 1 press per second until the System Paused screen appears.  
(See Resetting the T1 Access Unit from the Control Menu to reset the unit.)  
5. Tab to the desired method, and enter yes (or y) for the selected prompt.  
If entering yes to prompt . . . Then . . .  
Reset COM Port usage  
H Port Type is set to Terminal.  
H Data Rate (Kbps) is set to 19.2.  
H Character Length is set to 8.  
H Stop Bits is set to 1.  
H Parity is set to None.  
H External Device Commands is set to Disable.  
Reload Factory Defaults  
All factory-loaded configuration and control  
settings contained in the Default Factory  
configuration area are loaded.  
If no (or n) is entered, or if no selection is made within 30 seconds, the T1  
access unit returns to the condition of operation it was in when the system  
pause was initiated, with the COM port settings returning to their configured  
states.  
If you choose yes, the T1 access unit resets itself, going through a Device  
Self-Test. Connectivity is restored and the Main Menu screen appears.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
8-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
9
What Are the Troubleshooting Features?  
The T1 access unit is designed to provide you with many years of trouble-free  
service. If a communication problem occurs, however, refer to the information in  
this chapter for possible solutions.  
The T1 access unit can:  
H
H
Detect and report faults  
Perform diagnostic tests  
Use the test jacks on the front panel of the Single and Dual T1 NAM, and the  
DSX APM to help isolate problems.  
Statistics are also collected to help you determine how long a problem has  
existed. See Chapter 7, Displaying System Information, for information on  
statistics.  
These features ensure that your T1 access unit is giving you optimum  
performance in your network.  
How Do I Know There Is a Problem?  
The T1 access unit offers three major mechanisms that alert you to possible  
problems:  
H
H
H
LEDs  
Alarms  
SNMP Traps  
If monitoring the system, the System and Test Status screen can also indicate  
that there is a problem.  
Main Menu Status System and Test Status  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
T1 NAM LEDs  
General Status LEDs  
IN  
Label Indication Color  
What It Means  
NET  
OUT  
OK  
Power and Green  
Operational  
Status  
ON – NAM has power and is operational.  
IN  
DSX  
OFF – NAM is in a power-up self-test, or there is a  
failure.  
OUT  
Test  
Jacks  
IN  
NET  
CYCLING – The unit is in Minimum mode. Requires an  
FTP download.  
MON  
OUT  
IN  
DSXMON  
ALM  
TST  
BKP  
System  
Failure/  
Self-Test  
Red  
ON – NAM has just been reset, or an error or fault  
has been detected.  
OUT  
961  
OFF – No failures have been detected.  
OK  
ALM  
Test Mode Yellow  
ON – Loopback or test pattern in progress, initiated  
locally, remotely, or from the network.  
TST  
BKP  
SIG  
OFF – No tests are active.  
NETWORK  
OOF  
ALM  
SIG  
OOF  
ALM  
1–  
Backup  
Yellow  
Not supported in this release. Remains off except during  
a Lamp Test.  
LEDs  
DSX  
OK  
POR  
2–  
T
O
K
496-15051  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
Network and DSX Interface LEDs  
Label  
Indication  
Color  
What It Means  
IN  
SIG  
Signal  
Green  
ON – A recoverable signal is present on the  
Network/DSX interface.  
NET1  
OUT  
IN  
OFF – The signal cannot be recovered from  
the Network/DSX interface. An LOS  
condition exists.  
NET2  
OUT  
Test  
Jacks  
IN  
ET1MON  
OOF  
ALM  
Out of Frame  
Alarm  
Yellow  
Yellow  
ON – At least one OOF was detected during  
the sampling period.  
OUT  
IN  
ET2MON  
OFF – No OOFs were detected during the  
sampling period.  
OUT  
9261  
ON – An alarm condition is present on the  
Network/DSX interface.  
OK  
ALM  
TST  
BKP  
SIG  
Current alarm conditions:  
H Loss of Signal (LOS)  
H Loss of Frame (LOF)  
H Excessive Error Rate (EER)  
H Yellow  
NET1  
OOF  
ALM  
SIG  
OOF  
ALM  
1–  
LEDs  
NET2  
H Alarm Indication Signal (AIS)  
OK  
POR  
OFF – No alarm condition is present on the  
Network/DSX interface.  
2–  
T
O
K
97-15647  
Port 1 and Port 2 LEDs  
Label  
Indication  
Color  
What It Means  
1-OK  
2-OK  
Operational  
Status  
Green  
ON – The interchange circuits for the port  
are in the correct state to transmit and  
receive data.  
OFF – The port is idle. Occurs if the port is  
disabled, if an EDL Out of Frame or  
EER condition is present, if a DCLB is  
active, or if the port is configured to  
monitor DTR and/or RTS and the  
lead(s) is not asserted.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
T1 NAM Test Jack Functions  
The T1 NAM has four sets of test jacks located on the upper section of the  
faceplate. Four nonintrusive access points are also provided.  
See Test Jacks on page 9-8 for more information on the test jacks.  
9161 Single T1 NAM Test Jack Functions  
DSX  
In  
DSX  
Out  
NET  
In  
NET  
Out  
In  
Out  
In  
TX  
DSX  
RX  
RX  
NET  
TX  
Internal  
Circuitry  
Out  
NET  
MON  
NET  
DSX  
DSX  
MON  
97-15195-01  
Test Jack Name  
Function  
IN  
DSX IN  
An intrusive test jack that allows a signal to be inserted  
towards the equipment attached to the DSX-1 interface by  
external test equipment.  
NET  
OUT  
IN  
DSX OUT  
An intrusive test jack that interrupts the signal coming from  
the equipment attached to the DSX-1 interface and allows it  
to be terminated by external test equipment.  
DSX  
OUT  
Test  
Jacks  
IN  
NET  
MON  
DSX MON IN  
(DSX Monitor In)  
A monitor jack that noninstrusively monitors the signal going  
into the terminal equipment (DTE).  
OUT  
IN  
DSXMON  
DSX MON OUT  
(DSX Monitor Out)  
A monitor jack that noninstrusively monitors the signal  
coming out of the terminal equipment (DTE).  
OUT  
961  
NET IN  
(Network In)  
An intrusive test jack that allows insertion of a signal toward  
the network by external test equipment.  
OK  
ALM  
NET OUT  
(Network Out)  
An intrusive test jack that interrupts the signal coming from  
the network and allows it to be terminated by external test  
equipment.  
TST  
BKP  
SIG  
NETWORK  
OOF  
ALM  
SIG  
OOF  
ALM  
1–  
NET MON IN  
(Network Monitor In)  
A monitor jack that noninstrusively monitors the transmitted  
signal going into the network. This is a composite of the  
channels allocated to the network.  
DSX  
NET MON OUT  
(Network Monitor Out)  
A monitor jack that noninstrusively monitors the received  
signal coming out of the network. This is a composite of the  
channels allocated to the network.  
OK  
POR  
2–  
T
O
K
496-15205  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
9261 Dual T1 NAM Test Jack Functions  
The T1 NAM has four sets of test jacks located on the upper section of the  
faceplate. Four nonintrusive access points are also provided.  
NET1 NET1  
NET2 NET2  
In  
Out  
In  
Out  
In  
Out  
In  
TX  
NET1  
RX  
RX  
NET2  
TX  
Internal  
Circuitry  
Out  
NET2  
MON  
NET2  
NET1  
NET1  
MON  
97-15652  
Test Jack Name  
Function  
IN  
NET1 IN  
(Network 1 In)  
An intrusive test jack that allows a signal to be inserted  
towards the Network 1 interface by external test equipment.  
NET1  
OUT  
NET1 OUT  
(Network 1 Out)  
An intrusive test jack that interrupts the signal coming from  
the Network 1 interface and allows it to be terminated by  
external test equipment.  
IN  
NET2  
OUT  
Test  
Jacks  
IN  
 N
NET1 MON IN  
(Network 1 Monitor In)  
A monitor jack that noninstrusively monitors the signal going  
into the network (a composite of all channels allocated to the  
Network 1 interface).  
OUT  
IN  
ET2MON  
NET1 MON OUT  
(Network 1 Monitor Out)  
A monitor jack that noninstrusively monitors the received  
signal coming out of the network (a composite of all channels  
allocated to the Network 1 interface).  
OUT  
9261  
OK  
NET2 IN  
(Network 2 In)  
An intrusive test jack that allows insertion of a signal toward  
equipment attached to the Network 2 interface by external  
test equipment.  
ALM  
TST  
BKP  
SIG  
NET2 OUT  
(Network 2 Out)  
An intrusive test jack that interrupts the signal coming from  
equipment attached to the Network 2 interface and allows it  
to be terminated by external test equipment.  
NET1  
OOF  
ALM  
SIG  
OOF  
ALM  
1–  
NET2 MON IN  
(Network 2 Monitor In)  
A monitor jack that noninstrusively monitors the signal going  
into the equipment attached to the Network 2 interface.  
NET2  
NET2 MON OUT  
(Network 2 Monitor Out)  
A monitor jack that noninstrusively monitors the signal  
coming out of the equipment attached to the Network 2  
interface.  
OK  
POR  
2–  
T
O
K
97-15646  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
Dual DSX APM LEDs  
DSX 1 and DSX 2 Interface LEDs  
IN  
Label  
Indication  
Color  
What It Means  
DSX2  
OUT  
SIG  
Signal  
Green  
ON – A recoverable signal is present on the  
DSX1/DSX2 interface.  
IN  
DSX1  
OUT  
OFF – The signal cannot be recovered from  
the DSX1/DSX2 interface. An LOS  
condition exists.  
Test  
Jacks  
IN  
DSX2MON  
OUT  
OOF  
ALM  
Out of Frame  
Alarm  
Yellow  
Yellow  
ON – At least one OOF was detected during  
the sampling period.  
 N
IN  
OUT  
OFF – No OOFs were detected during the  
sampling period.  
109DSX  
ON – An alarm condition is present on the  
DSX1/DSX2 interface.  
OK  
Current alarm conditions:  
H Loss of Signal (LOS)  
H Loss of Frame (LOF)  
H Excessive Error Rate (EER)  
H Yellow  
SIG  
DSX1  
OOF  
ALM  
SIG  
LEDs  
DSX2  
OOF  
ALM  
H Alarm Indication Signal (AIS)  
OFF – No alarm condition is present on the  
DSX1/DSX2 interface.  
97-15642-01  
General Status LED  
Label  
Indication  
Color  
What It Means  
OK  
Power and  
Operational  
Status  
Green  
ON – The APM has power and is  
operational.  
OFF – The APM is in a local self-test, or there  
is a failure.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
9109 Dual DSX APM Test Jack Functions  
The Dual DSX APM test jacks are used for:  
H
H
Accessing and testing towards the DSX 1 port  
Accessing and testing towards the DSX 2 port  
DSX1 DSX1  
DSX2 DSX2  
In  
Out  
In  
Out  
In  
Out  
In  
TX  
DSX1  
RX  
RX  
DSX2  
TX  
Internal  
Circuitry  
Out  
DSX2  
MON  
DSX2  
DSX1  
DSX1  
MON  
97-15653  
Test Jack Name  
Function  
IN  
DSX1 IN  
An intrusive test jack that allows a signal to be inserted  
towards the equipment attached to the DSX1 interface by  
external test equipment.  
DSX2  
OUT  
IN  
DSX1  
DSX1 OUT  
An intrusive test jack that interrupts the signal coming from  
the equipment attached to the DSX1 interface and allows it  
to be terminated by external test equipment.  
OUT  
Test  
Jacks  
IN  
DSX2MON  
DSX1 MON IN  
(DSX1 Monitor In)  
A monitor jack that noninstrusively monitors the transmitted  
signal going into the network (a composite of all channels  
allocated to the DSX1 interface).  
OUT  
 O
IN  
OUT  
DSX1 MON OUT  
(DSX1 Monitor Out)  
A monitor jack that noninstrusively monitors the received  
signal coming out of the network (a composite of all channels  
allocated to the DSX1 interface).  
109DSX  
OK  
DSX2 IN  
An intrusive test jack that allows insertion of a signal toward  
the equipment attached to the DSX2 interface by external  
test equipment.  
DSX2 OUT  
An intrusive test jack that interrupts the signal coming from  
the equipment attached to the DSX2 interface by external  
test equipment.  
SIG  
DSX1  
OOF  
ALM  
SIG  
DSX2 MON IN  
(DSX2 Monitor In)  
A monitor jack that noninstrusively monitors the signal going  
into the equipment attached to the DSX2 interface.  
DSX2  
OOF  
ALM  
DSX2 MON OUT  
A monitor jack that noninstrusively monitors the signal  
(DSX2 Monitor Out)  
coming out of the equipment attached to the DSX2 interface.  
97-15644-01  
See Test Jacks on page 9-8 for more information on the test jacks.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
Test Jacks  
And provides these test access  
points . . .  
This card . . .  
Provides these test jacks . . .  
9161 Single T1  
NAM  
H Network In  
H Network Out  
H DSX In  
H Network Monitor In  
H Network Monitor Out  
H DSX Monitor In  
H DSX Out  
H DSX Monitor Out  
9261 Dual T1  
NAM  
H Network 1 In  
H Network 1 Out  
H Network 2 In  
H Network 2 Out  
H Network 1 Monitor In  
H Network 1 Monitor Out  
H Network 2 Monitor In  
H Network 2 Monitor Out  
9109 Dual DSX  
APM  
H DSX 1 In  
H DSX 1 Out  
H DSX 2 In  
H DSX 2 Out  
H DSX 1 Monitor In  
H DSX 1 Monitor Out  
H DSX 2 Monitor In  
H DSX 2 Monitor Out  
The following figure is an example of using these test jacks:  
H
DSX OUT to allow test equipment to terminate the signal coming from  
equipment (e.g., a PBX) attached to the DSX port on the rear of the T1  
access unit.  
H
DSX IN to allow test equipment to provide a signal to equipment (e.g., a PBX)  
attached to the DSX port on the rear of the T1 access unit.  
Front  
Rear  
Test  
Out  
In  
Out  
In  
Equipment  
Internal  
Circuitry  
PBX  
Test  
Equipment  
T1 Access Unit  
97-15682  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
The following figure is an example of using the monitor test jacks:  
H
DSX MON IN to allow test equipment to nonintrusively monitor the signal  
being sent from the T1 access unit to equipment (e.g., a PBX) attached to the  
DSX port on the rear of the T1 access unit.  
H
DSX MON OUT to allow test equipment to nonintrusively monitor the signal  
being sent equipment (e.g., a PBX) attached to the DSX port on the rear of  
the T1 access unit.  
Front  
Rear  
Mon In  
Rx  
Rx  
Test  
Equipment  
Internal  
Circuitry  
PBX  
Test  
Equipment  
Mon Out  
T1 Access Unit  
97-15680  
Sync Data APM Front Panel LEDs  
The Sync Data APM has five LED status indicators.  
General Status LED  
Label  
Indication  
Color  
What It Means  
OK  
Power and  
Operational  
Status  
Green  
ON – APM has power and is operational.  
OFF – APM is in a local self-test, or there is a  
failure.  
Port 1, Port 2, Port 3, and Port 4 LEDs  
109SYNCD  
Label  
Indication  
Color  
What It Means  
OK  
1-OK  
2-OK  
3-OK  
4-OK  
Operational  
Status  
Green  
ON – The interchange circuits for the port  
are in the correct state to transmit  
and receive data.  
A
T
A
OFF – The port is idle. Occurs if the port is  
disabled, if an EDL Out of Frame or  
EER condition is present, if a DCLB is  
active, or if the port is configured to  
monitor DTR and/or RTS and the  
lead(s) is not asserted.  
1-OK  
2-OK  
3-OK  
4-OK  
LEDs  
PORT  
97-15679  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
OCU-DP APM Front Panel LEDs  
The 2-port OCU-DP APM has three LED status indicators. The 6-port OCU-DP  
APM has seven LEDs.  
General Status LED  
Label  
Indication  
Color  
What It Means  
OK  
Power and  
Operational  
Status  
Green  
ON – APM has power and is operational.  
OFF – APM is in a local self-test, or there is a  
failure.  
109OCU  
OK  
Port (1 to 6) LEDs  
Label  
Indication  
Color  
What It Means  
LEDs  
1-TST  
2-TST  
POR  
1-TST  
2-TST  
3-TST  
4-TST  
5-TST  
6-TST  
Operational  
Status  
Yellow  
ON – A test is in progress.  
T
OFF – No test is active on the port, including  
all test pattern generation, and any  
loopback that may be active on the  
local loop or the OCU-DP APM.  
98-15924  
109OCU  
OK  
1-TST  
2-TST  
3-TST  
4-TST  
5-TST  
6-TST  
LEDs  
POR  
T
98-15925  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
Voice APM Front Panel LED  
The E&M, FXO, and FXS Analog Voice APMs each have 1 LED status indicator.  
General Status LED  
Label  
Indication  
Color  
What It Means  
OK  
Power and  
Operational  
Status  
Green  
ON – APM has power and is operational.  
OFF – APM is in a local self-test, or there is a  
failure.  
109FXO  
OK  
97-15643  
System Alarm Relay  
The 5-slot housing and the access carrier provide an alarm system relay that you  
can configure to activate when an alarm condition is present. To use the system  
alarm relay, you must:  
H
H
See the 5-slot housing or access carrier installation instructions for  
information on how to connect the alarm relay connector.  
Set the following configuration option:  
Main Menu Configuration Edit/Display Alarm Options System  
Alarm Relay Enable  
H
Ensure that the System Alarm Relay Cut-off under the Control branch is not  
selected. This menu selection turns off the system alarm relay.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
Alarms  
The T1 access unit monitors alarm conditions occurring on either the:  
H
H
H
Network interface  
DSX-1 interface, or  
Sync data ports  
You select the ASCII alarms that you wish to receive for each interface on the T1  
access unit via the Network Interface configuration option screen.  
Viewing Alarm Messages  
You can view alarm messages via the:  
H
H
H
Health and Status screen  
Messages on Line 24 of the user interface screen  
Printout from your ASCII terminal printer  
ASCII Alarm Messages  
The following messages are sent to an ASCII terminal or printer attached to the  
communication port (either locally or remotely via an external device).  
CAUTION:  
You should be sure to clear alarms as they occur by correcting the  
condition that caused the alarm. Additional alarms will not be reported  
until the previous alarm is cleared. Therefore, if you do not clear an  
alarm, a serious outage could occur and you will be unaware of it,  
unless you are monitoring the unit via the user interface or SNMP.  
H
H
When set, an alarm is sent at the start of an alarm condition.  
If more than one alarm condition exists, only the highest priority alarm will be  
sent. View Health and Status for all conditions.  
H
An Alarm Cleared message is sent when the alarm condition no longer  
exists.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Table 9-1 lists the alarm messages and corresponding clear messages in  
alphabetical order. Priority order is identified. Each alarm message contains:  
H
Date and time (month/day/year hours:minutes:seconds) that the condition  
occurred or was cleared.  
H
H
H
The user-configured device name.  
Alarm description.  
An identification of the affected interface (when applicable).  
Table 9-1. ASCII Alarm Messages (1 of 5)  
Message  
What It Indicates  
What To Do  
Priority  
month/day/year  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
An Abnormal Station Code DS0 is detected on the  
An Abnormal Station  
Code from the network  
1. Check that the  
far-end DSU is  
operational.  
17  
has been received at the  
OCU-DP port in slot ss  
port p.  
specified OCU-DP  
port  
2. Check the far-end  
cable to the DSU.  
month/day/year  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for Abnormal  
Station Code at OCU-DP  
port in slot ss port p.  
month/day/year  
An Alarm Indication  
Signal condition is  
detected on the  
specified Network or  
DSX-1 interface.  
Check the status of  
the far-end unit. If  
necessary, contact  
network provider for  
Network interface.  
6 (Net)  
7 (DSX-1)  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Indication Signal  
(AIS) received at the  
Network 1/Network 2  
Interface or at the DSX-1  
Interface in slot ss port p.  
Check the DTE  
attached to the DSX-1  
interface.  
month/day/year  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for Alarm  
Indication Signal (AIS) at  
the Network 1/Network 2)  
Interface or at the DSX-1  
Interface in slot ss port p.  
month/day/year  
An APM card failure is 1. Check that the APM 11  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
An APM Card Failure has  
been detected for slot ss.  
detected for the  
identified slot.  
card is seated  
properly.  
2. Contact your  
service  
representative.  
month/day/year  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for an APM  
Card Failure for slot ss.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
Table 9-1. ASCII Alarm Messages (2 of 5)  
Message  
What It Indicates  
What To Do  
Priority  
month/day/year  
LOS condition  
detected.  
1. Check the cable to  
2 (Net)  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Continuous Loss Of Signal  
(LOS) condition detected at  
the Network 1/Network 2  
Interface or at DSX-1  
the Network/DSX-1 3 (DSX-1)  
interface.  
2. Contact network  
provider.  
Interface in slot ss port p.  
month/day/year  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for Loss Of  
Signal (LOS) condition at  
the Network 1/Network 2  
Interface or at the DSX-1  
Interface in slot ss port p.  
month/day/year  
An out-of-frame  
condition is detected  
at the specified  
Network or DSX-1  
interface.  
1. Ensure that the line 4 (Net)  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Continuous Out Of Frame  
(OOF) detected at the  
Network 1/Network 2  
Interface or at DSX-1  
Interface in slot ss port p.  
framing format  
5 (DSX-1)  
configuration option  
setting matches the  
setting of the  
equipment (DSX-1)  
or network (Net).  
2. Contact network  
provider.  
month/day/year  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for Out of  
Frame (OOF) condition at  
the Network 1/Network 2  
Interface or at the DSX-1  
Interface in slot ss port p.  
month/day/year  
A continuous  
1. Ensure that EDL is  
enabled on the  
far-end port. Refer  
to the Technical  
Reference for  
setting  
13  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Continuous Out of Frame  
(OOF) condition at  
synchronous data port in  
slot ss port p.  
out-of-frame condition  
occurred on the  
synchronous data port  
for the identified slot  
and port.  
configuration  
options.  
2. There is a network  
problem with the  
fractional portion of  
the link carrying this  
port’s data. Contact  
network provider.  
month/day/year  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for Out Of  
Frame (OOF) condition at  
synchronous data port in  
slot ss port p.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
Table 9-1. ASCII Alarm Messages (3 of 5)  
Message  
What It Indicates  
What To Do  
Priority  
month/day/year  
A DDS network failure Contact the DDS  
19  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
A DDS Network Failure  
code has been received at  
OCU-DP port in slot ss  
port p.  
is being detected on  
the specified OCU-DP  
port.  
service provider.  
month/day/year  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for a DDS  
Network Failure code at  
OCU-DP port in slot ss  
port p.  
month/day/year  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
An Excessive Error Rate  
(EER) has been detected at network interface.  
the Network 1/ Network 2  
Interface.  
An Excessive Error  
Rate condition is  
detected on the  
Contact network  
provider.  
12  
14  
20  
month/day/year  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for  
Excessive Error Rate  
(EER) at the Network  
1/Network 2 Interface.  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
month/day/year  
hours/minutes/seconds –  
An Excessive Error Rate  
(EER) has been detected at for the identified slot  
synchronous data port in  
slot ss port p.  
An excessive error  
rate occurred on the  
synchronous data port fractional portion of  
There is a network  
problem with the  
the link carrying this  
port’s data. Contact  
network provider.  
and port.  
month/day/year  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for  
Excessive Error Rate  
(EER) at synchronous data  
port in slot ss port p.  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
month/day/year  
The specified  
OCU-DP port cannot  
recover timing from  
the received signal on rate.  
the local loop.  
Check that the CPE  
CSU/DSU rate  
matches the OCU-DP  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
A Loss of Loop Timing has  
been detected at OCU-DP  
port in slot ss port p.  
month/day/year  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for Loss of  
Loop Timing at OCU-DP  
port in slot ss port p.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
Table 9-1. ASCII Alarm Messages (4 of 5)  
Message  
What It Indicates  
What To Do  
Priority  
month/day/year  
LOS condition  
1. Check the cable to  
the OCU-DP port.  
16  
hours:minutes:seconds – A detected.  
Loss Of Signal (LOS) has  
been detected at the  
2. Contact network  
provider.  
OCU-DP port in slot ss  
port p.  
month/day/year  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for a Loss  
Of Signal (LOS) at  
OCU-DP port in slot ss  
port p.  
month/day/year  
The identified slot  
Ensure that the APM  
8
hours:minutes:seconds –  
A Module Misconfiguration  
condition was detected for  
slot ss.  
previously contained a installed is the correct  
different type of APM. type. If it is not, install  
the correct APM type.  
The card needs to be  
accepted. Refer to the  
Technical Reference  
for additional  
information, if  
necessary.  
month/day/year  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for the  
Module Misconfiguration for  
slot ss.  
month/day/year  
A power supply or fan 1. Check that the  
1
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Power Supply Alarm  
condition detect.  
tray problem is  
detected on the  
system.  
power supply or fan  
tray is mounted  
correctly in the  
housing.  
2. Contact your  
service  
representative.  
month/day/year  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for Power  
Alarm condition.  
month/day/year  
A Yellow alarm signal  
is detected on the  
specified Network or  
DSX-1 interface.  
1. Check the Network 9 (Net)  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Yellow alarm signal  
received at the Network  
1/Network 2 Interface or at  
the DSX-1 Interface in  
slot ss port p.  
and/or DSX-1  
cable.  
10 (DSX-1)  
2. Contact network  
provider for  
Network interface  
problem. Check  
equipment for  
DSX-1 interface  
problem.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
Table 9-1. ASCII Alarm Messages (5 of 5)  
Message  
What It Indicates  
What To Do  
Priority  
month/day/year  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for Yellow  
alarm signal at the  
Network1/Network 2  
Interface or at the DSX-1  
Interface in slot ss port p.  
month/day/year  
The primary clock  
source has failed. The  
system is operating  
from the secondary  
clock source.  
1. If the primary clock 22  
was derived from  
the network,  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
A Primary Clock Source  
Failure has occurred.  
contact the network  
provider.  
2. Check the clock  
source. Contact  
your service  
representative.  
month/day/year  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for a  
Primary Source Failure.  
month/day/year  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
A Secondary Clock Source system is operating  
Failure has occurred.  
The secondary clock  
source has failed. The  
1. If the secondary  
clock was derived  
from the network,  
contact the network  
provider.  
21  
from the internal clock.  
2. Check the clock  
source. Contact  
your service  
representative.  
month/day/year  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
Alarm Cleared for a  
Secondary Source Failure.  
month/day/year  
A continuous  
out-of-frame condition problem with the  
occurred on the  
OCU-DP port for the  
There is a network  
18  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
A 64KCC Loop Out of  
Frame has been detected  
at OCU-DP port in slot ss  
port p.  
fractional portion of  
the link carrying this  
identified slot and port. port’s data. Contact  
network provider.  
month/day/year  
Alarm condition no  
longer exists.  
No action needed.  
hours:minutes:seconds –  
Alarm Cleared for a 64KCC  
Loop Out Of Frame at  
OCU-DP port in slot ss  
port p.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
System Error Messages  
These messages, listed in alphabetical order, appear in the messages area at the  
bottom of the screens (see Table 9-2).  
Table 9-2. System Error Messages  
Message  
What It Indicates  
What To Do  
1
Invalid Character (x)  
An invalid character has been Reenter information using  
entered.  
valid characters.  
Invalid – Already  
Active  
Test was already in progress  
when it was selected.  
No action needed.  
Invalid Password  
Login is required and an  
incorrect password was  
entered; access is denied.  
1. Try again.  
2. Contact your system  
administrator to verify your  
password.  
Invalid Test  
Combination  
A conflicting loopback or  
pattern test was in progress  
when Start was selected to  
start another test, or was  
active on the same or another  
interface when Start was  
selected.  
1. Wait until other test ends  
and message clears.  
2. Stop the test from the same  
screen the test was started  
from.  
3. Cancel all tests from the  
Test screen (Path:  
main/test).  
Limit of six Login IDs  
reached  
An attempt to enter a new  
login ID exceeds the six  
login/password combinations  
limit.  
1. Delete another  
login/password  
combination.  
2. Reenter the new login ID.  
Minimum Mode  
Appears if the T1 access unit  
fails the memory test during a software again. Call your  
Use FTP to download  
power-up self-test.  
service representative.  
No Security Records  
to Delete  
Delete was selected from the  
Administer Login screen, and  
no security records exist.  
1. No action needed.  
2. Enter a security record.  
Password Matching  
Error – Re-enter  
Password  
Password entered in the  
1. Try again.  
Reenter Password field of the  
Administer Logins screen  
does not match what was  
entered in the Password field.  
2. Contact your system  
administrator to verify your  
password.  
1
x is the character not being accepted.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Automatic Dialing Out When an Alarm Occurs  
You can control whether generated alarm messages will initiate a call if a  
connection on the COM port external device has not already been established.  
To dial out when an alarm occurs you must:  
H
H
H
H
H
Connect the modem to the COM port using the appropriate cable.  
Select the ASCII alarms to receive for each interface.  
Configure the phone directory to use for Dial Out Alarms.  
Enable Alarm & Trap Dial Out.  
Enable Call Retry, if desired.  
" Procedure  
To enable the desired ASCII alarms for each interface:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence to display the Load Configuration From  
screen:  
Main Menu Configuration  
2. Select the desired configuration area and press Return. The Configuration  
Edit/Display screen appears.  
3. Select the ASCII alarms to enable for the interface.  
To enable . . .  
Set the configuration option(s) . . .  
Configuration Network  
T1 alarms  
DSX-1 alarms  
Configuration DSX-1  
Sync Data Ports alarms  
OCU-DP Ports alarms  
Configuration Sync Data Ports  
Configuration OCU-DP Ports  
4. Configure the phone directory to use for dialing out alarms (see Displaying  
Directory Numbers and Changing Directory Numbers in Chapter 8, Operation  
and Maintenance).  
5. Select Alarm from the Configuration Edit/Display menu and press Return.  
The Alarms Options screen appears.  
To . . .  
Set the configuration option . . .  
Alarm & Trap Dial-Out to Enable.  
Call Retry to Enable.  
Automatically initiate a call (dial out)  
Retry the call if the call cannot be  
completed  
Enable ASCII alarms  
Configuration Alarm  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
6. Press Ctrl-a to switch to the screen function key area.  
7. To save changes, select Save and press Return. The Save Configuration To  
screen appears.  
8. Select the configuration area where you want to save the changes to and  
press Return. When Save is complete, Command Complete appears at the  
bottom of the screen.  
Manual Dialing Out When an Alarm Occurs  
Configure the external device connected the the access unit’s COM port. Then,  
use the COM Port Call Setup screen to:  
H
H
H
Select the desired telephone number.  
Dial a call.  
Disconnect a call.  
" Procedure  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Control COM Port Call Setup  
2. Enter the desired directory number, or press the spacebar to cycle through  
the numbers that have been set up in the directory. The telephone number  
appears in the Directory Phone Number field.  
See Displaying Directory Numbers and Changing Directory Numbers in  
Chapter 8, Operation and Maintenance, for information about the call  
directory.  
3. Select Dial and press the Enter key to initiate dialing.  
4. To end the call, select Disconnect and press the Enter key.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
Tests Available  
The Test menu allows you to run loopbacks and test patterns on the T1 access  
unit, and to test the front panel LEDs. It is available to users with a security  
access level of 1 or 2. Use the test menu to access the following tests.  
To access the . . .  
Select . . .  
Network (1 or 2) Interface tests:  
Network Tests  
Line Loopback  
Payload Loopback  
Repeater Loopback  
Remote Line Loopback  
Pattern Tests  
QRSS  
All-zeroes  
All-ones  
1-in-8  
3-in-24  
63  
511  
2047  
15  
2
2
-1  
-1  
20  
user-defined  
DSX-1 Interface tests:  
Line Loopback  
Payload Loopback  
Repeater Loopback  
Pattern tests  
QRSS  
DSX-1 Tests  
All-zeroes  
All-ones  
1-in-8  
3-in-24  
63  
511  
2047  
15  
2
-1  
-1  
20  
2
user-defined  
Sync Data Port tests  
Sync Data Port Tests  
DTE Loopback  
DTE Payload Loopback  
Data Channel Loopback  
Remote Loopbacks  
V.54  
FT1  
Pattern tests  
QRSS  
All-zeroes  
All-ones  
63  
511  
2047  
15  
2
2
-1  
-1  
20  
user-defined  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
To access the . . .  
Select . . .  
Voice Port tests  
Voice Port Tests  
Digital Loopback  
Analog Loopback  
Line Loopback  
Test tones  
DRS  
Quiet  
Force Signaling  
Monitor Signaling  
OCU-DP tests  
OCU-DP Tests  
Local Loopback  
Latching Loopback  
Nonlatching Loopback  
OCU Loopback  
DS-0 Payload Loopback  
Line Loopback  
Data Loopback  
Remote Loopback  
Latching LB  
Nonlatching LB  
Pattern tests  
All-zeroes  
All-ones  
63  
511  
2047  
Lamp test  
Device Tests  
Interface Tests  
The interface tests run on the T1 access unit’s Network (1 or 2) or DSX-1  
interfaces.  
" Procedure  
To start and stop a Line, Payload or Repeater Loopback test:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence to display the Tests screen:  
Main Menu Test [Network Tests/DSX-1 Tests]  
2. For Network tests, select the desired Network interface (1 for 9161 NAM, 1 or  
2 for 9261 NAM).  
For DSX-1 tests, enter the slot and port number of the desired DSX-1  
interface.  
3. Highlight Start under Command in the selected test’s row. Then, press Return  
to start the test. This field now displays the word Stop.  
4. View the length of time that the test has been running in the Result column.  
5. Highlight Stop under Command in the selected test’s row. Then, press Return  
to stop the test. This field now displays the word Start.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Line Loopback  
The Line Loopback (LLB) loops the information received on the Network or  
DSX-1 interface back to the source of the loopback. When used with a pattern  
test at the remote node, LLB determines whether the problem is with the sending  
device or the T1 facility.  
Framer  
Network  
Interface  
DSX  
Port  
All  
1s  
LLB  
All 1s  
All 1s  
DCE  
Port 2  
DCE  
Port 1  
496-15197  
The following tests cannot be running when a line loopback test is initiated:  
H
H
Payload loopback on this Network or DSX-1 interface  
Send Pattern Test on this Network or DSX-1 interface or any data port  
assigned to this interface  
H
H
Send Remote Line Loopback on this Network or DSX-1 interface  
Send V.54 or Send FT1 Loopback on any port assigned to this Network or  
DSX-1 interface  
H
Data Channel Loopback on any data port assigned to this Network or DSX-1  
interface  
CAUTION:  
Line Loopback may affect the operation of the FDL, DDL, or EDL. Any IP  
data being sent while this test is active will be disrupted. Also, any  
performance statistics being sent over the EDL will be disrupted.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Payload Loopback  
The Payload Loopback (PLB) loops the information received on the Network or  
DSX-1 interface back to the network after it has passed through the receive and  
transmit framing section of the device. Use PLB for determining whether the  
problem is with the T1 facility or in the circuitry of the remote device.  
Framer  
Network  
Interface  
DSX  
Port  
All  
1s  
PLB  
All 1s  
All 1s  
DCE  
Port 2  
DCE  
Port 1  
496-15198  
The following tests cannot be running when a payload loopback test is initiated:  
H
H
Line Loopback or Repeater Loopback on the same Network or DSX-1  
interface  
Send Pattern Test on the same Network or DSX-1 interface or any data port  
assigned to this interface  
H
H
Send Remote Line Loopback on the same Network or DSX-1 interface  
Send V.54 or Send FT1 Loopback on any data port assigned to this Network  
or DSX-1 interface  
H
Data Channel Loopback on any data port assigned to the same Network or  
DSX-1 interface  
CAUTION:  
Payload Loopback may affect the operation of the FDL, DDL, or EDL.  
Any IP data being sent while this test is active will be disrupted. Also,  
any performance statistics being sent over the EDL will be disrupted.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Repeater Loopback  
The Repeater Loopback (RLB) loops the information to be sent over the Network  
or DSX-1 interface back to the device. The RLB loops the entire data stream,  
which includes data on the interface, as well as the synchronous data ports. Use  
RLB to ensure that all of the data is correct up to the point where it is sent out  
over the interface.  
H
H
This helps to indicate that the T1 access unit is operational.  
An attached device or test equipment should generate and monitor data to be  
looped back.  
Framer  
Network  
Interface  
DSX  
Port  
RLB  
AIS  
DCE  
DCE  
496-15199  
Port 2 Port 1  
The T1 NAM will not respond to any messages from the network during this test.  
The following tests cannot be running when a repeater loopback test is initiated:  
H
H
Payload Loopback on this Network or DSX-1 interface  
All loopbacks on any other T1 interface (DSX-1 or Network) with DS0s  
assigned to this interface  
H
Send Pattern Test on this Network or DSX-1 interface or any data port  
assigned to this interface  
H
H
Send Remote Line Loopback on this Network or DSX-1 interface  
Send V.54 or Send FT1 Loopback on any data port assigned to this Network  
or DSX-1 interface  
H
Data Channel Loopback on any data port assigned to this Network or DSX-1  
interface  
CAUTION:  
Repeater Loopback may affect the operation of the FDL, DDL, or EDL.  
Any IP data being sent while this test is active will be disrupted. Also,  
any performance statistics being sent over the EDL will be disrupted.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Remote Loopbacks  
The remote loopback up codes (which put a remote device in loopback mode)  
and down codes (which take a remote device out of loopback mode) are in-band  
codes that allow remote control of a device.  
H
H
Network loopbacks are defined in AT&T TR 62411.  
The LLB up code invokes a line loopback in the remote unit while the LLB  
down code terminates the line loopback in the remote unit.  
The following tests cannot be running when a remote loopback test is initiated:  
H
H
H
H
H
All loopbacks on this Network or DSX-1 interface  
Send Pattern Test on this interface or any data port assigned to this interface  
Send Remote Line Loopback on this interface  
Send V.54 or Send FT1 Loopback on any data port assigned to this interface  
Data Channel Loopback on any data port assigned to this interface  
" Procedure  
To start and stop a Remote Loopback:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Test Network Tests  
2. Select the desired Network interface (1 for 9161 NAM, 1 or 2 for 9261 NAM).  
3. Select the code Up or Down in the Send Line Loopback field.  
4. Highlight Send under Command in the Send Line Loopback row. Then, press  
Return to start the test. The code will be sent for 10 seconds.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Sending and Monitoring Pattern Tests  
The pattern tests enable a T1 access unit either to send or monitor a known bit  
pattern. These tests generate industry-standard bit patterns that can be used to  
determine whether information is being correctly transmitted across a circuit.  
" Procedure  
To send/monitor a Pattern Test:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence to display the Tests screen:  
Main Menu Test [Network Tests/DSX-1 Tests]  
2. For Network tests, select the desired Network interface (1 for 9161 Single T1  
NAM, 1 or 2 for 9261 Dual T1 NAM).  
For DSX-1 tests, enter the slot and port number of the desired DSX-1  
interface.  
3. Select the desired pattern in the Send field. If you are sending/monitoring a  
user-defined pattern, enter the desired 2-byte hexadecimal value in the field  
next to Send. When sending a pattern, the Inject ERR function key appears.  
Use Inject ERR if you want to inject a bit error in the transmitted bit pattern.  
4. Highlight Send under Command in the row to send a pattern, or Start to  
monitor a pattern. Then, press Return to start the test.  
5. View the length of time that the test has been running in the Results column.  
An error count is also displayed. When monitoring a pattern, the ResetMon  
virtual function key appears. ResetMon resets the error count to zero.  
6. Highlight Stop under Command in the Send or Monitor row. Then, press  
Return to stop the test.  
7. View the length of time that the test has been running in the Result column.  
The following tests cannot be running when a Send Pattern test is initiated:  
H
H
All loopbacks on the same interface  
Send Pattern Test on the same interface or any data port assigned to that  
interface  
H
H
H
Send Remote Line Loopback on the same interface  
Send V.54 or Send FT1 Loopback on any data port assigned to this interface  
Data Channel Loopback on any data port assigned to the same interface  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Data Port Tests  
Data port tests are available to run on any of the synchronous DTE interfaces on  
the T1 NAM and the Sync Data APM.  
H
H
Data port loopbacks are defined in ITU V.54 and ANSI T1 403.  
The Send V.54 Up/Down and FT1 Up/Down perform a similar function to LLB  
Up and LLB Down, but are only sent on the DS0s associated with a particular  
data port and will control the remote operation of the Data Channel Loopback  
(a Sync Data Port test).  
H
DTE Payload Loopback on the same port  
" Procedure  
To start and stop a data port loopback test:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Test Sync Data Port Tests  
2. Enter the desired slot and port number.  
3. Highlight Start under Command in the selected test’s row to send a test.  
Then, press Return to start the test.  
4. View the length of time that the test has been running in the Results column.  
5. Highlight Stop under Command to stop the test.  
DTE Loopback (DTLB)  
The DTE Loopback (DTLB) performs the same function on the DTE interface that  
the LLB does on the Network or DSX-1 interface. Use DTLB for isolating  
problems on the DTE interface. An attached device or test equipment must  
generate data to be looped back.  
Network  
Interface  
DSX  
Port  
All 1s  
DCE  
Port 2  
DCE  
Port 1  
496-15213  
The following test cannot be running when a DTLB test is initiated:  
H
DTE Payload Loopback on the same port  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
DTE Payload Loopback (DTPLB)  
The DTE Payload Loopback (DTPLB) loops the information received on the  
Network or DSX-1 interface back to the network after it has passed through the  
port circuitry. Use DTPLB for isolating problems on the DTE line. An attached  
device or test equipment must generate and monitor data to be looped back.  
All 1s  
Network  
Interface  
DSX  
Port  
DTLB  
DTLB  
DCE  
Port 2  
DCE  
Port1  
496-15211  
CAUTION:  
The Abort All Test selection from the Tests screen or the system test  
timeout (set via the Test Timeout configuration option on the System  
Options branch of the menu tree) will not interrupt a DTE Loopback test  
that has been initiated by an attached device since the Local Loopback  
lead will still be asserted.  
The following tests cannot be running when a DTPLB test is initiated:  
H
DTE Loopback, Data Channel Loopback, or Send Pattern Test on the same  
port  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Data Channel Loopback (DCLB)  
The Data Channel Loopback (DCLB) loops the data for a particular synchronous  
data port back to the interface after the information has passed all the way  
through the device (i.e., just before it is sent to the Customer Premises  
Equipment). Use DCLB to verify the end-to-end integrity of a circuit for a  
particular port.  
Network  
Interface  
DSX  
Port  
DCLB  
All 1s  
DCLB  
All 1s  
496-15212  
DCE  
Port 2  
DCE  
Port 1  
The following tests cannot be running when a DCLB test is initiated:  
H
H
A Line Loopback, Payload Repeater Loopback or Send Pattern Test on the  
same interface  
Send Pattern Test or DTE Payload Loopback on the same port  
V. 54 Remote Loopback  
The V.54 remote loopback commands a device to go into the data channel  
loopback on the associated port.  
" Procedure  
To send a V.54 Remote Loopback:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Test Sync Data Port Tests  
2. Enter the desired slot and port number.  
3. Select the code Up or Down in the Send V.54 Loopback field.  
4. Highlight Send under Command in the Send V.54 Loopback row. Then, press  
Return to start the test. The code will be sent for up to 10 seconds, or until an  
acknowledgement is received from the remote end.  
5. View the length of time that the test has been running in the Results column.  
6. Send the Down code to stop the remote loopback.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
The following tests cannot be running when a V.54 test is initiated:  
H
H
A Send Pattern Test, Send Remote Line Loopback, Payload Loopback, or  
Repeater Loopback on the interface to which the port is assigned  
DTE Payload Loopback, Send Pattern Test, or Send FT1 Loopback on the  
same port  
Remote FT1 Data Channel Loopback  
The Remote FT1 Data Channel Loopback commands a remote device to go into  
Data Channel Loopback on associated port.  
" Procedure  
To send a Remote FT1 Data Channel Loopback:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Test Sync Data Port Tests  
2. Enter the desired slot and port number.  
3. Select the code Up or Down in the Send FT1 Loopback field.  
4. Highlight Send under Command in the Send Ft1 Loopback row. Then, press  
Return to start the test. The code will be sent for up to 10 seconds, or until an  
acknowledgement is received from the remote end.  
5. View the length of time that the test has been running in the Results column.  
The following tests cannot be running when a V.54 test is initiated:  
H
H
A Send Pattern Test, Send Remote Line Loopback, Payload Loopback, or  
Repeater Loopback on the interface to which the port is assigned  
DTE Payload Loopback, Send Pattern Test, or Send V.54 Loopback on the  
same port  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Sending and Monitoring Pattern Tests  
The pattern tests enable a T1 access unit either to send or monitor a known bit  
pattern.  
H
H
These tests generate industry-standard bit patterns that can be used to  
determine whether information is being correctly transmitted across a circuit.  
These industry-standard and user-defined patterns can be sent by the  
Network (1 or 2) and DSX-1 interfaces, as well as the Sync Data ports  
(toward the Network or DSX-1 interface) and the OCU-DP ports.  
" Procedure  
To send/monitor a Pattern Test:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence to display the Tests screen:  
Main Menu Test Sync Data Port Tests  
2. Select the desired slot and port numbers.  
3. Select the desired pattern in the Send field. If you are sending/monitoring a  
user-defined pattern, enter the the desired 2-byte hexadecimal value in the  
field next to Send. When sending a pattern, the Inject ERR function key  
appears. Use Inject ERR if you want to inject a bit error in the transmitted bit  
pattern.  
4. Highlight Send under Command in the row to send a pattern, or Start to  
monitor a pattern. Then, press Return to start the test.  
5. View the length of time that the test has been running in the Results column.  
An error count is also displayed. When monitoring a pattern, the ResetMon  
virtual function key appears. ResetMon resets the error count to zero.  
6. Highlight Stop under Command in the Send or Monitor row. Then, press  
Return to stop the test.  
Voice Port Tests  
Voice port tests are available to run on voice ports for any installed and enabled  
APM.  
" Procedure  
To start and stop a voice port loopback:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Test Voice Port Tests  
2. Enter the desired slot and port number.  
3. Highlight Start under Command in the row to send a test. Then, press Return  
to start the test.  
4. View the length of time that the test has been running in the Results column.  
5. Highlight Stop under Command to stop the test.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Digital Loopbacks  
A Digital Loopback loops the digital voice signal received from the T1 interface  
back to the same interface, just before reaching the D-to-A converter on the voice  
port.  
CODEC  
D to A  
Digital Loopback  
Converter  
to: T1 Interface  
496-15200  
The following tests cannot be running when a digital loopback test is initiated:  
H
Analog Loopback, DRS or Quiet Test Tone on the same port  
Analog Loopbacks  
An Analog Loopback loops the analog voice signal received from the T1 interface  
back to the same interface, after passing through the Digital-to-Analog converter  
and Analog-to-Digital converter on the voice port.  
CODEC  
D to A  
Analog Loopback  
Converter  
to: T1 Interface  
496-15201  
The following tests cannot be running when an Analog Loopback test is initiated:  
H
DRS or Quiet Test Tone, or Digital or Line Loopback on the same port  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Line Loopbacks  
This test is only available for a voice port belonging to an E&M APM. A Line  
Loopback loops the analog voice signal received from the analog line/device  
connected to the port back to the same line/device, before passing through the A  
to D converter on the voice port.  
CODEC  
D to A  
Line Loopback  
Converter  
to: Analog Device  
496-15202  
The following tests cannot be running when a Line Loopback is initiated:  
H
DRS or Quiet Test Tone, or Analog Loopback on the same port  
Test Tones  
The following test tones are available to send to interface or to the user:  
H
H
DRS – Digital Reference Signal, a 1004 Hz, 0.0 dBm tone.  
Quiet – No signal is sent.  
" Procedure  
To start and stop a Test Tone:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Test Voice Port Tests  
2. Enter the desired slot and port number.  
3. Highlight either Send ___ to T1 Interface or Send ___ to User and select  
either Quiet or DRS for each field.  
4. Highlight Start under Command in the row to send a test. Then, press Return  
to start the test.  
5. View the length of time that the test has been running in the Results column.  
6. Highlight Stop under Command to stop the test.  
The following tests cannot be running when a Test Tone is initiated:  
H
H
Any loopbacks on the same port  
Another type of test tone (other than the one currently running) on the same  
interface  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Force and Monitor Signaling  
Force and Monitor signaling enables you to send and receive the following  
to/from the T1 interface to which the selected port is assigned:  
You can force these fields . . .  
To these settings . . .  
ABCD bits (Tx and Rx) for ESF framing or  
AB bits (Tx and Rx) for D4 framing  
User-specified values  
Set Tip and Ring Leads To  
For FXO  
Loop – Tip and Ring are connected  
together  
Rgnd – Ring lead is attached to ground  
Open – Ring lead is not connected to  
either the Tip lead or the ground  
Lpgnd – Tip and Ring are connected  
together, and Tip is connected to ground  
RbTo – A 48 Vdc battery is applied to the  
Ring lead and the Tip lead is open  
For FXS  
RbTg – A 48 Vdc battery is applied to the  
Ring lead and the Tip lead is grounded  
TbRg – A 48 Vdc battery is applied to the  
Tip lead and the Ring lead is grounded  
Ring – Ringing voltage applied between  
Tip and Ring  
Set E-lead to (E&M APM only)  
On  
Off  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
You can monitor these fields . . .  
At these settings . . .  
ABCD bits (Tx and Rx) for ESF framing or  
AB bits (Tx and Rx) for D4 framing  
Whatever value is currently set  
Tip and Ring Leads State  
For FXO  
ToRo – Attached device has both Tip and  
Ring leads open  
TgRo – Attached device has Tip lead  
grounded and Ring lead open  
TgR* – Attached device has Tip lead  
grounded and Ring lead state is unknown  
ToR* – Attached device has Tip lead open  
and Ring lead state is unknown  
RoT* – Attached device has Ring lead  
open and Tip lead state is unknown  
RbTo – A battery is applied to the Ring  
lead and the Tip lead is open  
RbTg – A battery is applied to the Ring  
lead and the Tip lead is grounded  
TbRg – A battery is applied to the Tip lead  
and the Ring lead is grounded  
Ring – Ringing voltage applied between  
Tip and Ring  
For FXS  
RbTo – Ring Lead connected to nominal  
48Vdc battery and Tip lead open  
RbTg – Ring Lead connected to nominal  
48Vdc battery and Tip lead grounded  
TbRg – Tip Lead connected to nominal  
48Vdc battery and Ring lead grounded  
Ring – Ringing voltage applied between  
Tip and Ring  
Tip and Ring Leads Control State  
(FXO only)  
Loop – Tip and Ring are connected  
together  
Rgnd – Ring lead is attached to ground  
Open – Ring lead is not connected to  
either the Tip lead or the ground  
Lpgnd – Tip and Ring are connected  
together, and Tip is connected to ground  
E-lead state (E&M APM only)  
M-lead state (E&M APM only)  
On  
Off  
On  
Off  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
" Procedure  
To force signaling:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Test Voice Port Tests  
2. Enter the desired slot and port number.  
3. Press PgDn to go to page 2.  
4. Enter the desired setting for each field.  
5. Highlight Start under Command in the row to send a test. Then, press Return  
to start the test.  
6. View the length of time that the test has been running in the Results column.  
7. Highlight Stop under Command to stop the test.  
" Procedure  
To monitor signaling:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Test Voice Port Tests  
2. Enter the desired slot and port number.  
3. Press PgDn to go to page 2.  
4. Look at the values displayed under the Monitor Signaling portion of the  
screen.  
OCU-DP Tests  
The OCU-DP tests run on the OCU-DP APM’s ports. The procedure to send a  
Latching loopback differs from the procedure to start/stop other loopbacks. Both  
procedures are described below.  
Sending a Latching Loopback  
" Procedure  
To send a Latching Loopback:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Test [OCU-DP Tests]  
2. Enter the loopback type:  
— For Local: CSU or DSU  
— For Remote: CSU, DSU, or OCU  
3. Select the code Up or Down.  
4. Highlight Send in the Command row. Then, press Return to start the test. The  
code will be sent for up to 10 seconds, or until an acknowledgement is  
received.  
5. View the length of time that the test has been running in the Results column.  
6. Send the Down code to stop the loopback.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Starting/Stopping Other Loopbacks  
" Procedure  
To start and stop loopback tests:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence to display the Tests screen:  
Main Menu Test [OCU-DP Tests]  
2. For Nonlatching loopbacks, select the desired loopback type (CSU or DSU).  
3. Highlight Start under Command in the selected test’s row. Then, press Return  
to start the test. This field now displays the word Stop.  
4. View the length of time that the test has been running in the Result column.  
5. Highlight Stop under Command in the selected test’s row. Then, press Return  
to stop the test. This field now displays the word Start.  
OCU-DP Local Loopback Tests  
The following local loopback tests are available for the OCU-DP APM:  
H
Latching Loopback – applicable only to the 64 Clear Channel DDS (64KCC)  
rate  
H
H
H
H
H
Nonlatching Loopback – applicable only to the DDS rate of 56K  
OCU Loopback  
DS-0 Loopback  
Line Loopback  
Data Loopback  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
DDS CSU/DSU Latching/Nonlatching Loopback  
The Latching/Nonlatching Loopback sends the selected loopback sequence to  
the CPE attached to the port.  
Allows testing of a local loop between  
the selected port and the CPE  
running at . . .  
Loopback  
types  
This loopback  
Latching  
Direction  
64K Clear Channel  
56K  
CSU or DSU up or down  
CSU or DSU  
Nonlatching  
DSU Latching  
and Nonlatching  
Loopback  
OCU  
APM  
T1  
NAM  
DDS  
OCU  
CSU  
Port  
Network  
Interface  
DSU  
CSU Latching  
and Nonlatching  
Loopback  
98-15958  
The following tests are the only tests allowed to run at the same time as a  
Latching/Nonlatching Loopback. No other tests can be running when a  
Latching/Nonlatching Loopback test is initiated:  
H
Send Pattern/Monitor Pattern Test on any data port assigned to this interface  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
OCU Loopback  
The OCU Loopback loops the data received from the T1 interface for the selected  
port back to the T1 interface.  
OCU  
APM  
T1  
NAM  
OCU  
Loopback  
Network  
Interface  
OCU  
Port  
All  
1s  
98-15959  
The following test is the only test allowed to run at the same time as an OCU  
Loopback. No other tests can be running when an OCU Loopback test is initiated:  
H
Line Loopback  
DS-0 Loopback  
The DS-0 Loopback loops the data received from the T1 interface for the  
selected port back to the T1 interface.  
OCU  
APM  
T1  
NAM  
Network  
Interface  
OCU  
Port  
All  
1s  
DS-0  
Loopback  
98-15960  
The following test is the only test allowed to run at the same time as an DS-0  
Loopback. No other tests can be running when a DS-0 Loopback test is initiated:  
H
Line Loopback  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Line Loopback  
The Line Loopback tests the local loop between the OCU port and the attached  
CPE. The loopback occurs on the APM near the local loop interface, toward the  
local loop.  
OCU  
APM  
T1  
NAM  
Line  
Loopback  
Network  
Interface  
OCU  
Port  
All 1s  
98-15961  
The following tests are the only tests allowed to run at the same time as a Line  
Loopback. No other tests can be running when a Line Loopback test is initiated:  
H
H
H
H
OCU Loopback  
DS-0 Loopback  
Line Loopback on the cross-connected T1 interface  
Payload Loopback on the cross-connected T1 interface  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Data Loopback  
The Data Loopback tests the APM circuitry and the local loop connecting the port  
to the CPE. The loopback occurs on the APM near the backplane connection,  
toward the local loop.  
OCU  
APM  
T1  
NAM  
Data  
Loopback  
Network  
Interface  
OCU  
Port  
All 1s  
98-15962  
The following tests are the only tests allowed to run at the same time as a Data  
Loopback. No other tests can be running when a Data Loopback test is initiated:  
H
H
Line Loopback on the cross-connected T1 interface  
Payload Loopback on the cross-connected T1 interface  
OCU-DP Remote Loopback Tests  
The following remote loopback tests are available for the OCU-DP APM:  
H
H
Latching Loopback – applicable only to the 64 Clear Channel DDS (64KCC)  
rate  
Nonlatching Loopback – applicable only to the DDS rates of 56K and  
Switched 56  
Device Tests  
The T1 access unit supports a Lamp test at the device level. Use this test to  
determine whether all LEDs are lighting and functioning properly. All LEDs light at  
the same time every 1/2 seconds during execution of the Lamp test. When you  
stop the Lamp test, the LEDs are restored to their normal condition. If the Test  
Timeout configuration option is enabled and a Test Duration is set, the Lamp test  
stops when the test duration expires. The Lamp test is not disruptive to data.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Test Timeout  
A Test Timeout feature is available to automatically terminate a test (as opposed  
to manually terminating a test) after it has been running a specified period of  
time.  
To use this feature, enable the Test Timeout configuration option under the  
System Options branch of the menu tree, and set a duration for the test to run in  
the Test Duration (min) configuration option (see Table 5-9, System Options in  
Chapter 5, Setting Up).  
Starting and Stopping a Test  
Use this procedure to start and/or abort specific tests. To abort all active tests on  
all interfaces, see Aborting All Tests on page 9-44.  
When the status of a test is . . .  
The only command available is . . .  
Inactive  
Active  
Start  
Stop  
You start or stop an individual test using the same general procedure. For more  
specific instructions, see the individual test descriptions in this chapter.  
" Procedure  
To start or stop a test:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Test  
2. Select a test screen for an interface and press Return. The selected test  
screen appears, with the cursor positioned in the Command column of the  
first line (available test).  
Start or Stop appears in the Command column, and Active or Inactive  
appears in the Status column, based upon the test’s current status for that  
interface.  
3. Select the test you want to start or stop and press Return. The selected test  
for the interface changes from Stop to Start, or from Stop to Start, also  
changing the status of the test.  
4. Press Return again to start or stop the test.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
9-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Aborting All Tests  
Use the Abort All Tests selection from the Test menu to abort all tests running on  
all interfaces, with exception to Network- or DTE-initiated loopbacks. To abort  
individual tests that are active, see Starting and Stopping a Test on page 9-43.  
" Procedure  
To abort all tests on all interfaces:  
1. Follow this menu selection sequence:  
Main Menu Test  
2. Select Abort All Tests and press Return.  
Command Complete appears when all tests on all interfaces have been  
terminated.  
NOTE:  
Abort All Tests does not interrupt DTE-initiated loopbacks.  
Determining Test Status and Results  
Current test status and results are available on the:  
H
H
H
H
Test screen from where you execute the test  
System and Test Status screen  
NMS  
Test LED  
For more information on interpreting results and messages, see Chapter 7,  
Displaying System Information.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
9-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration  
Worksheets  
A
Menus  
The following menus give you a graphical representation of the system options  
that appear on the async terminal screens. Not all options are available, but are  
filtered depending on what other options have been selected.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
A-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Menu  
MAIN MENU  
Status  
MAIN MENU  
Status  
Test  
Test  
Configuration  
Control  
Configuration  
Control  
Test  
Status  
Network Tests  
System and Test Status  
DSX-1 Tests  
Voice Status  
Sync Data Port Tests  
Voice Port Tests  
OCU-DP Tests  
Device Tests  
Cross Connect Status  
Performance Statistics  
Identity  
Abort Tests  
Network Channel Display  
DSX-1 Channel Display  
Port Assignment Display  
Network  
System & NAM  
APM  
Sync Data Ports  
Clear Statistics  
MAIN MENU  
Status  
MAIN MENU  
Status  
Test  
Configuration  
Control  
Test  
Configuration  
Control  
Load  
Configuration  
from:  
Configuration Edit/Display  
Network  
DSX-1  
Control  
COM Port Call Setup  
COM Port Call Directories  
Device Name  
Sync Data Ports  
Voice Ports  
Date & Time  
OCU-DP  
Administer Logins  
System Alarm Relay Cut-Off  
Clear Device Fail  
Reset Device  
Copy Ports  
Cross Connect  
System Options  
User Interface  
Alarm  
Management and Communication  
DSX-1 to Network  
Assignments  
Communication Port  
Communication  
Protocol  
External Device  
(Com Port)  
Network to Network  
Assignments  
General SNMP  
Management  
Telnet/FTP Sessions  
Voice Port  
Assignments  
SNMP NMS Security  
SNMP Traps  
Sync Data Port  
Assignments  
OCU-DP Port  
Assignments  
98-15081-03  
Clear Assignments  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
A-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Recording Configurations  
It is recommended that you keep a record of each T1 access unit’s configuration,  
which can also be used when configuring the T1 access unit. For additional  
information about configurations, refer to Chapter 5, Setting Up.  
" Procedure  
1. Photocopy or print the worksheets included in this appendix. Make as many  
copies of each table as needed.  
2. Write the T1 access unit’s Device Name on each photocopied or printed  
page.  
3. Write in or circle the settings that are different from the default setting.  
Do this for each of the alternate configurations stored in Customer  
Configuration 1 and 2, as well. Store these records for reference, as needed.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
A-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Device Name: ___________________________________________________________  
Network  
See Table 5-1  
Configuration Option  
Settings  
Default in [Bold]  
1
Interface Status  
Enable, [Disable]  
D4, [ESF]  
Line Framing Format  
Line Coding Format  
Line Build Out (LBO)  
Bit Stuffing  
AMI, [B8ZS]  
[0.0], –7.5, –15, –22.5  
[62411], Part68, Disable  
[Enable], Disable  
[Enable], Disable  
[System], Network  
Enable, [Disable]  
Network Initiated LLB  
Network Initiated PLB  
2
Transmit Timing  
ANSI Performance Report  
Messages  
Management Link  
[Disable], FDL, DDL  
3
IP Address  
[000.000.000.000] – 223.255.255.255, Clear  
[000.000.000.000] – 255.255.255.255, Clear  
None, [Proprietary]  
Subnet Mask  
Routing Information Protocol  
Network Time Slot  
0124 [lowest available time slot]  
Text field  
Circuit Identifier  
Loss of Signal (LOS) Alarm  
Out of Frame (OOF) Alarm  
[Enable], Disable  
[Enable], Disable  
Alarm Indication Signal (AIS) Alarm [Enable], Disable  
Yellow Alarm [Enable], Disable  
Excessive Error Rate (EER) Alarm [Enable], Disable  
Excessive Error Rate Threshold  
[10E-4], 10E-5, 10E-6, 10E-7, 10E-8, 10E-9  
1
Read-only when Network is set to 1.  
2
This first byte cannot be set to 0 nor 127. However, the null address of 0.0.0 is valid  
after performing a Clear.  
3
Only shown when 9261 Dual T1 NAM is being used.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
A-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Device Name: ___________________________________________________________  
DSX-1  
See Table 5-2  
Settings  
Configuration Option  
Default in [Bold]  
Slot ss  
916x: 01  
9262: 02  
9265: 02, 03, 04, 05  
Port p  
916x: 1  
926x: 1, 2  
Interface Status  
Enable, [Disable]  
D4, [ESF]  
Line Framing Format  
Line Coding Format  
AMI, [B8ZS]  
Line Equalization  
[0–133], 133–266, 266–399, 399–533, 533–655  
[Enable], Disable  
Send All Ones on DSX-1 Failure  
Loss of Signal (LOS) Alarm  
Out of Frame (OOF) Alarm  
Alarm Indication Signal (AIS)  
Yellow Alarm  
[Enable], Disable  
[Enable], Disable  
[Enable], Disable  
[Enable], Disable  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
A-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Device Name: ___________________________________________________________  
Sync Data Ports  
See Table 5-3  
Settings  
Configuration Option  
Default in [Bold]  
Slot ss  
916x: 01  
9x62: 01, 02  
9x65: 01, 02, 03, 04, 05  
Port p  
T1 NAM: 1, 2  
Sync Data APM: 1, 2, 3, 4  
Port Status  
Enable, [Disable]  
[E530], V.35, RS449, X.21  
[Nx64], Nx56  
Port Type  
Port Base Rate  
Transmit Clock Source  
Invert Transmit Clock  
[Internal], External  
Enable, [Disable]  
Invert Transmit and Received Data Enable, [Disable]  
Send All Ones on Data Port Not  
Ready  
Disable, DTR, RTS, [Both]  
Action on Network Yellow Alarm  
None, [Halt]  
Network Initiated Data Channel  
Loopback (DCLB)  
[Disable], V.54, FT1, Both  
Port (DTE) Initiated Loopbacks  
Embedded Data Link  
[Disable], DTPLB, DCLB, Both  
Enable, [Disable]  
EDL Management Link  
Enable, [Disable]  
1
IP Address  
[000.000.000.000] – 223.255.255.255, Clear  
[000.000.000.000] – 255.255.255.255, Clear  
None, [Proprietary]  
Subnet Mask  
Routing Information Protocol  
Near-End Performance Statistics  
Far-End Performance Statistics  
Out of Frame (OOF) Alarm  
[Disable], Maintain, Send, Both  
[Disable], Maintain  
[Enable], Disable  
Excessive Error Rate (EER) Alarm [Enable], Disable  
Excessive Error Rate Threshold  
[10E-4], 10E-5, 10E-6, 10E-7, 10E-8, 10E-9  
1
The first byte cannot be set to 0 nor 127. However, the null address of 0.0.0.0 is valid  
after performing a Clear.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
A-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Device Name: ___________________________________________________________  
Voice Ports  
Configuration Option  
E&M Voice  
Settings  
Default in [Bold]  
See Table 5-4  
Slot ss  
2-slot: 02  
5-slot: 02, 03, 04, 05  
Port p  
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8  
Enable, [Disable]  
[E&M], Transmit Only  
Port Status  
Operating Mode  
Rx Gain (dB)  
–17.0, –16.5, –16.0, –15.5, –15.0, ..., [0.0],  
...,+6.5, +7.0, +7.5  
Tx Attenuation (dB)  
Trunk Cond in CGA  
–17.0, –16.5, –16.0, –15.5, –15.0, ..., [0.0],  
...,+6.5, +7.0, +7.5  
[Busy], Idle  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
A-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Device Name: ___________________________________________________________  
Voice Ports  
Configuration Option  
FXO Voice  
Settings  
Default in [Bold]  
See Table 5-5  
Slot ss  
2-slot: 02  
5-slot: 02, 03, 04, 05  
Port p  
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8  
Port Status  
Enable, [Disable]  
Operating Mode  
Signaling Type  
[FXO], FXODN, FXODN/WINK, DPT  
[Loop-Start], Loop-Start/Fwd Disc, Ground-Start  
[600], 900  
Terminating Impedance (ohms)  
Wink Delay (10 ms)  
Wink Duration (10 ms)  
Rx Gain (dB)  
1 – 99  
1 – 99  
[15]  
[20]  
–10.00, –9.5, –9.0, –8.5, ..., [0.0], +0.5, +1.0, +1.5,  
+2.0  
Tx Attenuation (dB)  
Trunk Cond in CGA  
–10.00, –9.5, –9.0, –8.5, ..., [0.0], ..., +4.0, +4.5,  
+5.0  
[Busy], Idle  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
A-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Voice Ports  
Configuration Option  
FXS Voice  
Settings  
Default in [Bold]  
See Table 5-6  
Slot ss  
2-slot: 02  
5-slot: 02, 03, 04, 05  
Port p  
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8  
Port Status  
Operating Mode  
Signaling Type  
Enable, [Disable]  
[FXS], FXSDN, FXSDN/WINK, PLAR, DPO  
[Loop-Start], Loop-Start/Fwd Disc, Ground-Start,  
Ground-Start-Immediate, Ground-Start-Automatic,  
d3, d4  
Terminating Impedance (ohms)  
Wink Delay (10 ms)  
Wink Duration (10 ms)  
Rx Gain (dB)  
[600], 900  
1 – 99  
1 – 99  
[15]  
[20]  
–10.00, –9.5, –9.0, –8.5, ..., [0.0], +0.5, +1.0, +1.5,  
+2.0  
Tx Attenuation (dB)  
–10.00, –9.5, –9.0, –8.5, ..., [0.0], ..., +4.0, +4.5,  
+5.0  
Ring-Back Tone  
Enable, [Disable]  
Trunk Cond in CGA  
[Busy], Idle  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
A-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Device Name: ___________________________________________________________  
OCU-DP Ports  
Configuration Option  
Slot ss  
See Table 5-7  
Settings  
Default in [Bold]  
9x62: 02  
9x65: 02, 03, 04, 05  
Port p  
2-port: 1, 2  
6-port: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6  
Port Status  
Enable, [Disable]  
[56K], 64KCC, Switched_56  
[Enable], Disable  
[Enable], Disable  
[Enable], Disable  
[Enable], Disable  
[Enable], Disable  
[Enable], Disable  
Port Rate  
Loopback Detection  
Loss of Signal Alarm  
Abnormal Station Code Alarm  
64KCC Loop OOF Alarm  
DDS Network Failure Alarm  
Loss of Loop Timing Alarm  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
A-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Device Name: ___________________________________________________________  
Copy Ports  
Configuration Option  
Settings  
Default in [Bold]  
From: Slot ss  
2-Slot: 01, 02  
5-Slot: 01, 02, 03, 04, 05  
From: Port p  
T1 NAM: 1, 2  
Sync Data APM: 1, 2, 3, 4  
Voice APM: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8  
OCU-DP (2-port): 1, 2  
OCU-DP (6-port): 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6  
Type  
T1 NAM, Sync Data, FXS Voice, FXO Voice, E&M  
Voice, OCU-DP  
To: Slot ss  
2-Slot: All, 01, 02  
5-Slot: All, 01, 02, 03, 04, 05 [lowest numbered  
slot containing the same port type]  
To: Port p  
All, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8  
Perform Copy  
n/a  
n/a  
Perform Copy Then Increment  
System Options  
See Table 5-9  
Configuration Option  
Generate Yellow Alarm Signals  
Test Timeout  
Settings  
Default in [Bold]  
[Enable], Disable  
[Enable], Disable  
1 – 120 [10]  
Test Duration (min)  
Primary Clock Source  
[Net1], Net2, DSXss-p, Internal, External, Sync  
Data  
Port (for Primary Clock Source)  
Secondary Clock Source  
SssPp [the first available port]  
Net1, Net2, DSXss-p, [Internal], External, Sync  
Data  
Port (for Secondary Clock Source) SssPp [the first available port]  
External Clock Rate (KHz)  
Primary Clock Failure Alarm  
Secondary Clock Failure Alarm  
8, [1544], 2048  
[Enable], Disable  
[Enable], Disable  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
A-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Device Name: ___________________________________________________________  
User Interface  
Configuration Option  
Communication Port  
Port Use  
Settings  
Default in [Bold]  
See Table 5-10  
[Terminal], Net Link, Alarm  
Port Type  
[Asynchronous], Synchronous  
1
RIP  
[None], Proprietary  
Port Type – Synchronous  
Clock Source  
[Internal], External  
2
Data Rate (Kbps)  
9.6, 14.4, [19.2], 28.8, 38.4, 57.6, 115.2  
Port Type – Asynchronous  
Data Rate (Kbps)  
9.6, 14.4, [19.2], 28.8, 38.4 57.6, 115.2  
7, [8]  
3
Character Length  
3
Parity  
[None], Even, Odd  
[1], 1.5 ,2  
3
Stop Bits  
3
Ignore Control Leads  
[Disable], DTR  
4
Login Required  
Enable, [Disable]  
[Level-1], Level-2, Level-3  
Enable, [Disable]  
4
Port Access Level  
4
Inactivity Timeout  
4,5  
Disconnect Time (Minutes)  
1 – 60 [5]  
External Device (COM Port)  
See Table 5-11  
[Disable], AT, Other  
External Device Commands  
6
Dial-In Access  
Enable, [Disable]  
7
Connect Prefix  
ASCII text entry, Clear  
ASCII text entry, Clear  
ASCII text entry, Clear  
[None], 0.2, 0.4, 0.6, 0.8, 1.0  
ASCII text entry, Clear  
7
Connect Indication String  
7
Escape Sequence  
7
Escape Sequence Delay (Sec)  
7
Disconnect String  
1
Only shown when Port Use is set to Net Link.  
2
3
4
5
6
7
Only shown when Clock Source is set to Internal.  
Only shown when Port Type is set to Asynchronous.  
Only shown when Port Use is set to Terminal.  
Only shown when Inactivity Timeout is set to Enable.  
Only shown when External Device Commands is set to Other or AT.  
Only shown when External Device Commands is set to Other.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
A-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Device Name: ___________________________________________________________  
User Interface (Cont’d)  
Configuration Option  
Telnet/FTP Sessions  
Telnet Session  
Settings  
Default in [Bold]  
See Table 5-12  
Enable, [Disable]  
Enable, [Disable]  
[Level-1], Level-2, Level-3  
Enable, [Disable]  
Telnet Login Required  
Session Access Level  
Inactivity Timeout  
Disconnect Time (Minutes)  
FTP Session  
1 – 60  
[5]  
Enable, [Disable]  
FTP Login Required  
Enable, [Disable]  
Alarm  
See Table 5-13  
Settings  
Configuration Option  
ASCII Alarm Messages  
Alarm & Trap Dial Out  
Trap Disconnect  
Default in [Bold]  
Com Port, [Disable]  
Enable, [Disable]  
[Enable], Disable  
Enable, [Disable]  
1 – 10 [5]  
Call Retry  
Dial-Out Delay Time (Min)  
Alternate Dial-Out Directory  
System Alarm Relay  
[None], 1 – 5  
Enable, [Disable]  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
A-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Device Name: ___________________________________________________________  
Management and Communication  
Configuration Option  
Settings  
Default in [Bold]  
Communication Protocol  
See Table 5-14  
1
Node IP Address  
[000.000.000.000] – 223.255.255.255, Clear  
[000.000.000.000] – 255.255.255.255, Clear  
[None], COM, FDL1, FDL2, DDL, EDLss-p  
[000.000.000.000] – 223.255.255.255, Clear  
[000.000.000.000] – 255.255.255.255, Clear  
[PPP], SLIP  
Node Subnet Mask  
Default Network Destination  
Communication Port IP Address  
1
Communication Port Subnet Mask  
Communication Port Link Protocol  
Alternate Communication Port IP  
[000.000.000.000] – 223.255.255.255, Clear  
1
Address  
Alternate Communication Port  
Subnet Mask  
[000.000.000.000] – 255.255.255.255, Clear  
General SNMP Management See Table 5-15  
SNMP Management  
Community Name 1  
Name 1 Access  
Enable, [Disable]  
ASCII text entry [Public], Clear  
[Read], Read/Write  
Community Name 2  
Name 2 Access  
ASCII text entry, [Clear]  
[Read], Read/Write  
SNMP NMS Security  
NMS IP Validation  
Number of Managers  
See Table 5-16  
Enable, [Disable]  
[1] – 10 [1]  
1
NMS n IP Address  
[000.000.000.000] – 223.255.255.255, Clear  
[Read], Read/Write  
Access Level  
SNMP Traps  
See Table 5-17  
SNMP Traps  
Enable, [Disable]  
Number of Trap Managers  
[1] – 6 [1]  
1
NMS n IP Address  
[000.000.000.000] – 223.255.255.255, Clear  
[Default], COM, FDL1, FDL2, DDL, EDLss-p  
Disable, Warm, AuthFail, [Both]  
Enable, [Disable]  
Destination  
General Traps  
Enterprise Specific Traps  
Link Traps  
Disable, Up, Down, [Both]  
Network, DSX-1, T1s, Ports, [All]  
Link Traps Interfaces  
1
The first byte cannot be set to 0 nor 127. However, the null address of 0.0.0.0 is valid  
after performing a Clear.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
A-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Channel Assignments Worksheets  
Use the following worksheets to record cross connection assignments. See  
Assigning Cross Connections in Chapter 5, Setting Up, for more information.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
A-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
Network T1 Interface ___ Channel Worksheet  
Network ___  
Channel  
Signaling and  
Trunk Conditioning  
Allocation  
N1  
N2  
N3  
N4  
N5  
N6  
N7  
N8  
N9  
N10  
N11  
N12  
N13  
N14  
N15  
N16  
N17  
N18  
N19  
N20  
N21  
N22  
N23  
N24  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
A-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
DSX-1 T1 Interface ___ Channel Worksheet  
DSX-1 Signaling and  
Trunk Conditioning  
DSX ___ Channel  
Allocation  
D1  
D2  
D3  
D4  
D5  
D6  
D7  
D8  
D9  
D10  
D11  
D12  
D13  
D14  
D15  
D16  
D17  
D18  
D19  
D20  
D21  
D22  
D23  
D24  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
A-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menus and Configuration Worksheets  
This page intentionally left blank.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
A-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IP Addressing  
B
Selecting an IP Addressing Scheme  
You can select from many IP addressing schemes to provide SNMP NMS, Telnet,  
or FTP connectivity. When selecting a scheme, keep the following in mind:  
H
Because connection to remote devices is through different interfaces (for  
EDL), it may be necessary to assign IP addresses and subnet masks to each  
EDL individually.  
H
Avoid multiple EDL connections between the same two devices to prevent  
routing loops.  
H
H
Assign IP addresses on a per-interface or T1 access unit basis.  
Although routing information is automatically passed between interconnected  
T1 access units from the network side, make sure to set a route to the  
subnet(s) in the NMS’s or local router’s routing table.  
The gateway to subnet(s) is through the T1 access unit connected to:  
— The LAN (using a LAN adapter), or  
To a router’s, terminal server’s, or NMS’s direct PPP (point-to-point  
protocol) or SLIP (link-layer protocol for IP traffic) serial connection.  
H
H
H
Each T1 unit’s routing table supports a maximum of 300 routes, even though  
a single route is all that is needed to reach every device on a subnet.  
Have a default route set only for devices directly connected to the NMS’s  
COM port.  
Allow any legal host address for a given subnet; the address choice within  
the subnet is not important to the unit, but should be selected in conjunction  
with all IP addressing for the subnet.  
H
H
For a point-to-point ESF T1 link, use the FDL to connect to the remote site.  
For a fractional T1 network, use EDL(s) to connect to each remote site (when  
at least one data port is configured at that site).  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
B-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IP Addressing  
H
For a fractional T1 network when a data port is not configured (in the case of  
voice only), a single DDL can be used to connect to a remote site.  
NOTE:  
When dealing with IP addressing, your Information Systems (IS) department  
needs to be involved since they typically dictate the IP addressing scheme  
used in an organization.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
B-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IP Addressing  
IP Addressing Scheme Examples  
The following examples describe some typical network scenarios; they are not  
the only scenarios that can be used. The subnet mask shown for each T1 access  
unit is 255.255.255.0.  
Direct Management Links to Remote T1 Access Units  
In this example, T1 Access Unit A is connected to:  
H
H
The NMS at the central site  
Each remote T1 access unit through a management link (multiple EDLs)  
SNMP NMS  
Ethernet  
135.18.40.1  
B
C
D
135.18.2.17  
135.18.2.18  
LAN Adapter  
COM Port  
T1  
Network  
IP Address: 135.18.40.3  
A
135.18.2.1  
135.18.2.26  
Subnet 135.18.40.0  
Subnet 135.18.2.0  
496-15185  
Physical Connection  
EDL Management Link  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
B-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IP Addressing  
Routing to Remote T1 Access Units on the Same Subnet  
In this example, T1 Access Unit A is connected to:  
H
H
The NMS at the central site  
Remote T1 access units through EDL management links  
The illustration shows two management EDL management links at the central  
site, with T1 Access Units B and C connected through one EDL management  
link.  
SNMP NMS  
Ethernet  
135.18.40.1  
B
C
D
135.18.2.17  
135.18.2.18  
LAN Adapter  
COM Port  
T1  
Network  
IP Address: 135.18.40.3  
A
135.18.2.1  
135.18.2.26  
Subnet 135.18.40.0  
Subnet 135.18.2.0  
496-15186  
Physical Connection  
EDL Management Link  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
B-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IP Addressing  
Routing to Remote Access Units Using Different Subnets  
In this example, T1 Access Unit A is connected to:  
H
H
The NMS at the central site  
Two remote T1 access units through EDL management links  
The illustration shows two EDL management links, with T1 Access Units B and C  
connected through one EDL management link. By configuring a different IP  
address and subnet for each management link:  
H
H
H
T1 Access Units B and C share a subnet: 135.18.3.0  
T1 Access Units A and B share a different subnet: 135.18.2.0  
T1 Access Units A and D share yet another subnet: 135.18.4.0  
Subnet 135.18.40.0  
SNMP NMS  
Subnet 135.18.2.0  
135.18.2.2  
*
Ethernet  
B
135.18.40.1  
135.18.3.2  
LAN Adapter  
COM Port  
C
IP Address: 135.18.40.3  
T1  
Network  
135.18.2.1  
A
135.18.3.3  
Subnet 135.18.3.0  
D
135.18.4.1  
Subnet 135.18.4.0  
135.18.4.26  
Physical Connection  
EDL Management Link  
This subnet connection can be to any of the following:  
• SNMP NMS via the COM Port  
*
• LAN adapter via the COM Port  
Terminal server via the COM Port  
496-15187  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
B-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IP Addressing  
Routing to Remote T1 Access Units Using Routers  
In the following example, each T1 access unit receives its management traffic  
through a connection from the COM port to the serial port of a router. In this case,  
the units do not route data among themselves, but rely on the IP routers to route  
management traffic for the remote T1 access units using data streams configured  
between the routers.  
Each T1 Access Unit is configured to be on its own subnet, having a subnet mask  
of FF.FF.FF.00. This subnet is independent of the subnet on the LAN supported  
by the local router.  
Subnet 135.18.1.0  
SNMP NMS  
Subnet 135.18.5.0  
135.18.5.2  
135.18.1.2  
COM  
Router:  
135.18.5.1  
Serial  
Port  
Router:  
135.18.1.1  
Router:  
135.18.2..  
Serial  
Port  
Router:  
135.18.4.1  
T1  
Network  
Subnet 135.18.2.0  
COM  
Subnet 135.18.6.0  
135.18.6.2  
135.18.4.2  
Subnet 135.18.4.0  
COM  
Router:  
135.18.6.1  
Serial  
Port  
Router:  
135.18.3..  
Subnet 135.18.3.0  
497-15196-01  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
B-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IP Addressing  
Assigning IP Addresses and Subnet Masks  
Once you select an IP scheme, assign an address (or addresses) to the T1  
access unit.  
If using . . .  
Then . . .  
COM port as a  
management interface  
Assign the COM port address and net mask.  
Menu selection sequence:  
Main MenuConfigurationManagement &  
CommunicationCommunication Protocol  
COM port connected to an  
external modem  
Configure using an alternate IP address.  
Menu selection sequence:  
Main MenuConfigurationManagement &  
CommunicationCommunication Protocol  
FDL, DDL, or EDL  
management links  
Assign IP addresses and net masks to each management  
link.  
Menu selection sequences:  
Main MenuConfigurationNetwork (for FDL and  
DDL)  
Main MenuConfigurationSync Data Ports (for EDL)  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
B-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IP Addressing  
This page intentionally left blank.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
B-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Traps  
C
This section describes the T1 access unit’s compliance with SNMP format  
standards and with its special operational trap features. The T1 access unit  
supports the following user interface traps, along with several enterprise-specific  
traps:  
H
warmStart  
H
H
H
authenticationFailure  
linkUp  
linkDown  
These traps are listed in alphabetical order within each table.  
Trap: warmStart  
Trap  
What It Indicates  
Possible Cause  
warmStart  
T1 access unit has just  
reinitialized and stabilized  
itself.  
H Reset command sent.  
H Power disruption.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
C-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SNMP Traps  
Trap: authentificationFailure  
Trap  
What It Indicates  
Possible Cause  
authenticationFailure  
Access to the T1 access  
unit was attempted and  
failed.  
H SNMP protocol message not  
properly authenticated.  
H Three unsuccessful attempts  
were made to enter a correct  
login/password combination.  
H IP address security is  
enabled, and a message was  
received from SNMP Manager  
whose address was not on the  
list of approved managers.  
Traps: linkUp and linkDown  
Trap  
What It Indicates  
Possible Cause  
linkDown  
The link is down.  
A failure in one of the  
communication interfaces has  
occurred.  
linkUp  
The link is operational.  
One of the failed communication  
interfaces is up and operational.  
The interfaces that support these traps and conditions that define linkUp and  
linkDown for each interface:  
linkUp/Down  
Variable-Bindings  
Interface  
Possible Cause  
PHYSICAL SUBLAYER – Represented by the entry in the MIB II Interfaces Table.  
Network and DSX-1  
interfaces  
H ifIndex (RFC 1573)  
H linkDown – One or more  
alarm conditions are active on  
the interface.  
H ifAdminStatus  
(Supported by the  
DS1 MIB.)  
(RFC 1573)  
Alarm conditions include:  
– Loss of Signal (LOS)  
– Out of Frame (OOF)  
H ifOperStatus (RFC 1573)  
H ifType (RFC 1573)  
– Alarm Indication Signal  
(AIS)  
H dsx1LineStatus  
(RFC 1406)  
– Excessive Error Rate (EER)  
Yellow Alarm  
H linkUp – No alarms on the  
interface.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
C-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SNMP Traps  
linkUp/Down  
Variable-Bindings  
Interface  
Possible Cause  
Synchronous  
Data Ports  
H ifIndex (RFC 1573)  
H linkDown – One or more  
alarm conditions are active on  
the port.  
H ifAdminStatus  
(Supported by the  
media-specific  
RS232-Like MIB.)  
(RFC 1573)  
Alarm conditions include:  
H ifOperStatus (RFC 1573)  
H ifType (RFC 1573)  
1
– DTR Off  
1
– RTS Off  
– Out of Frame (OOF) for the  
Embedded Data Link  
2
(EDL)  
– Excessive Error Rate for  
the Embedded Data Link  
2
(EDL)  
H linkUp – No alarms on the  
port.  
OCU Ports  
H ifIndex (RFC 1573)  
H linkDown – One or more  
alarm conditions are active on  
the interface.  
(Represented by an  
entry in the MIB-II  
interfaces table.)  
H ifAdminStatus  
(RFC 1573)  
Alarm conditions include:  
– Loss of Signal  
H ifOperStatus (RFC 1573)  
H ifType (RFC 1573)  
– Abnormal Station Code  
– 64KCC Loop OOF  
3
– DDS Net Failure  
– Loss of Loop Timing  
H linkUp – No alarms on the  
port.  
1
The DTR alarm condition will only generate a linkUp/linkDown trap if the DTE  
supports the DTR lead state (Send All Ones on Data Port Not Ready configuration  
option on the Main Menu Configuration Sync Data Ports branch).  
The OOF and EER alarm condition will only generate a linkUp/linkDown trap if the  
EDL is enabled on that port (Embedded Data Link configuration option on the  
Main Menu Configuration Sync Data Ports branch).  
2
3
xxxxxx is the failure code  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
C-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Traps  
Traps: Enterprise-Specific  
These traps indicate that an enterprise-specific event has occurred. Supported  
enterprise-specific traps include the following, listed in alphabetical order:  
Trap  
What It Indicates  
Possible Cause  
enterpriseAPMFailed(9)  
The APM cannot be detected.  
The APM has failed or has been  
removed.  
enterpriseAPMFailedClear (109)  
enterpriseConfigChange(6)  
The APM failure has cleared.  
The APM failure has cleared.  
Configuration has been changed  
via the user interface or an SNMP  
Manager after 60 seconds has  
elapsed without another change.  
Configuration has been changed  
via the user interface or an SNMP  
Manager.  
enterpriseDeviceFail(3)  
An internal device failure.  
Operating software has detected  
an internal device failure.  
enterpriseModuleMisConfig (8)  
A module misconfiguration has  
been detected.  
An APM is installed in a slot that  
previously contained another type  
of APM.  
enterpriseModuleMisConfigClear(108)  
enterprisePowerSupply(7)  
A module misconfiguration error  
condition has been cleared.  
The operating software no longer  
detects a misconfiguration.  
The power supply output voltage  
has dropped below the tolerance  
level.  
Power supply problem.  
enterprisePowerSupplyClear(107)  
enterprisePrimaryClockFail(1)  
The power supply output voltage  
alarm condition has cleared.  
The power supply output voltage  
alarm condition has cleared.  
A failure of the device’s currently  
configured primary clock source.  
Operating software has detected  
that the primary clock source has  
failed.  
enterprisePrimaryClockFailClear(101)  
enterpriseSecondaryClockFail(4)  
The failure of the device’s currently Operating software has detected  
configured primary clock source  
has cleared.  
that the primary clock source is  
now operational again.  
A failure of the device’s currently  
configured secondary clock  
source.  
Operating software has detected  
that the secondary clock source  
has failed.  
enterpriseSecondaryClockFailClear(104) The failure of the device’s currently Operating software has detected  
configured secondary clock source that the secondary clock source is  
has cleared.  
now operational again.  
enterpriseSelfTestFail(2)  
A hardware failure.  
Unit has completed (re)initialization  
and a hardware failure was  
detected.  
enterpriseTestStart(5)  
A test is running.  
At least one test has been started  
on an interface.  
enterpriseTestStop(105)  
All tests have been halted.  
All tests have been halted on an  
interface.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
C-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SNMP Traps  
The tests that support these traps and conditions that define enterpriseTestStart  
and enterpriseTestStop for each interface:  
enterpriseTestStart/Stop  
Variable-Bindings  
Interface  
For These Tests  
Network and DSX-1  
T1 Interfaces  
H ifIndex (RFC 1573)  
H All  
H ifAdminStatus  
(RFC 1573)  
H ifOperStatus (RFC 1573)  
H ifType (RFC 1573)  
H dsx1SendCode  
H Remote Line Loopback  
H Send 511 pattern  
H Send 3 in 24  
(RFC 1406)  
H Send QRSS  
H dsx1LoopbackConfig  
H Line Loopback  
H Payload Loopback  
(RFC 1406)  
H devDS1TestType  
H Repeater Loopback  
H Send All Zeroes  
H Send All Ones  
H Send 1-in-8  
(devDS1Config.mib)  
H Send 63  
H Send 2047  
15  
H Send 2 -1  
20  
H Send 2 -1  
H Send user-defined pattern  
H All Monitor patterns  
Synchronous  
Data Ports  
H ifIndex (RFC 1573)  
H DTE Loopback  
H ifAdminStatus  
H DTE Payload Loopback  
H Data Channel Loopback  
H Send V.54 Loopback  
H Send FT1 Loopback  
H Send pattern tests  
(RFC 1573)  
H ifOperStatus (RFC 1573)  
H ifType (RFC 1573)  
H devSyncPortTestType  
(devDataPortConfig.mib)  
H Monitor pattern tests  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
C-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Traps  
enterpriseTestStart/Stop  
Variable-Bindings  
Interface  
For These Tests  
OCU Ports  
H ifIndex (RFC 1573)  
H Latching CSU and DSU  
Loopbacks  
H ifAdminStatus  
(RFC 1573)  
H Nonlatching CSU and DSU  
Loopbacks  
H ifOperStatus (RFC 1573)  
H ifType (RFC 1573)  
H OCU Loopback  
H DS-0 Loopback  
H Line Loopback  
H Data Loopback  
H devOcuTestType  
(devOcu.mib)  
H Remote Latching CSU, DSU  
and OCU Loopbacks  
H Remote Nonlatching CSU,  
DSU and OCU Loopbacks  
H Send pattern tests  
H Monitor pattern tests  
Voice Ports  
H ifIndex (RFC 1573)  
H Digital Loopback  
H Analog Loopback  
H Line Loopback  
H ifAdminStatus  
(RFC 1573)  
H ifOperStatus (RFC 1573)  
H ifType (RFC 1573)  
H Send DRS tone to T1 interface  
and user  
H Send quiet tone to T1  
H devVoiceTestType  
interface and user  
(devVoice.mib)  
H Monitor pattern tests  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
C-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Cross-Reference  
D
This appendix provides a correlation between how a function is performed or  
status is displayed on the user interface and how the same function is  
accomplished using access to the SNMP database (Table D-1). SNMP objects  
are displayed in bold type while values for SNMP objects are displayed in italics.  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (1 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
STATUS  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/status/system Health & Status:  
Read:  
Power Supply Alarm  
LOS at Net/DSX-1  
OOF at Net/DSX-1  
AIS at Net/DSX-1  
EER at Net  
Yellow at Net/DSX-1  
APM Card Failed  
devHealthAndStatus  
dsx1LossOfSignal from dsx1LineStatus for interface  
dsx1LossOfFrame from dsx1LineStatus for interface  
dsx1RcvAIS from dsx1LineStatus for interface  
dsx1OtherFailure from dsx1LineStatus for interface  
dsx1RcvFarEndLOF from dsx1LineStatus for interface  
devHealthAndStatus  
Module MisConfig  
devHealthAndStatus  
Module Unsupported  
OOF (EDL)  
devHealthAndStatus  
devHealthAndStatus  
Out of Sync, Slot xx Group g  
EER (EDL)  
devHealthAndStatus  
devHealthAndStatus  
Loss of Signal, ss-p  
Abnormal Station Code, ss-p  
64KCC Loop OOF, ss-p  
DDS Net Failure xxxxxx, ss-p  
Loss of Loop Timing, ss-p  
Primary Clock Failed  
Secondary Clock Failed  
Network Com Link Down  
Device Fail  
devHealthAndStatus  
devHealthAndStatus  
devHealthAndStatus  
devHealthAndStatus  
devHealthAndStatus  
devHealthAndStatus  
devHealthAndStatus  
down from ifOperStatus for the COM port interface  
devHealthAndStatus  
main/status/system Self-Test Results:  
All Self-Test Results  
Read:  
devSelfTestResults  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
D-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (2 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/status/system Test Status:  
Read:  
Net/DSX-1 LLB Test Active  
Net/DSX-1 PLB Test Active  
Net/DSX-1 RLB Test Active  
DCLB, Slot xx Port n  
dsx1LineLoop from dsx1LoopbackConfig for interface  
dsx1PayloadLoop from dsx1LoopbackConfig for interface  
devDS1TestControl and rlb test for interface  
devSyncPortTestControl and dclb test for interface  
devSyncPortTestControl and dtlb test for interface  
devSyncPortTestControl and plb test for interface  
devOcuTestControl and locOCULB test for interface  
devOcuTestControl and locOCULB test for interface  
devOcuTestControl and locNonLatchingCSULB test for interface  
devOcuTestControl and locLatchingCSULB test for interface  
devOcuTestControl and locNonLatchingDSULB test for interface  
devOcuTestControl and locLatchingCSULB test for interface  
devOcuTestControl and locLineLB test for interface  
devOcuTestControl and locDataLB test for interface  
devOcuTestControl and locDS0LB test for interface  
devVoiceTestAction and digitalLoopback test for interface  
devVoiceTestAction and analogLoopback test for interface  
devVoiceTestAction and lineLoopback test for interface  
devVoiceTestAction and userDRSTone or networkDRSTone for  
interface  
DTLB, Slot xx Port n  
DTPLB, Slot xx Port n  
Non-Latching OCU LB, ss-p  
Latching OCU LB, ss-p  
Non-Latching CSU LB, ss-p  
Latching CSU LB, ss-p  
Non-Latching DSU LB, ss-p  
Latching DSU LB, ss-p  
OCU Line LB, ss-p  
OCU Data LB, ss-p  
OCU DS-0 LB, ss-p  
Voice DLB, Slot xx Port n  
Voice ALB, Slot xx Port n  
Voice LLB, Slot xx Port n  
Voice DRS, Slot xx Port n  
Voice Quiet, Slot xx Port n  
Forced Signal, Slot xx Port  
devVoiceTestAction and userQuietTone or networkQuietTone for  
interface  
devVoiceTestAction and testRXBits, testTXBits, testTRLeads, or  
testELeads for interface  
Pttn Act, Network/DSX-1  
Mon Pttn, Network/DSX-1  
devDS1TestControl and send[Pttn] for interface  
devDS1TestControl and mon[Pttn] for interface  
devSyncDataTestControl and send[Pttn] for interface  
devSyncDataTestControl and mon[Pttn] for interface  
devOcuTestControl and send[Pttn] for interface  
devOcuTestControl and mon[Pttn] for interface  
devControlTestStatus  
Pttn Act, Slot xx Port n (sync port)  
Mon Pttn, Slot xx Port n (sync port)  
Pttn Act, Slot xx Port n (OCU port)  
Mon Pttn, Slot xx Port n (OCU port)  
Lamp Test Active  
main/status/voice:  
Fully supported by MIB objects (see test/port (voice) and  
config/voice_port.  
Call Progress  
devVoiceStatusCallProgState  
Trunk Condition CGA  
devVoiceStatusTrunkCondInCGA  
main/status/cross_connect:  
fully supported by devCrossConnect  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
D-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (3 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/status/performance/network  
Telco Current:  
For the network interface, Read value in:  
dsx1TimeElapsed  
Current Interval Timer  
ESF Error Events  
ES  
dsx1TelcoCurrentEvent  
dsx1CurrentES  
UAS  
SES  
BES  
CSS  
LOFC  
dsx1CurrentUAS  
dsx1CurrentSES  
dsx1CurrentBES  
dsx1CurrentCSS  
dsx1CurrentLOFC  
Telco Intervals:  
ES  
Select interval number with dsx1IntervalNumber, Read value in:  
dsx1IntervalES  
UAS  
dsx1IntervalUAS  
SES  
dsx1IntervalSES  
BES  
dsx1IntervalBES  
CSS  
dsx1IntervalCSS  
LOFC  
Select interval number with devTelcoIntervalNumber, then  
Read value in: devTelcoIntervalLOFC  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
D-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (4 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/status/performance/network  
(cont’d)  
Telco 24 Hour Totals:  
For the network interface, Read value in:  
dsx1ValidIntervals  
dsx1TotalES  
Valid Intervals  
ES  
UAS  
dsx1TotalUAS  
SES  
dsx1TotalSES  
BES  
dsx1TotalBES  
CSS  
dsx1TotalCSS  
LOFC  
devTelcoTotalLOFC  
User Current:  
For the network interface, Read value in:  
devUserCurrentTimer  
devUserCurrentEvent  
devUserCurrentESs  
Current Interval Timer  
ESF Error Events  
ES  
UAS  
SES  
BES  
CSS  
LOFC  
Status  
devUserCurrentUASs  
devUserCurrentSESs  
devUserCurrentBESs  
devUserCurrentCSSs  
devUserCurrentLOFC  
devUserCurrentStEvnt  
User Intervals:  
Select interval number with devUserIntervalNumber, then  
Read value in:  
ES  
devUserIntervalESs  
UAS  
SES  
BES  
CSS  
LOFC  
Status  
devUserIntervalUASs  
devUserIntervalSESs  
devUserIntervalBESs  
devUserIntervalCSSs  
devUserIntervalLOFC  
devUserIntervalStEvnt  
User 24 Hour Totals:  
Valid Intervals  
ES  
devUserValidIntervals  
devUserTotalESs  
UAS  
SES  
BES  
CSS  
devUserTotalUASs  
devUserTotalSESs  
devUserTotalBESs  
devUserTotalCSSs  
devUserTotalLOFC  
LOFC  
User Clear Statistics:  
For the network interface, Set devClrUserReg to clear.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
D-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (5 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/status/performance/port  
Near-End Current:  
For the port, Read value in:  
devEDLCurrentTimer  
devEDLCurrentEvent  
devEDLCurrentESs  
Current Interval Timer  
Error Events Counter  
ES  
UAS  
SES  
BES  
LOFC  
devEDLCurrentUASs  
devEDLCurrentSESs  
devEDLCurrentBESs  
devEDLCurrentLOFC  
Near-End Intervals:  
Select interval number with devEDLIntervalNumber, then Read  
value in:  
ES  
devEDLIntervalESs  
UAS  
SES  
BES  
LOFC  
devEDLIntervalUASs  
devEDLIntervalSESs  
devEDLIntervalBESs  
devEDLIntervalLOFC  
Near-End 8 Hour Totals:  
For the port, Read value in:  
devEDLTotalValidIntervals  
devEDLTotalESs  
Valid Intervals  
ES  
UAS  
devEDLTotalUASs  
SES  
devEDLTotalSESs  
BES  
devEDLTotalBESs  
LOFC  
devEDLTotalLOFC  
Near-End Clear Statistics:  
For the port, Set devEDLClrRegWhichRegs to nearRegisters and  
devEDLClrRegAction to clear.  
Far-End Current:  
For the port, Read value in:  
devEDLFarEndCurrentTimer  
devEDLFarEndCurrentEvent  
devEDLFarEndCurrentESs  
devEDLFarEndCurrentUASs  
devEDLFarEndCurrentSESs  
devEDLFarEndCurrentBESs  
devEDLFarEndCurrentLOFC  
Current Interval Timer  
Error Events Counter  
ES  
UAS  
SES  
BES  
LOFC  
Far-End Intervals:  
Select interval number with devDataPortIntervalNumber, then  
Read value in:  
ES  
devEDLFarEndIntervalESs  
UAS  
SES  
BES  
LOFC  
Complete  
devEDLFarEndIntervalUASs  
devEDLFarEndIntervalSESs  
devEDLFarEndIntervalBESs  
devEDLFarEndIntervalLOFC  
devEDLFarEndIntervalCmpl  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
D-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (6 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/status/performance/port (cont’d)  
Far-End 8 Hour Totals:  
For the port, Read value in:  
devEDLFarEndTotalValidIntervals  
devEDLFarEndTotalESs  
devEDLFarEndTotalUASs  
devEDLFarEndTotalSESs  
devEDLFarEndTotalBESs  
devEDLFarEndTotalLOFC  
devEDLFarEndTotalCmpl  
Valid Intervals  
ES  
UAS  
SES  
BES  
LOFC  
Complete  
Far-End Clear Statistics:  
For the port, Set devEDLClrRegWhichRegs to farRegisters and  
devEDLClrRegAction to clear.  
main/status/performance/clear_statistics:  
Network  
Set:  
devUserClrReg  
All Synchronous Data Ports  
Set devEDLClrRegWhichRegs to nearRegisters and farRegisters  
and devEDLClrRegsAction to clear.  
main/status/identity:  
Serial Number  
Read:  
sysDescr object from the System group  
sysDescr object from the System group  
sysDescr object from the System group  
sysDescr object from the System group  
sysName object from the System group  
sysContact object from the System group  
sysLocation object from the System group  
ifDescr object for the interface  
Model Number  
Software Revision  
Hardware Revision  
System Name  
System Contact  
System Location  
APM Type  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
D-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (7 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
TEST  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/test/network and /dsx  
Set:  
Start Line Loopback  
Stop Line Loopback  
dsx1LoopbackConfig to dsx1LineLoop for the interface  
dsx1LoopbackConfig to dsx1NoLoop for the interface  
Start Payload Loopback  
Stop Payload Loopback  
dsx1LoopbackConfig to dsx1PayloadLoop for the interface  
dsx1LoopbackConfig to dsx1NoLoop for the interface  
Start Repeater Loopback  
Stop Repeater Loopback  
devDS1TestControl for rlb on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for rlb to idle on the interface  
Send Line Loopback Up  
dsx1SendCode to dsx1SendLineCode for the network interface  
Send Line Loopback Down  
dsx1SendCode to dsx1SendResetCode for the network interface  
Start Send QRSS Pattern  
Stop Send QRSS Pattern  
dsx1SendCode to dsx1SendQRS for the interface  
dsx1SendCode to dsx1SendResetCode for the interface  
Start Send All Zeros Pattern  
Stop Send All Zeros Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for sendZeros on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for sendZeros to idle on the interface  
Start Send All Ones Pattern  
Stop Send All Ones Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for sendOnes on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for sendOnes to idle on the interface  
Start Send 1 in 8 Pattern  
Stop Send 1 in 8 Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for send1in8 on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for send1in8 to idle on the interface  
Start Send 3 in 24 Pattern  
Stop Send 3 in 24 Pattern  
dsx1SendCode to dsx1Send3in24Pattern for the interface  
dsx1SendCode to dsx1SendNoCode for the interface  
Start Send 63 Pattern  
Stop Send 63 Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for send63 on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for send63 to idle on the interface  
Start Send 511 Pattern  
Stop Send 511 Pattern  
dsx1SendCode to dsx1Send511Pattern for the interface  
dsx1SendCode to dsx1SendNoCode for the interface  
Start Send 2047 Pattern  
Stop Send 2047 Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for send2047 on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for send2047 to idle on the interface  
15  
Start Send 2 -1 Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for send2E15 on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for send2E15 to idle on the interface  
15  
Stop Send 2 -1 Pattern  
20  
Start Send 2 -1 Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for send2E20 on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for send2E20 to idle on the interface  
20  
Stop Send 2 -1 Pattern  
Start Send User-Defined Pattern  
Stop User-Defined Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for sendUserDefined on the interface and  
devDS1TestArgument to the 2-byte pattern value  
devDS1TestControl for sendUserDefined to idle on the interface  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
D-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (8 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/test/network and /dsx (cont’d)  
Set:  
Start Monitor QRSS Pattern  
Stop Monitor QRSS Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for monQRSS on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for monQRSS to idle on the interface  
Start Monitor All Zeros Pattern  
Stop Monitor All Zeros Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for monZeros on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for monZeros to idle on the interface  
Start Monitor All Ones Pattern  
Stop Monitor Alll Ones Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for monOnes on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for monOnes to idle on the interface  
Start Monitor 1 in 8 Pattern  
Stop Monitor 1 in 8 Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for mon1in8 on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for mon1in8 to idle on the interface  
Start Monitor 3 in 24 Pattern  
Stop Monitor 3 in 24 Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for mon3in24 on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for mon3in24 to idle on the interface  
Start Monitor 63 Pattern  
Stop Monitor 63 Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for mon63 on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for mon63 to idle on the interface  
Start Monitor 511 Pattern  
Stop Monitor 511 Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for mon511 on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for mon511 to idle on the interface  
Start Monitor 2047 Pattern  
Stop Monitor 2047 Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for mon2047 on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for mon2047 to idle on the interface  
15  
Start Monitor 2 -1 Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for mon2E15 on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for mon2E15 to idle on the interface  
15  
Stop Monitor 2 -1 Pattern  
20  
Start Monitor 2 -1 Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for mon2E20 on the interface  
devDS1TestControl for mon2E20 to idle on the interface  
20  
Stop Monitor 2 -1 Pattern  
Start Monitor User-Defined Pattern  
Stop Monitor User-Defined Pattern  
devDS1TestControl for monUserDefined on the interface and  
devDS1TestArgument to the 2-byte pattern value  
devDS1TestControl for monUserDefined to idle on the interface  
Inject Error  
devDS1SendControlInjectErr to inject  
Clear Monitor Error  
devDS1MonResultErrorCount to clear  
Read value in:  
Number of Errors Monitored  
Number of Errors Injected  
devDS1MonResultErrorCount  
devDS1SendControlErrorCount  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
D-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (9 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/test/port (sync data):  
Set:  
Start DTE Loopback  
Stop DTE Loopback  
devSyncPortTestControl for dtlb on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for dtlb to idle on the interface  
Start DTE Payload Loopback  
Stop DTE Payload Loopback  
devSyncPortTestControl for plb on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for plb to idle on the interface  
Start Data Channel Loopback  
Stop Data Channel Loopback  
devSyncPortTestControl for dclb on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for dclb to idle on the interface  
Send V.54 Loopback Up  
Send V.54 Loopback Down  
devSyncPortTestControl to v54dn on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for v54dn to idle on the interface  
Send FT1 Loopback Up  
Send FT1 Loopback Down  
devSyncPortTestControl for ftlup on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for ftlup to idle on the interface  
Start Send QRSS Pattern  
Stop Send QRSS Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for sendQRSS on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for sendQRSS to idle on the interface  
Start Send All Zeros Pattern  
Stop Send All Zeros Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for sendZeros on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for sendZeros to idle on the interface  
Start Send All Ones Pattern  
Stop Send All Ones Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for sendOnes on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for sendOnes to idle on the interface  
Start Send 63 Pattern  
Stop Send 63 Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for send63 on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for send63 to idle on the interface  
Start Send 511 Pattern  
Stop Send 511 Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for send511 on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for send511 to idle on the interface  
Start Send 2047 Pattern  
Stop Send 2047 Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for send2047 on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for send2047 to idle on the interface  
15  
Start Send 2 -1 Pattern  
Stop Send 2 -1 Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for send2E15 on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for send2E15 to idle on the interface  
15  
20  
Start Send 2 -1 Pattern  
Stop Send 2 -1 Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for send2E20 on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for send2E20 to idle on the interface  
20  
Start Send User-Defined Pattern  
Stop Send User-Defined Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for sendUserDefined on the interface and  
devSyncPortTestArgument to the 2-byte pattern value  
devSyncPortTestControl for sendUserDefined to idle on the  
interface  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
D-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (10 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/test/port (sync data): (cont’d)  
Set:  
Start Monitor QRSS Pattern  
Stop Monitor QRSS Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for monQRSS on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for monQRSS to idle on the interface  
Start Monitor All Zeros Pattern  
Stop Monitor All Zeros Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for monZeros on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for monZeros to idle on the interface  
Start Monitor All Ones Pattern  
Stop Monitor All Ones Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for monOnes on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for monOnes to idle on the interface  
Start Monitor 63 Pattern  
Stop Monitor 63 Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for mon63 on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for mon63 to idle on the interface  
Start Monitor 511 Pattern  
Stop Monitor 511 Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for mon511 on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for mon511 to idle on the interface  
Start Monitor 2047 Pattern  
Stop Monitor 2047 Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for mon2047 on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for mon2047 to idle on the interface  
15  
Start Monitor 2 -1 Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for mon2E15 on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for mon2E15 to idle on the interface  
15  
Stop Monitor 2 -1 Pattern  
20  
Start Monitor 2 -1 Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for mon2E20 on the interface  
devSyncPortTestControl for mon2E20 to idle on the interface  
20  
Stop Monitor 2 -1 Pattern  
Start Monitor User-Defined Pattern  
Stop Monitor User-Defined Pattern  
devSyncPortTestControl for monUserDefined on the interface and  
devSyncPortTestArgument to the 2-byte pattern value  
devSyncPortTestControl for monUserDefined to idle on the  
interface  
Inject Error  
devSyncPortSendControlInjectErr fo inject  
Clear Monitor Error  
devSyncPortMonResultErrorCount to clear  
Read value in:  
Number of Errors Monitored  
Number of Errors Injected  
devSyncPortMonResultErrorCount  
devSyncPortSendControlErrorCount  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
D-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (11 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/test/port (voice):  
Set devVoiceTestType to:  
With devVoiceTestAction set to:  
Start Digital Loopback  
Stop Digital Loopback  
digitalLoopback  
digitalLoopback  
start  
stop  
Start Analog Loopback  
Stop Analog Loopback  
analogLoopback  
analogLoopback  
start  
stop  
Start Line Loopback  
Stop Line Loopback  
lineLoopback  
lineLoopback  
start  
stop  
Start Send DRS to T1  
Stop Send DRS to T1  
networkDRSTone  
networkDRSTone  
start  
stop  
Start Send DRS to User  
Stop Send DRS to User  
userDRSTone  
userDRSTone  
start  
stop  
Start Send Quiet to T1  
Stop Send Quiet to T1  
networkQuietTone  
networkQuietTone  
start  
stop  
Start Send Quiet to User  
Stop Send Quiet to User  
userQuietTone  
userQuietTone  
start  
stop  
main/test/port (voice):  
Set Tx ABCD Bits  
Set Rx ABCD Bits  
Set devVoiceTestType to:  
testTXBits  
With devVoiceTestAction set to:  
start and devVoiceTestArgument  
specifying the ABCD bit values  
start and devVoiceTestArgument  
specifying the ABCD bit values  
testRXBits  
Set Tip & Ring Leads  
Set E-Lead State  
testTRLeads  
testELeads  
start and devVoiceTestArgument  
specifying Tip and Ring values  
start and devVoiceTestArgument  
set to idle or active  
From devVoiceTestType  
Read:  
Tx ABCD Bits  
Rx ABCD Bits  
testTXBits  
testRXBits  
Tip & Ring Leads  
E-Lead State  
M-Lead State  
testTRLeads  
testELeads  
testTRLeads  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
D-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (12 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/test/port (OCU):  
Set devOcuTestType to:  
With devOcuTestControl set to:  
Start OCU LB  
Stop OCU LB  
locOCULB  
locOCULB  
running  
idle  
Start Non-Latching CSU LB  
Stop Non-Latching CSU LB  
locNonLatchingCSULB  
locNonLatchingCSULB  
running  
idle  
Start Latching CSU LB  
Stop Latching CSU LB  
locLatchingCSULB  
locLatchingCSULB  
running  
idle  
Start Non-Latching DSU LB  
Stop Non-Latching DSU LB  
locNonLatchingDSULB  
locNonLatchingDSULB  
running  
idle  
Start Latching DSU LB  
Stop Latching DSU LB  
locLatchingDSULB  
locLatchingDSULB  
running  
idle  
Start OCU Line LB  
Stop OCU Line LB  
locLineLB  
locLineLB  
running  
idle  
Start OCU Data LB  
Stop OCU Data LB  
locDataLB  
locDataLB  
running  
idle  
Start OCU DS-0 LB  
Stop OCU DS-0 LB  
locDS0LB  
locDS0LB  
running  
idle  
Start remote Latching CSU LB  
Stop remote Latching CSU LB  
remLatchingCSULB  
remLatchingCSULB  
running  
idle  
Start remote Latching DSU LB  
Stop remote Latching DSU LB  
remLatchingDSULB  
remLatchingDSULB  
running  
idle  
Start remote Latching OCU LB  
Stop remote Latching OCU LB  
remLatchingOCULB  
remLatchingOCULB  
running  
idle  
Start remote Non-Latching CSU LB  
Stop remote Non-Latching CSU LB  
remNonLatchingCSULB  
remNonLatchingCSULB  
running  
idle  
Start remote Non-Latching DSU LB  
Stop remote Non-Latching DSU LB  
remNonLatchingDSULB  
remNonLatchingDSULB  
running  
idle  
Start remote Non-Latching OCU LB  
Stop remote Non-Latching OCU LB  
remNonLatchingOCULB  
remNonLatchingOCULB  
running  
idle  
Start Send All Zeros to User  
Stop Send All Zeros to User  
sendZerosUser  
sendZerosUser  
running  
idle  
Start Send All Ones to User  
Stop Send All Ones to User  
sendOnesUser  
sendOnesUser  
running  
idle  
Start Send 63 to User  
Stop Send 63 to User  
send63User  
send63User  
running  
idle  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
D-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (13 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/test/port (OCU) (continued):  
Set devOcuTestType to:  
With devOcuTestControl set to:  
(continued)  
Start Send 511 to User  
Stop Send 511 to User  
send511User  
send511User  
running  
idle  
Start Send 2047 to User  
Stop Send 2047 to User  
send2047User  
send2047User  
running  
idle  
Start Send All Zeros to User  
Stop Send All Zeros to User  
sendZerosT1  
sendZerosT1  
running  
idle  
Start Send All Ones to T1  
Stop Send All Ones to T1  
sendOnesT1  
sendOnesT1  
running  
idle  
Start Send 63 to T1  
Stop Send 63 to T1  
send63T1  
send63T1  
running  
idle  
Start Send 511 to T1  
Stop Send 511 to User  
send511T1  
send511User  
running  
idle  
Start Send 2047 to T1  
Stop Send 2047 to T1  
send2047T1  
send2047T1  
running  
idle  
Inject Error  
Set devOcuSendControlInjectErr to inject  
Set devOcuMonResultErrorCount  
Read value from devOcuMonResultErrorCount  
Read value from devOcuSendControlErrorCount  
Clear Monitor Error  
Number of Errors Monitored  
Number of Errors Injected  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
D-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (14 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
CONFIG  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/config/load followed by  
main/config/save:  
Set:  
devConfigAreaCopy to the selected area: active-to-customer1,  
factory1-to-active, etc.  
main/config:  
Set:  
Accept Configuration Mismatch  
devCfgCardAction to accept  
main/config/network:  
Set/Read:  
Network Interface  
Line Framing Format  
Line Coding Format  
ANSI Performance Report Msgs.  
Management Link  
DDL Rate  
ifAdminStatus to up or down  
dsx1LineType  
dsx1LineCoding  
dsx1Fdl  
dsx1Fdl (fdl only)  
ifSpeed  
Network Time Slot  
Circuit Identifier  
devDs1FracTable entry, with devDs1FracIndex for DDL  
dsx1Circuit Identifier  
main/config/dsx:  
Set/Read:  
Interface Status  
Line Framing Format  
Line Coding Format  
ifAdminStatus to up or down  
dsx1LineType  
dsx1LineCoding  
main/config/sync:  
Set/Read:  
Port Status  
ifAdminStatus to up or down  
Port Type  
rs232PortType  
Port Base Rate  
devSyncDataPortConfigBaseRate  
rs232SyncPortClockSource to internal or external  
ifAdminStatus to up/down of EDL for this port  
devPortUsage to none or netLink  
rs232SyncPortEncoding to nrzi  
Transmit Clock Source  
Embedded Data Link  
EDL Management Link  
Invert Transmit and Received Data  
main/config/voice_port:  
Set/Read:  
Port Status  
ifAdminStatus to up or down  
devVoiceConfigSignalingType  
devVoiceConfigTermImpedance  
devVoiceConfigWinkDelay  
devVoiceConfigWinkDuration  
devVoiceConfigRxGain  
Signaling Type  
Terminating Impedance  
Wink Delay  
Wink Duration  
Rx Gain  
Tx Gain  
devVoiceConfigTxGain  
Ring-back Tone  
Trunk Cond. in CGA  
devVoiceConfigRingBackTone  
devVoiceConfigTrunkCondInCGA  
Operating Mode  
Read:devVoiceConfigOperatingMode  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
D-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (15 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
CONFIG  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/config/ocu:  
Set/Read:  
Port Status  
Port Rate  
ifAdminStatus to up or down  
devOcuRate  
Loopback Detection  
devOcuLoopbackDetection  
main/config/cross_connect:  
Fully supported by the device cross-connect MIB objects using:  
DSX-1-to-Network Assignments  
Network to Network Assignments  
Voice Port Assignments  
devDs1FracTable  
devDs1FracTable  
devDs1FracTable  
Sync Data Port Assignments  
OCU-DP Port Assignments  
Clear DSX-1 Time Slots  
Clear Network Interface Time Slots  
Clear Slot nn  
devSyncDataPortAssignTable  
devDs1FracTable  
Use devDs1FracTable to clear all time slots  
Use devDs1FracTable to clear all time slots  
Use devDs1FracTable to clear all time slots  
main/config/system:  
Set/Read:  
Test Timeout  
devConfigTestTimeout  
Test Duration  
devConfigTestDuration  
Primary Clock Source  
Secondary Clock Source  
devConfigClockSrcTable (read only)  
devConfigClockSrcTable (read only)  
main/config/user/com:  
COM Port  
Set/Read:  
Port Usage  
Port Type  
Data Rate  
Character Length  
Parity  
devPortUsage to netlink, alarm, or terminal  
See the Asynchronous/Synchronous Port Table for the entry  
rs232PortInSpeed or rs232PortOutSpeed for the port  
rs232AsyncPortBits for the port  
rs232AsyncPortParity for the port  
Stop Bits  
rs232AsyncPortStopBits for the port  
Ignore Control Leads  
Clock Source  
rs232PortInFlowType for the port  
rs232SyncPortClockSource to internal or external  
main/config/management/security:  
Set/Read:  
IP Address  
devSecurityMgrIpAddress  
Access Type  
devSecurityMgrAccess to read or readWrite  
main/config/management/trap:  
Set/Read:  
IP Address  
devTrapMgrIpAddress  
Destination  
devTrapMgrDestination  
devConfigTrapEnable  
devConfigTrapEnable  
General Traps  
Enterprise-Specific Traps  
Link Traps  
devConfigTrapEnable  
Link Traps Interfaces  
ifLinkUpDownTrapEnable for the interface  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
D-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SNMP Cross-Reference  
Table D-1. SNMP MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference (16 of 16)  
User Interface Command  
SNMP MIB Object  
main/control/device_name:  
Set/Read:  
System Name  
System Contact  
System Location  
sysName object from the System group  
sysContact object from the System group  
sysLocation object from the System group  
System Alarm Relay Cut-Off:  
Reset:  
Set/Read:  
devConfigAlarmRelayCutoff  
Set:  
devHWControlReset to reset.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
D-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cables, Connectors, and Pin  
Assignments  
E
COM Port  
The COM (communications) port connects to an async terminal or other  
management interface.  
These cables are:  
H
H
14-foot, 26 AWG, 8-conductor, with a non-keyed 8-position modular jack  
interface/connector at one end, and  
25-pin or 9-pin connector at the other end, depending upon the management  
interface used.  
Refer to the appropriate cable section.  
The following table shows the signals and pin assignments for the COM port  
interface/connector.  
Signal  
Direction  
Pin #  
DCE Transmit Clock (TXC)  
DCE Received Data (RXD)  
Signal Ground (SG)  
Out  
Out  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
DCE Transmit Data (TXD)  
DCE Data Terminal Ready (DTR)  
DCE Carrier Detect (CD)  
DCE Request to Send (RTS)  
DCE Received Clock (RXC)  
In  
In  
Out  
In  
Out  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
E-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
COM Port-to-PC Cable  
This cable comes with the T1 access unit. The following shows the pin  
assignments from the COM port to the DTE interface.  
COM Port  
Non-Keyed  
8-Position  
DTE  
DB9 Socket  
Modular Plug  
No  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Tx Clock  
Rx Data  
Signal Ground  
Tx Data  
DTR  
Connection  
2
Rx Data  
5
3
4
1
8
6
7
Signal Ground  
Tx Data  
DTR  
CD  
CD  
RTS  
CTS  
No  
Connection  
Rx Clock  
DSR  
RTS  
97-14909-01  
COM Port-to-Terminal/Printer Cable  
Order this cable when connecting the COM port to a terminal or printer, rather  
than to a PC; it does not come with the T1 access unit. The following shows the  
pin assignments from the COM port to the DTE interface.  
COM Port  
Non-Keyed  
DTE  
DB25 Plug  
8-Position  
Modular Plug  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
15  
Tx Clock  
Rx Data  
Signal Ground  
Tx Data  
DTR  
3
7
2
Rx Data  
Signal Ground  
Tx Data  
20 DTR  
8
5
CD  
CD  
CTS  
DSR  
RTS  
RTS  
6
Rx Clock  
4
17  
97-14910-01  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
E-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
COM Port-to-Modem Cable  
Order this cable when connecting the COM port to a modem or other external  
device. The following shows the pin assignments from the COM port to the  
external device.  
COM Port  
Non-Keyed  
Modem  
DB25 Plug  
8-Position  
Modular Plug  
No  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Tx Clock  
Rx Data  
Signal Ground  
Tx Data  
DTR  
Connection  
2
7
3
6
4
Tx Data  
Signal Ground  
Rx Data  
DSR  
RTS  
CD  
20 DTR  
CTS  
RTS  
No  
Connection  
5
Rx Clock  
97-15669  
Gender Adapter/Changer  
When connecting the COM port to a router or Frame Relay Assembler/  
Disassembler (FRAD), a gender adapter is required to convert the  
COM Port-to-Terminal/Printer cable’s plug-type interface to a socket-type  
interface for the AUX port.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
E-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
LAN Adapter and Cables  
The LAN adapter is ordered along with the appropriate cable. Be sure to specify  
whether you need a Token Ring or an Ethernet LAN Adapter.  
The following shows the pin assignments for the cable between the LAN Adapter  
(LAN A) and the T1 access unit’s COM port or COM Port-to-PC Adapter.  
COM  
Port  
(DCE)  
(DTE)  
LAN A  
Tx Clock  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Unused  
DTR  
Rx Data  
Signal Ground  
Tx Data  
DTR  
Tx Data  
Signal Ground  
Rx Data  
CD  
CTS  
RTS  
Frame Ground  
Unused  
Rx Clock  
496-14908  
T1 Network Interface Cable  
Network access is via a 14-foot cable with an RJ48C unkeyed plug-type  
connector on each end. The following table shows pin assignments and the  
purpose of each.  
Function  
Circuit  
Pin Number  
Receive ring from the network  
Receive tip from the network  
Transmit ring to the network  
Transmit tip to the network  
R1  
T1  
R
1
2
4
5
T
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
E-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
DSX-1 Port Interface  
The DSX-1 Port cable is a cable with a 15-pin DB15 on one end. The following  
table shows pin assignments and the purpose of each.  
Function  
Circuit  
Pin #  
1
Receive tip from the DTE  
Transmit tip to the DTE  
Shield  
T1  
T
3
2,4  
9
Receive ring from the DTE  
Transmit ring to the DTE  
R1  
R
11  
T1 Line Interface Cable  
RJ48C  
Plug  
Unkeyed  
DA15P  
Plug  
Blue  
Blue  
Receive Ring  
Receive TIP  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
11 Receive Ring  
3
Receive TIP  
White/Blue  
Orange  
White/Blue  
Orange  
Transmit Ring  
Transmit TIP  
9
1
Transmit Ring  
Transmit TIP  
White/Orange  
White/Orange  
493-14342-01  
The following table contains T1 Network Interface Connector information.  
T1 Network Interface Connector (DA15P)  
Pin Number  
RJ48C  
DA15P  
Signal  
Receiver Ring  
Receiver Tip  
Transmitter Ring  
Transmitter Tip  
1
2
4
5
11  
3
9
1
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
E-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
EIA-530A Port Interface  
The following table shows the EIA-530A circuit and pin assignments that are  
supported for a port connector/interface (Port 1 or Port 2).  
Circuit  
Mnemonic CCITT #  
ITU/  
25-Pin  
Pin #  
Signal  
Direction  
Shield  
1
Transmitted Data (TXD)  
BA  
103  
To DCE  
2 (A)  
14 (B)  
Received Data (RXD)  
Request to Send (RTS)  
Clear to Send (CTS)  
BB  
CA  
CB  
CC  
104  
105  
106  
107  
From DCE  
To DCE  
3 (A)  
16 (B)  
4 (A)  
19 (B)  
From DCE  
From DCE  
5 (A)  
13 (B)  
Data Set (or DCE) Ready  
(DSR)  
6
Signal Ground/Common (SG) AB  
102A  
109  
7
Received Line Signal Detector CF  
(RLSD or LSD)  
From DCE  
8 (A)  
10 (B)  
Transmit Signal Element  
Timing (TXC – DTE Source)  
DA  
DB  
DD  
113  
114  
115  
To DCE  
11 (B)  
24 (A)  
Transmitter Signal Element  
Timing (TXC – DCE Source)  
From DCE  
From DCE  
12 (B)  
15 (A)  
Receiver Signal Element  
Timing (RXC – DCE Source)  
17 (A)  
9 (B)  
Local Loopback (LL)  
LL  
141  
To DCE  
To DCE  
18  
20  
Data Terminal (or DTE)  
Ready (DTR)  
CD  
108/1, /2  
Remote Loopback (RL)  
Signal Common  
RL  
AC  
TM  
140  
To DCE  
21  
102B  
142  
22, 23  
25  
Test Mode Indicator (TM)  
From DCE  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
E-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
EIA-530A-to-V.35 DTE Adapter Cable  
Used as an interface between the 25-position EIA-530A Sync Data Port  
connector and a DTE’s V.35 connector.  
12 Inches  
25-Pin Plug  
Connector  
34-Position Socket  
Connector  
496-14882a  
530 DB25  
SIGNAL PLUG  
V.35  
SIGNAL  
MS34  
SOCKET  
SHIELD  
TD-A  
1
2
A
P
S
R
T
Y
SHIELD  
TD-A  
TD-B 14  
RD-A  
TD-B  
3
RD-A  
RD-B 16  
TXC-A 15  
TXC-B 12  
RXC-A 17  
RD-B  
TXC-A  
AA TXC-B  
V
X
C
D
F
RXC-A  
RXC-B  
RTS  
RXC-B  
RTS  
9
4
5
8
6
7
CTS  
CTS  
RLSD  
RLSD  
DSR  
DSR  
E
B
U
W
H
N
L
SIG. COMMON  
SIG. COMMON  
TT-A  
TT-A 24  
TT-B 11  
TT-B  
DTR 20  
DTR  
RL 21  
RL  
LL 18  
LL  
TM 25  
NN TM  
SIG. COMMON 23  
497-15233  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
E-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
The following table provides the pin assignments for the 25-position Port 1 or  
Port 2 connector/interface and a DTE’s 34-position V.35 connector.  
25-Pin  
Plug  
Pin #  
34-Pin  
Socket  
Pin #  
ITU/  
CCITT #  
Signal  
Direction  
Shield  
1
A
Transmit Data (TXD)  
103  
2 (A)  
14 (B)  
To DCE  
P (A)  
S (B)  
Received Data (RXD)  
104  
3 (A)  
16 (B)  
From DCE  
R (A)  
T (B)  
Request to Send (RTS)  
105  
106  
107  
102  
109  
4
To DCE  
From DCE  
From DCE  
C
D
E
B
F
Clear to Send (CTS)  
5
Data Set (or DCE) Ready (DSR)  
Signal Ground/Common (SG)  
6
7, 23  
8
Data Channel Received Line  
From DCE  
Signal Detector (RLSD or LSD)  
Transmitter Signal Element/  
Terminal Timing (TT) —  
DTE Source  
113  
24 (A)  
11 ( B)  
To DCE  
U (A)  
W (B)  
Transmitter Signal Element Timing 114  
(TXC) — DCE Source  
15 (A)  
12 (B)  
From DCE  
From DCE  
Y (A)  
AA (B)  
Receiver Signal Element Timing  
(RXC) — DCE Source  
115  
17 (A)  
9 (B)  
V (A)  
X (B)  
Local Loopback (LL)  
141  
18  
To DCE  
To DCE  
L
Data Terminal (or DTE) Ready  
(DTR)  
108/1, /2 20  
H
Loopback/Maintenance (RL)  
Test Mode Indicator (TM)  
140  
142  
21  
25  
To DCE  
N
From DCE  
NN  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
E-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
EIA-530A-to-RS449 DTE Adapter Cable  
Used as an interface between the 25-position Sync Data Port connector and a  
DTE’s RS449 connector.  
530  
Signal  
DB37 449  
DB25  
Plug  
Signal  
Socket  
Shield  
TXD-A  
1
2
1
4
Shield  
TD-A  
TXD-B 14  
RXD-A  
RXD-B 16  
TXC-A 15  
TXC-B 12  
RXC-A 17  
22 TD-B  
RD-A  
24 RD-B  
TXC-A  
23 TXC-B  
RXC-A  
26 RXC-B  
RTS-A  
25 RTS-B  
CTS-A  
3
6
5
8
RXC-B  
RTS-A  
9
4
7
RTS-B 19  
CTS-A  
5
9
CTS-B 13  
DTR 20  
27 CTS-B  
12 DTR-A  
13 RR-A  
31 RR-B  
11 DM-A  
19 Sig. Common  
14 RL  
RLSD-A  
8
RLSD-B 10  
DSR  
Sig. Common  
6
7
RL 21  
LL 18  
10 LL  
RCV. Common 23  
TT-A 24  
20 RCV. Common  
17 TT-A  
TT-B 11  
35 TT-B  
TM 25  
18 TM  
Sig. Common 22  
29 DM-B  
30 DTR-B  
496-15147  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
E-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
The following table provides the pin assignments for the 25-position Sync Data  
connector/interface and a DTE’s 37-position RS449 connector.  
25-Pin  
Plug  
Pin #  
37-Pin  
Socket  
Pin #  
ITU/  
CCITT #  
Signal  
Direction  
Shield  
1
1
Transmit Data (TXD/TD)  
103  
2 (A),  
14 (B)  
To DCE  
4 (A),  
22 (B)  
Receive Data (RXD/RD)  
Request to Send (RTS)  
Clear to Send (CTS)  
104  
105  
106  
107  
3 (A),  
16 (B)  
From DCE  
To DCE  
6 (A),  
24 (B)  
4 (A),  
19 (B)  
7 (A),  
25 (B)  
5 (A),  
13 (B)  
From DCE  
From DCE  
9 (A),  
27 (B)  
Data Set Ready/Data Mode  
(DSR/DM)  
6
11 (A)  
Signal Ground (SG)  
102A  
109  
7
19  
Data Channel Received Line  
Signal Detect/Receiver Ready  
(RLSD/RR)  
8 (A),  
10 (B)  
From DCE  
13 (A),  
31 (B)  
Transmitter Signal Element  
Timing/Transmit Timing (TXC) —  
DCE Source  
114  
115  
141  
15 (A),  
12 (B)  
From DCE  
From DCE  
5 (A),  
23 (B)  
Receiver Signal Element Timing/  
Receive Timing (RXC) —  
DCE Source  
17 (A),  
9 (B)  
8 (A),  
26 (B)  
Local Loopback (LL)  
18  
To DCE  
To DCE  
10  
Data Terminal (or DTE) Ready  
(DTR/TR)  
108/1, /2 20  
12 (A)  
Remote Loopback (RL)  
Receive Common (RC)  
140  
21  
23  
To DCE  
14  
102B  
113  
20, 29  
Transmitter Signal Element/  
Terminal Timing (TT) —  
DTE Source  
24 (A),  
11 ( B )  
To DCE  
17 (A),  
35 (B)  
Test Mode (TM)  
no connection  
142  
25  
From DCE  
18  
30, 37  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
E-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
EIA-530A-to-X.21 DTE Adapter Cable  
Used as an interface between the 25-position Sync Data Port connector and a  
DTE’s X.21 connector.  
530 DB25  
X.21  
Signal  
DB15  
Socket  
Signal  
Plug  
TXD-A  
TXD-B 14  
RXD-A  
2
2
9
4
TD-A  
TD-B  
RD-A  
3
RXD-B 16  
RXC-A 17  
11 RD-B  
RXC-A  
13 RXC-B  
RTS-A  
10 RTS-B  
RR-A  
12 RR-B  
6
RXC-B  
RTS-A  
9
4
3
RTS-B 19  
RLSD-A  
RLSD-B 10  
8
5
Sig. Common  
7
TT-A 24  
TT-B 11  
8
7
Sig. Common  
TT-A  
14 TT-B  
496-15146  
The following table provides the pin assignments for the 25-position Port 1 or  
Port 2 connector/interface and a DTE’s 15-position X.21 connector/interface.  
25-Pin  
Plug  
Pin #  
15-Pin  
Socket  
Pin #  
ITU/  
CCITT #  
Signal  
Direction  
Transmit Data (TXD/TD)  
103  
104  
105  
2 (A)  
14 (B)  
To DCE  
2 (A),  
9 (B)  
Received Data (RXD/RD)  
Request to Send (RTS)  
Signal Ground/Common  
3 (A)  
16 (B)  
From DCE  
To DCE  
4 (A),  
11 (B)  
4 (A)  
19 (B)  
3 (A),  
10 (B)  
102  
109  
7
8
Data Channel Received Line  
Signal Detector/Receiver Ready  
(RLSD/RR)  
8 (A)  
10 (B)  
From DCE  
5 (A),  
12 (B)  
Receiver Signal Element Timing  
(RXC) — DCE Source  
115  
17 (A)  
9 (B)  
From DCE  
To DCE  
6 (A),  
13 (B)  
Transmitter Signal Element Timing/ 113  
Terminal Timing (TT) —  
DTE Source  
24 (A)  
11 ( B )  
7 (A),  
14 (B)  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
E-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
Voice APM Cables  
This section provides the pin assignments for the FXO, FXS and E&M voice APM  
50-pin Amphenol connectors (RJ27X socket), followed by the pin assignments for  
the extension cables that can be used with these APMs.  
FXO/FXS Voice APM Connector  
The FXO/FXS Analog Voice APM uses a single 50-pin connector to provide eight  
2-wire interfaces for connecting to analog voice equipment.  
FXO/FXS 50-Pin Amphenol Connector  
Port  
Pin  
26  
1
Signal  
1
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
T
R
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
29  
4
32  
7
35  
10  
38  
13  
41  
16  
44  
19  
47  
22  
All other pins are unconnected.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
E-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
E&M Voice APM Connector  
The E&M Analog Voice APM uses a single 50-pin connector (RJ27X socket) to  
provide eight 2-wire interfaces for connecting to analog voice equipment.  
E&M 50-Pin Amphenol Connector (1 of 2)  
Port  
Pin  
26  
1
Function  
Transmit tip  
Transmit ring  
Receive tip  
Receive ring  
E Lead  
Signal  
T
1
R
27  
2
T1  
R1  
E
28  
3
M Lead  
M
2
3
4
29  
4
Transmit tip  
Transmit ring  
Receive tip  
Receive ring  
E Lead  
T
R
30  
5
T1  
R1  
E
31  
6
M Lead  
M
32  
7
Transmit tip  
Transmit ring  
Receive tip  
Receive ring  
E Lead  
T
R
33  
8
T1  
R1  
E
34  
9
M Lead  
M
35  
10  
36  
11  
37  
12  
Transmit tip  
Transmit ring  
Receive tip  
Receive ring  
E Lead  
T
R
T1  
R1  
E
M Lead  
M
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
E-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
E&M 50-Pin Amphenol Connector (2 of 2)  
Port  
Pin  
38  
13  
39  
14  
40  
15  
41  
16  
42  
17  
43  
18  
44  
19  
45  
20  
46  
21  
47  
22  
48  
23  
49  
24  
25  
50  
Function  
Signal  
T
5
Transmit tip  
Transmit ring  
Receive tip  
Receive ring  
E Lead  
R
T1  
R1  
E
M Lead  
M
6
Transmit tip  
Transmit ring  
Receive tip  
Receive ring  
E Lead  
T
R
T1  
R1  
E
M Lead  
M
7
Transmit tip  
Transmit ring  
Receive tip  
Receive ring  
E Lead  
T
R
T1  
R1  
E
M Lead  
M
8
Transmit tip  
Transmit ring  
Receive tip  
Receive ring  
E Lead  
T
R
T1  
R1  
E
M Lead  
M
All  
Signal Ground  
Signal Battery  
SG  
SB  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
E-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
Extension Cables  
Extension cables can be ordered for use with the 50-pin FXO, FXS and E&M  
Voice APM connectors. They are all straight-through cables (i.e., Pin 1 on the  
voice APM side is Pin 1 on the M66 block side of the cable), and they coincide  
with the pins on the 50-pin APM connector.  
The following table identifies these cables, indicates the voice APM it is used  
with, and describes when you might use each:  
Extension Cables  
Extension Cable  
Length Voice APM When Used  
1 Amphenol plug-to- 3′  
1 Amphenol plug  
cable  
E&M  
FXO  
FXS  
To connect the voice APM’s 50-pin  
Amphenol connector to the M66 block.  
When the M66 block is further than five  
feet from the APM connector, used as an  
extension to the 5-foot cable normally  
used.  
(Twisted pair/25-pair:  
1-26, 2-27, 3-28 . . .  
25-50)  
See FXO/FXS Voice APM Connector on  
Page E-12 or E&M Voice APM  
Connector on Page E-13 for pin  
assignments.  
1 Amphenol socket-  
to-1 Amphenol plug  
cable  
25′  
E&M  
FXO  
FXS  
When the M66 block is further than five  
feet from the APM’s connector, used as  
an extension to the 5-foot 1 Amphenol  
plug-to-1 Amphenol plug cable.  
(Twisted pair/25-pair:  
1-26, 2-27, 2-28 . . .  
25-50)  
See FXO/FXS Voice APM Connector on  
Page E-12 or E&M Voice APM  
Connector on Page E-13 for pin  
assignments.  
3 Amphenol plugs-to- 6′  
1 Amphenol plug  
FXO  
FXS  
To condense three voice APMs onto the  
single M66 block connector.  
connector assembly  
Extend the cable using the 25-foot  
1 Amphenol socket-to-1 Amphenol  
plug 25-pair cable.  
(Twisted pair: T1-R1  
. . .T24-R24, S1-S2)  
See 3 Amphenol Plugs-to-1 Amphenol  
Plug Cable on Page E-17 for pin  
assignments.  
3 Amphenol plugs-to- 6′  
4 Amphenol plugs  
connector assembly  
E&M  
To consolidate signals from three voice  
APMs and segregate four applications  
onto four M66 blocks (e.g., all transmit  
signals on one block, all receive signals  
on a second block, all E&M signals on a  
third, and all battery and signal ground  
signals on the fourth).  
(Twisted pair: T1-R1  
. . .T24-R24,  
TR1-RR1 . . .  
TR24-RR24,  
M1-E1 . . . M24-E24,  
SG1-SG1 . . .  
SG3-SG3)  
Extend the cable using the 25-foot  
1 Amphenol socket-to-1 Amphenol  
plug 25-pair cable.  
See 3 Amphenol Plugs-to-4 Amphenol  
Plugs Cable starting on Page E-19 for  
pin assignments.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
E-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
M66 Block  
Voice APMs  
P3  
P2  
P1  
P4  
97-15171-02  
3 Amphenol Plugs-to-1 Amphenol Plug Cable  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
E-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
3 Amphenol Plugs-to-1 Amphenol Plug Cable  
Connects  
to APM  
Plug  
Connects  
to APM  
Pin Signal  
Plug  
M66  
Plug  
M66  
Plug  
Pin  
1
Pin Signal  
Pin  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
P4  
P1  
P2  
P3  
1
R Port 1  
R Port 2  
R Port 3  
R Port 4  
R Port 5  
R Port 6  
R Port 7  
R Port 8  
R Port 1  
R Port 2  
R Port 3  
R Port 4  
R Port 5  
R Port 6  
R Port 7  
R Port 8  
R Port 1  
R Port 2  
R Port 3  
R Port 4  
R Port 5  
R Port 6  
R Port 7  
R Port 8  
P4  
P1  
P2  
P3  
26  
29  
32  
35  
38  
41  
44  
47  
26  
29  
32  
35  
38  
41  
44  
47  
26  
29  
32  
35  
38  
41  
44  
47  
T Port 1  
T Port 2  
T Port 3  
T Port 4  
T Port 5  
T Port 6  
T Port 7  
T Port 8  
T Port 1  
T Port 2  
T Port 3  
T Port 4  
T Port 5  
T Port 6  
T Port 7  
T Port 8  
T Port 1  
T Port 2  
T Port 3  
T Port 4  
T Port 5  
T Port 6  
T Port 7  
T Port 8  
2
4
3
7
4
10  
13  
16  
19  
22  
1
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
4
7
10  
13  
16  
19  
22  
1
4
7
10  
13  
16  
19  
22  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
E-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
3 Amphenol Plugs-to-4 Amphenol Plugs Cable  
M66 Blocks  
RX E&M  
Signal Ground  
and Battery  
TX  
Voice APMs  
P3  
P2  
P1  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P7  
97-15172-02  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
E-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
3 Amphenol Plugs-to-4 Amphenol Plugs Cable for P1 (1 of 2)  
P1 Pin # Designation Connects To Pin # Designation  
Function  
1
R (Port 1)  
R1 (Port 1)  
M (Port 1)  
R (Port 2)  
R1 (Port 2)  
M1 (Port 2)  
R (Port 3)  
R1 (Port 3)  
M (Port 3)  
R (Port 4)  
R1 (Port 4)  
M (Port 4)  
R (Port 5)  
R1 (Port 5)  
M (Port 5)  
R (Port 6)  
R1 (Port 6)  
M (Port 6)  
R (Port 7)  
R1 (Port 7)  
M (Port 7)  
R (Port 8)  
R1 (Port 8)  
M (Port 8)  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P7  
1
1
1
2
2
2
3
3
3
4
4
4
5
5
5
6
6
6
7
7
7
8
8
8
1–8  
R (Port 1)  
R1 (Port1)  
M (Port 1)  
R (Port 2)  
R1 (Port 2)  
M (Port 2)  
R (Port 3)  
R1 (Port 3)  
M (Port 3)  
R (Port 4)  
R1 (Port 4)  
M (Port 4)  
R (Port 5)  
R1 (Port 5)  
M (Port 5)  
R (Port 6)  
R1 (Port 6)  
M (Port 6)  
R (Port 7)  
R1 (Port 7)  
M (Port 7)  
R (Port 8)  
R1 (Port 8)  
M (Port 8)  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
2
3
4
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
5
6
7
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
SG  
SG  
Signal Ground  
(Ports 1–8)  
(Ports 1–8)  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
E-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
3 Amphenol Plugs-to-4 Amphenol Plugs Cable for P1 (2 of 2)  
P1 Pin # Designation Connects To Pin # Designation  
Function  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
T (Port 1)  
T1 (Port 1)  
E (Port 1)  
T (Port 2)  
T1 (Port 2)  
E (Port 2)  
T (Port 3)  
T1 (Port 3)  
E (Port 3)  
T (Port 4)  
T1 (Port 4)  
E (Port 4)  
T (Port 5)  
T1 (Port 5)  
E (Port 5)  
T (Port 6)  
T1 (Port 6)  
E (Port 6)  
T (Port 7)  
T1 (Port 7)  
E (Port 7)  
T (Port 8)  
T1 (Port 8)  
E (Port 8)  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P7  
26  
26  
26  
27  
27  
27  
28  
28  
28  
29  
29  
29  
30  
30  
30  
31  
31  
31  
32  
32  
32  
33  
33  
33  
T (Port 1)  
T1 (Port 1)  
E (Port 1)  
T (Port 2)  
T1 (Port 2)  
E (Port 2)  
T (Port 3)  
T1 (Port 3)  
E (Port 3)  
T (Port 4)  
T1 (Port 4)  
E (Port 4)  
T (Port 5)  
T1 (Port 5)  
E (Port 5)  
T (Port 6)  
T1 (Port 6)  
E (Port 6)  
T (Port 7)  
T1 (Port 7)  
E (Port 7)  
T (Port 8)  
T1 (Port 8)  
E (Port 8)  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
SB  
(Ports 1–8)  
26–33 SB  
(Ports 1–8)  
Signal Battery  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
E-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
3 Amphenol Plugs-to-4 Amphenol Plugs Cable for P2 (1 of 2)  
P2 Pin # Designation Connects To Pin # Designation  
Function  
1
R (Port 1)  
R1 (Port 1)  
M (Port 1)  
R (Port 2)  
R1 (Port 2)  
M (Port 2)  
R (Port 3)  
R1 (Port 3)  
M (Port 3)  
R (Port 4)  
R1 (Port 4)  
M (Port 4)  
R (Port 5)  
R1 (Port 5)  
M (Port 5)  
R (Port 6)  
R1 (Port 6)  
M (Port 6)  
R (Port 7)  
R1 (Port 7)  
M (Port 7)  
R (Port 8)  
R1 (Port 8)  
M (Port 8)  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P7  
9
R (Port 9)  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
2
9
R1 (Port 9)  
M (Port 9)  
3
9
4
10  
10  
10  
11  
11  
11  
12  
12  
12  
13  
13  
13  
14  
14  
14  
15  
15  
15  
16  
16  
16  
9–16  
R (Port 10)  
R1 (Port 10)  
M (Port 10)  
R (Port 11)  
R1 (Port 11)  
M (Port 11)  
R (Port 12)  
R1 (Port 12)  
M (Port 12)  
R (Port 13)  
R1 (Port 13)  
M (Port 13)  
R (Port 14)  
R1 (Port 14)  
M (Port 14)  
R (Port 15)  
R1 (Port 15)  
M (Port 15)  
R (Port 16)  
R1 (Port 16)  
M (Port 16)  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
5
6
7
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
SG  
SG  
Signal Ground  
(Ports 1–8)  
(Ports 9–16)  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
E-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
3 Amphenol Plugs-to-4 Amphenol Plugs Cable for P2 (2 of 2)  
P2 Pin # Designation Connects To Pin # Designation  
Function  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
T (Port 1)  
T1 (Port 1)  
E (Port 1)  
T (Port 1)  
T1 (Port 1)  
E (Port 1)  
T (Port 1)  
T1 (Port 1)  
E (Port 1)  
T (Port 1)  
T1 (Port 1)  
E (Port 1)  
T (Port 1)  
T1 (Port 1)  
E (Port 1)  
T (Port 1)  
T1 (Port 1)  
E (Port 1)  
T (Port 1)  
T1 (Port 1)  
E (Port 1)  
T (Port 1)  
T1 (Port 1)  
E (Port 1)  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P7  
34  
34  
34  
35  
35  
35  
36  
36  
36  
37  
37  
37  
38  
38  
38  
39  
39  
39  
40  
40  
40  
41  
41  
41  
T (Port 9)  
T1 (Port 9)  
E (Port 9)  
T (Port 10)  
T1 (Port 10)  
E (Port 10)  
T (Port 11)  
T1 (Port 11)  
E (Port 11)  
T (Port 12)  
T1 (Port 12)  
E (Port 12)  
T (Port 13)  
T1 (Port 13)  
E (Port 13)  
T (Port 14)  
T1 (Port 14)  
E (Port 14)  
T (Port 15)  
T1 (Port 15)  
E (Port 15)  
T (Port 16)  
T1 (Port 16)  
E (Port 16)  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
SB  
(Ports 1–8)  
34–41 SB  
(Ports 9–16)  
Signal Battery  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
E-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
3 Amphenol Plugs-to-4 Amphenol Plugs Cable for P3 (1 of 2)  
P3 Pin # Designation Connects To Pin # Designation  
Function  
1
R (Port 1)  
R1 (Port 1)  
M (Port 1)  
R (Port 2)  
R1 (Port 2)  
M (Port 2)  
R (Port 3)  
R1 (Port 3)  
M (Port 3)  
R (Port 4)  
R1 (Port 4)  
M (Port 4)  
R (Port 5)  
R1 (Port 5)  
M (Port 5)  
R (Port 6)  
R1 (Port 6)  
M (Port 6)  
R (Port 7)  
R1 (Port 7)  
M (Port 7)  
R (Port 8)  
R1 (Port 8)  
M (Port 8)  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P7  
17  
17  
17  
18  
18  
18  
19  
19  
19  
20  
20  
20  
21  
21  
21  
22  
22  
22  
23  
23  
23  
24  
24  
25  
R (Port 17)  
R1 (Port 17)  
M (Port 17)  
R (Port 18)  
R1 (Port 18)  
M (Port 18)  
R (Port 19)  
R1 (Port 19)  
M (Port 19)  
R (Port 20)  
R1 (Port 20)  
M (Port 20)  
R (Port 21)  
R1 (Port 21)  
M (Port 21)  
T (Port 22)  
R1 (Port 22)  
M (Port 22)  
R (Port 23)  
R1 (Port 23)  
M (Port 23)  
R (Port 24)  
R1 (Port 24)  
M (Port 24)  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
2
3
4
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
5
6
7
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
Transmit Ring  
Receive Ring  
M Lead  
SG  
(Ports 1–8)  
17–24 SG  
(Port 17–24)  
Signal Ground  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
E-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
3 Amphenol Plugs-to-4 Amphenol Plugs Cable for P3 (2 of 2)  
P3 Pin # Designation Connects To Pin # Designation  
Function  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
T (Port 1)  
T1 (Port 1)  
E (Port 1)  
T (Port 2)  
T1 (Port 2)  
E (Port 2)  
T (Port 3)  
T1 (Port 3)  
E (Port 3)  
T (Port 4)  
T1 (Port 4)  
E (Port 4)  
T (Port 5)  
T1 (Port 5)  
E (Port 5)  
T (Port 6)  
T1 (Port 6)  
E (Port 6)  
T (Port 7)  
T1 (Port 7)  
E (Port 7)  
T (Port 8)  
T1 (Port 8)  
E (Port 8)  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P4  
P5  
P6  
P7  
42  
42  
42  
43  
43  
43  
44  
44  
44  
45  
45  
45  
46  
46  
46  
47  
47  
47  
48  
48  
48  
49  
49  
49  
T (Port 17)  
T1 (Port 17)  
E (Port 17)  
T (Port 18)  
T1 (Port 18)  
E (Port 18)  
T (Port 19)  
T1 (Port 19)  
E (Port 19)  
T (Port 20)  
T1 (Port 20)  
E (Port 20)  
T (Port 21)  
T1 (Port 21)  
E (Port 21)  
T (Port 22)  
T1 (Port 22)  
E (Port 22)  
T (Port 23)  
T1 (Port 23)  
E (Port 23)  
T (Port 24)  
T1 (Port 24)  
E (Port 24)  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
Transmit Tip  
Receive Tip  
E Lead  
SB  
(Ports 1–8)  
42–49 SB  
(Ports 17–24)  
Signal Battery  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
E-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
OCU Port  
The OCU-DP APM can have either two or six ports, each port having an RJ48S  
connector. Connect the OCU port to the DDS network using one of the following  
cables:  
H
H
14-foot DDS cable  
25-foot DDS cable  
OCU Port Connector  
The OCU-DP port is a USOC RJ48S connector. The following table shows pin  
assignments and the purpose of each.  
Function  
Circuit  
Pin #  
Transmit ring  
Transmit tip  
Receive tip  
Receive ring  
R
1
2
7
8
T
T1  
R1  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
E-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cables, Connectors, and Pin Assignments  
T1 Mass Termination Cable  
A T1 mass termination cable is available to connect up to seven NAMs mounted  
in a 9000 Series Access Carrier to an M66 block. The T1 mass termination cable  
is a 5-foot RJ48H cable consisting of a 50-pin plug at one end and seven RJ48C  
plugs at the other end. The following shows pin assignments for the RJ48H  
connector.  
RJ48H Connector Pinouts for T1 Mass Termination Cable  
Circuits  
2
3
4
1
R1  
T
R
T1  
Line #  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
Receive Tip from Network  
2
3
4
Receive Ring from Network  
Transmit Tip to Network  
Transmit Ring to Network  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
E-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Technical Specifications  
F
Specification  
Criteria  
Network Access Module (NAM)  
Approvals  
FCC Part 15  
FCC Part 68  
Class A digital device.  
Refer to the equipment’s label for the  
Registration Number.  
Industry Canada  
Refer to the equipment’s label for the  
Certification Number.  
UL  
Refer to the equipment’s label for the UL listing.  
CSA – Safety  
Refer to the equipment’s label for CSA safety  
information.  
Weight  
T1 NAM  
1 lb. 2 oz. (.510 kg)  
6 oz. (.170 kg)  
T1 I/O Card  
Physical Environment  
Operating temperature  
Storage temperature  
Relative humidity  
Shock and vibration  
35°F to 122°F (1.7°C to 50°C)  
4°F to 158°F (20°C to 70°C)  
5% to 85% (noncondensing)  
Withstands normal shipping and handling  
Power Consumption  
9.4 watts, 0.78 amps input current at 12 volts  
Network 1/2 T1 Interface  
Physical Interface (USA)  
Physical Interface (Canada)  
Framing Format  
RJ48C  
CA81A using adapter cable  
D4, ESF  
AMI, B8ZS  
Coding Format  
Line Build-Out (LBO)  
ANSI PRM  
Bit Stuffing  
0.0 dB, –7.5 dB, –15 dB, –22.5 dB  
Selectable  
FCC Part 68, AT&T TR 62411  
Selectable  
Yellow Alarm Generation  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
F-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Technical Specifications  
Specification  
Criteria  
DSX-1 Interface (9161 only)  
Physical Interface  
Framing Format  
Coding Format  
DB15 socket  
D4, ESF  
AMI, B8ZS  
DTE Line Equalization  
5 selectable ranges from 0 to 655 feet  
(0 to 196.5 meters)  
Selectable  
Send AIS  
DTE Ports/Interfaces  
Standards  
Rates  
EIA-530A, V.35, RS-449, V.11, X.21  
Nx64 – 64K to 1.536 Mb  
Nx56 – 56K to 1.344 Mb  
COM Port/Interface  
Data Rates  
9.6, 14.4, 19.2, 28.8, 38.4 , 57.6, and 115.2 kbps.  
57.6 and 115.2 kbps are recommended for FTP  
download only.  
DBM (Backup) connector  
One 8-position modular keyed USOC RJ45 jack  
(reserved for future use)  
Clocking Sources  
T1 network interface (1 or 2), any port, internal clock,  
DSX-1 T1 interface (9161 only), or external clock  
Loopbacks  
Standard  
Network Line Loopback, Network Payload Loopback,  
V.54 Loop 2 (DCLB) and V.54 Loop 3 (DTPLB)  
Additional  
Network Repeater Loopback, DTE Loopback  
For 9161 Only  
DSX-1 Line Loopback, DSX-1 Payload Loopback, and  
DSX-1 Repeater Loopback  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
F-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Specifications  
Specification  
Sync Data APM  
Weight  
Criteria  
Sync Data APM  
Sync Data I/O card  
15 oz. (.425 kg)  
6 oz. (.170 kg)  
Size  
Sync Data APM  
Sync Data I/O card  
11.58x 8.00(29.41 cm x 20.32 cm)  
2.90x 10.15(7.37 cm x 25.78 cm)  
Physical Environment  
Operating temperature  
Storage temperature  
Relative humidity  
35°F to 122°F (1.7°C to 50°C)  
4°F to 158°F (20°C to 70°C)  
5% to 85% (noncondensing)  
Shock and vibration  
Withstands normal shipping and handling  
Power Consumption  
DTE Ports/Interfaces  
5.8 watts, 0.48 amps input current at 12 volts  
Standards  
Rates  
EIA-530A, V.35, RS-449, V.11, X.21  
Nx64 – 64K to 1.536 Mb  
Nx56 – 56K to 1.344 Mb  
Loopbacks  
Standard  
V.54 Loop 2 (DCLB) and V.54 Loop 3 (DTPLB)  
DTE Loopback  
Additional  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
F-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Specifications  
Specification  
Dual DSX APM  
Weight  
Criteria  
DSX APM  
DSX I/O card  
15 oz. (.425 kg)  
6 oz. (.170 kg)  
Size  
DSX APM  
DSX I/O card  
11.58x 8.00(29.41 cm x 20.32 cm)  
2.90x 10.15(7.37 cm x 25.78 cm)  
Physical Environment  
Operating temperature  
Storage temperature  
Relative humidity  
35°F to 122°F (1.7°C to 50°C)  
4°F to 158°F (20°C to 70°C)  
5% to 85% (noncondensing)  
Shock and vibration  
Withstands normal shipping and handling  
Power Consumption  
DSX-1 Interface  
3.5 watts, 0.29 amps input current at 12 volts  
15-position (DB15) subminiature connector  
Physical Interface  
Framing Format  
Coding Format  
DB15 socket  
D4, ESF  
AMI, B8ZS  
DTE Line Equalization  
5 selectable ranges from 0 to 655 feet  
(0 to 196.5 meters)  
Selectable  
Send AIS  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
F-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Specifications  
Specification  
Criteria  
Voice APMs  
Weight  
E&M APM  
FXO APM  
FXS APM  
Voice I/O card  
14 oz. (.397 kg)  
1 lb. (.454 kg)  
1 lb. (.454 kg)  
6 oz. (.170 kg)  
Size  
E&M/FXO/FXS APM  
Voice I/O card  
11.58x 8.00(29.41 cm x 20.32 cm)  
2.90x 10.15(7.37 cm x 25.78 cm)  
Physical Environment  
Operating temperature  
Storage temperature  
Relative humidity  
35°F to 122°F (1.7°C to 50°C)  
4°F to 158°F (20°C to 70°C)  
5% to 85% (noncondensing)  
Shock and vibration  
Withstands normal shipping and handling  
Cable Length  
Maximum cable length  
18,000 feet using 26 AWG  
Power Consumption  
E&M APM  
3.1 watts, 0.26 amps input current at 12 volts  
3.5 watts, 0.29 amps input current at 12 volts  
10.1 watts, 0.84 amps input current at 12 volts  
13.3 watts, 1.11 amps input current at 12 volts  
FXO APM  
FXS APM (8 lines talking)  
FXS APM (8 lines ringing)  
Interface Connector  
50-pin amphenol connector (RJ27X)  
Operating Modes  
E&M  
E&M  
Transmit Only  
FXO  
FXS  
DPT  
FXO  
FXO DN  
FXO DN Wink  
DPO  
FXS  
FXS DN  
FXS DN Wink  
PLAR  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
F-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Specifications  
Specification  
Criteria  
Signaling Types  
E&M  
Type I  
Type II  
Type IV  
Type V  
FXO  
FXS  
Loop Start  
Loop Start/Forward Disconnect  
Ground Start  
Loop Start  
Loop Start/Forward Disconnect  
Ground Start  
Ground Start Immediate  
Ground Start Automatic  
PLAR D3  
PLAR D4  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
F-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Specifications  
Specification  
OCU-DP APM  
Weight  
Criteria  
2-port OCU–DP APM  
6-port OCU-DP APM  
OCU–DP I/O card  
0.800 lbs. (.362 kg)  
1.052 lbs. (.477 kg)  
0.286 lbs. (.130 kg)  
Size  
OCU-DP APM  
OCU-DP I/O card  
11.58x 8.00(29.41 cm x 20.32 cm)  
2.90x 10.15(7.37 cm x 25.78 cm)  
Physical Environment  
Operating temperature  
Storage temperature  
Relative humidity  
35°F to 122°F (1.7°C to 50°C)  
4°F to 158°F (20°C to 70°C)  
5% to 85% (noncondensing)  
Shock and vibration  
Withstands normal shipping and handling  
Power Consumption (max)  
2-Port OCU  
2.78 watts, 0.232 amps input current at 12 volts  
5.04 watts, 0.420 amps input current at 12 volts  
6-Port OCU  
DDS Ports  
Standards  
AT&T PUB 62310, Bellcore TA-TSY-00077, ANSI  
T1.410, AT&T PUB 61330, AT&T TR41458  
Rates  
56 kbps, 64 kbps Clear Channel, 4-wire Switched 56  
Loopbacks  
DS-0, OCU Line, OCU Data, OCU, Local and Remote  
Latching and Non-Latching DSU/CSU  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
F-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Specifications  
This page intentionally left blank.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
F-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Equipment List  
G
Equipment  
Feature Number  
2-Slot Housing  
2-Slot Housing, 120 Vac Power Supply, Cables, Manuals  
9002-B1-200  
2-Slot Housing, 9161 Single T1 NAM, 120 Vac Power Supply,  
Cables, Manuals  
9162-A1-201  
2-Slot Housing, 9261 Dual T1 NAM, 120 Vac Power Supply, Cables, 9262-A1-201  
Manuals  
5-Slot Housing  
Desktop 5-Slot Housing, 120 Vac Power Supply, Cables, Manuals  
9005-B1-200  
9005-B1-209  
Rack-Mount 5-Slot Housing (without bezel and chassis skins),  
120 Vac Power Supply, Cables, Manuals  
Desktop 5-Slot Housing, DC Power Supply, Cables, Manuals  
9005-B1-500  
9005-B1-509  
Rack-Mount 5-Slot Housing (without bezel and chassis skins), DC  
Power Supply, Cables, Manuals  
Desktop 5-Slot Housing, 9161 Single T1 NAM, 120 Vac Power  
Supply, Cables, Manuals  
9165-A1-201  
9165-A1-209  
9165-A1-501  
9165-A1-509  
9265-A1-201  
9265-A1-209  
9265-A1-501  
9265-A1-509  
Rack-Mount 5-Slot Housing (without bezel and chassis skins),  
9161 Single T1 NAM, AC Power Supply, Cables, Manuals  
Desktop 5-Slot Housing, 9161 Single T1 NAM, DC Power Supply,  
Cables, Manuals  
Rack-Mount 5-Slot Housing (without bezel and chassis skins),  
9161 Single T1 NAM, DC Power Supply, Cables, Manuals  
Desktop 5-Slot Housing, 9261 Dual T1 NAM, 120 Vac Power  
Supply, Cables, Manuals  
Rack-Mount 5-Slot Housing (without bezel and chassis skins),  
9261 Dual T1 NAM, AC Power Supply, Cables, Manuals  
Desktop 5-Slot Housing, 9261 Dual T1 NAM, DC Power Supply,  
Cables, Manuals  
Rack-Mount 5-Slot Housing (without bezel and chassis skins),  
9261 Dual T1 NAM, DC Power Supply, Cables, Manuals  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
G-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Equipment List  
Equipment  
Feature Number  
Access Carrier  
14-Slot Access Carrier, Fan Tray, Baffle, Universal AC Power  
Supply, Cables, Manuals  
9007-B1-409  
1xT1 Carrier NAM Spare, 9161 Single T1 NAM, NAM Manual  
1xT1 Carrier NAM with I/O, Cables, Manuals  
2xT1 Carrier NAM Spare, 9261 Dual T1 NAM, NAM Manual  
2xT1 Carrier NAM with I/O, Cables, Manuals  
Access Carrier Parts  
9161-B2-902  
9167-B1-902  
9261-B2-902  
9267-B1-902  
Access Carrier Baffle Assembly  
9007-S1-897  
9007-S1-898  
9007-S1-899  
Universal Power Supply Fan Tray  
Access Carrier Auxiliary Fan Tray  
T1 NAM Upgrade Kits  
Software to upgrade 9161 T1 NAM for FXO capability, software  
instructions, current FXO feature (9109-F1-658)  
9161-F1-658  
9161-F1-620  
9261-F1-620  
9261-F1-902  
Software to upgrade the 9161 Single T1 NAM, new NAM I/O, and  
manuals  
Software to upgrade the 9261 Dual T1 NAM, new NAM I/O, and  
manuals  
Hardware and Software Upgrade, 9261 Overlay, E8 Jumper, 2xT1  
I/O, Software, Cables, Manuals  
Rack/Wall Mounting Kits  
Mounting Brackets for 5-slot  
9001-F1-890  
9008-F1-893  
Universal 2/5-slot Wall Mount Kit  
Power Supplies  
120 Vac Power Supply (for 2-slot housing)  
120 Vac Power Supply (for 5-slot housing)  
DC Power Supply (for 5-slot housing)  
Universal Power Supply (for Access Carrier)  
T1 NAMs  
9002-F1-020  
9005-F1-020  
9005-F1-050  
9007-F1-040  
9161 Single T1 Network Access Module (NAM)  
9261 Dual T1 Network Access Module (NAM)  
9161-B1-902  
9261-B1-902  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
G-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Equipment List  
Equipment  
Feature Number  
APMs  
High-Speed Synchronous Data Application Module (APM)  
FXS Analog Voice Application Module (APM), 2-Wire  
FXO Analog Voice Application Module (APM), 2-Wire  
E&M Analog Voice Application Module (APM), 4-Wire  
Dual DSX Application Module (APM)  
OCU-DP 2-Port Application Module (APM)  
OCU-DP 6-Port Application Module (APM)  
Manual  
9109-F1-604  
9109-F1-648  
9109-F1-658  
9109-F1-668  
9109-F1-692  
9109-F1-622  
9109-F1-626  
Model 916x/926x T1 Access Mux Technical Reference (paper),  
9161-A2-GH30  
9161-M2-001  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
G-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Equipment List  
Equipment  
Feature Number Cable Part Number  
Cables/Connectors  
Network Interface Cable, 20 ft.  
V.35 Interconnect Cable, 1 ft.  
V.11/X.21 Interconnect Cable, 1 ft.  
RS449 Interconnect Cable, 1 ft.  
3100-F1-500  
3100-F1-570  
3100-F1-571  
3100-F1-580  
3100-F2-540  
035-0209-2031  
035-0244-0031  
035-0302-0131  
035-0245-0031  
035-0314-1431  
DB25 COM Port Cable (25 D to 8 mod),  
14 ft.  
DB9 COM Port Cable (9 DSUB-to-8 mod),  
14 ft.  
3100-F2-550  
035-0313-1431  
LAN COM Port Cable (8 mod-to-8 mod)  
3100-F2-910  
035-0315-1431  
035-0320-0531  
Voice Cable (Amphenol plug-Amphenol plug, 9008-F1-531  
25 pairs), 6 ft.  
Voice Cable (Amphenol socket-Amphenol  
plug, 25 pairs), 25 ft.  
9008-F1-532  
9008-F1-533  
9008-F1-534  
035-0321-2531  
035-0318-0631  
035-0319-0631  
Voice Connector (3 Amphenol plug-4  
Amphenol plug), 6 ft.  
Voice Connector (3 Amphenol plug-1  
Amphenol plug), 6 ft.  
M66 Block (with 2 socket 50-pin connectors) 9008-F1-535  
__  
Modem Cable (8-pin RJ45-to-DB25 plug)  
RJ48S DDS Network Cable (14 ft.)  
RJ48S DDS Cable (25 ft.)  
9008-F1-550  
3600-F3-501  
3600-F3-502  
9007-F1-500  
035-0336-1431  
035-0267-1431  
035-0267-2531  
035-0363-0531  
T1 Mass Termination Cable (50-pin plug-to-  
seven RJ48S plug), 5 ft.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
G-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Glossary  
AIS  
Alarm Indication Signal. An all ones signal transmitted to maintain transmission continuity  
and to indicate to the receiving terminal that a transmission fault exists at either the  
transmitting terminal or upstream of the transmitting signal. Sometimes referred to as Blue  
Alarm.  
AMI  
Alternate Mark Inversion. A line coding technique used to accommodate the ones density  
requirements of E1 or T1 lines.  
APM  
AWG  
Application Module.  
American Wire Gauge. An indication of wire size. The heavier the gauge, the lower the  
AWG number, and the lower the impedance.  
BES  
Bursty Error Seconds. A second in which more than one, but less than 320 CRC6 error  
events have occurred.  
BPV  
Bipolar Violation. In a bipolar signal, a one (mark, pulse) which has the same polarity as its  
predecessor.  
B8ZS  
Bipolar with Eight Zero Substitution. Encoding scheme for transmitting clear channel  
signals over a T1 line.  
COM port  
Communications port. A computer’s serial communications port used to transmit to and  
receive data from a modem. The modem connects directly to this port.  
configuration option  
Device software that sets specific operating parameters for the device. Sometimes  
referred to as straps.  
CRC  
CSS  
Cyclic Redundancy Check. A mathematical method of confirming the integrity of received  
digital data.  
Controlled Slip Seconds. A period in which a frame was added or deleted because of a  
variance in timing.  
CSU  
DCE  
Channel Service Unit. A device that connects service user equipment or a DSU to the local  
digital telephone loop.  
Data Communications Equipment. The equipment that provides the functions required to  
establish, maintain, and end a connection. It also provides the signal conversion required  
for communication between the DTE and the network.  
DID  
DPO  
DPT  
DSU  
Direct Inward Dialing.  
Dial Pulse Originating.  
Dial Pulse Terminating.  
Data Service Unit. Data communications equipment that provides timing, signal  
regeneration, and an interface to data terminal equipment. A subrate DSU/CSU is normally  
referred to as a DSU.  
DSX-1  
DS0  
Digital Signal Cross Connect level 1. An interconnection point for terminals, multiplexers  
and transmission facilities.  
Digital Signal level 0 (zero). A 64 kbps digital telecommunications signal or channel.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
GL-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary  
DS1  
Digital Signal level 1 (one). A digital signal transmitted at the rate of 1.544 Mbps in North  
America.  
DTE  
Data Terminal Equipment. The equipment, such as a computer or terminal, that provides  
data in the form of digital signals for transmission.  
DTMF  
D4  
Dual Tone Multifrequency. The basis of operation for a pushbutton telephone.  
The transmission standard that specifies 12 frames as a superframe that is used for frame  
synchronization and to locate signaling bits.  
EER  
Excessive Error Rate. An error rate that is greater than the threshold that has been  
configured in the device.  
EON  
ES  
End of Number.  
Errored second. A second with one or more ESF error events (one or more CRC6 error  
events or OOFs).  
ESD  
ESF  
FCC  
FDL  
FXO  
ElectroStatic discharge. An undesirable discharge of static electricity that can damage  
equipment and degrade electrical circuitry.  
Extended Superframe. The T1 transmission standard that specifies 24 frames as an  
extended superframe to be used for frame synchronization and to locate signaling bits.  
Federal Communications Commission. The Board of Commissioners that regulates all  
electrical communications that originate in the United States.  
Facility Data Link. The selected framing bits in the ESF format used in a wide-area link that  
are used for control, monitoring, and testing.  
Foreign Exchange Office. An APM that extends voice channel connectivity to remote  
switching equipment. The FXO interface appears as a telephone to the connecting  
equipment.  
FXODN  
FXS  
Foreign Exchange Office Software-Defined Network.  
Foreign Exchange Station. An APM that provides voice channel connectivity directly to  
handsets or to PBX equipment.  
FXSDN  
ICMP  
Foreign Exchange Station Software-Defined Network.  
Internet Control Management Protocol. Internet protocol that allows for the generation of  
error messages, tests packets, and information messages related to IP.  
IP  
Internet Protocol. An open networking protocol used for internet packet delivery.  
ITU  
International Telecommunication Union. The telecommunications agency of the United  
Nations, established to provide standardized communications procedures and practices.  
Before March 1993 it was called CCITT.  
LBO  
LCD  
Line Build-out. The amount of attenuation of the transmitted signal that is used to  
compensate for the length of wire between the transmitter and the receiver.  
Liquid Crystal Display. Thin glass plates containing liquid crystal material. When voltage is  
applied, the amount of light able to pass through the glass plates is altered so that  
messages can be displayed.  
LED  
LLB  
Light Emitting Diode. A light or status indicator that glows in response to the presence of a  
certain condition (e.g., an alarm).  
Line Loopback. A test in which the received signal on the network interface is looped back  
to the network without change.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
GL-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary  
LOF  
Loss of Frame. Occurs when a DS1 terminal is unable to synchronize on the DS1 signal  
for some interval.  
LOFC  
Loss of Frame Count. The number of LOFs declared.  
loopback  
A diagnostic procedure that sends a test message back to its origination point. Used to  
test various portions of a data link in order to isolate an equipment or data line problem.  
LOS  
MIB  
Loss of Signal. The T1 line condition where there are no pulses.  
Management Information Base. A database of managed objects used by SNMP to provide  
network management information and device control.  
MUX  
Multiplexer. A device used to interleave or simultaneously transmit multiple independent  
data streams into a single high-speed data stream. Multiplexing techniques include FDM  
(frequency division multiplexing), TDM (time division multiplexing), and STDM (statistical  
time division multiplexing).  
NAM  
Network Access Module. A type of CCA that accesses or acts as an interface with the  
network.  
OCU-DP  
OOF  
Office Channel Unit–Data Port.  
Out Of Frame. An error condition in which frame synchronization bits are in error.  
Off-Premises Extension.  
OPX  
PAD  
Packet Assembly and Disassembly. The term PAD often is used with regard to  
X.25 networks; however, it can apply to any packet-switched network, such as frame relay.  
PBX  
Private Branch Exchange. Telephone switching equipment dedicated to one customer. A  
PBX connects private telephones to each other and to the public dial network.  
PDU  
PDV  
Protocol Data Unit. A message containing protocol-specific information.  
Pulse Density Violation. The number of ones (marks, pulses) is not adequate for the line  
requirement.  
PLAR  
PPP  
Private Line Automatic Ringdown.  
Point-to-Point Protocol, as specified by Internet RFC 1661.  
PSTN  
Public Switched Telephone Network. A network shared among many users who can use  
telephones to establish connections between two points. Also known as dial network.  
QRSS  
Quasi-Random Signal. A test pattern simulating a random pattern of digital ones and zeros  
used to simulate normal transmission.  
RBS  
RIP  
SES  
Robbed Bit Signaling. Signaling used for voice-call processing over a T1 line.  
Routing Information Protocol. A protocol for exchanging routing information.  
Severely Errored Seconds. Usually defined as a second during which a specific number of  
CRC errors was exceeded, or an OOF or other critical error occurred.  
SLIP  
SNMP  
UAS  
Vac  
Serial Line Internet Protocol. Protocol for serial operation on an internet.  
Simple Network Management Protocol. Protocol for open networking management.  
Unavailable Seconds. A count of one-second intervals when service is unavailable.  
Volts alternating current.  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
GL-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary  
VF  
Voice Frequency. The part of the audio frequency range used to transmit voice sound  
(usually 300 Hz to 3400 Hz). This band is used by the modem for its modulated signal.  
virtual circuit  
Yellow Alarm  
A logical link/connection or packet-switching mechanism established between two devices  
at the start of transmission.  
An outgoing signal transmitted when a DS1 terminal has determined that it has lost the  
incoming signal.  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
GL-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Numbers  
64KCC Loop OOF Alarm, OCU-DP, 5-34  
APM  
A
Abnormal Station Code Alarm, OCU-DP, 5-33  
Access  
OCU-DP, 1-6  
Limiting Async Terminal Direct , 6-1  
access carrier, 1-3  
security, 4-3  
Access Type, 6-8  
Action on Network Yellow Alarm, 5-19  
T1 access unit with high speed data and drop &  
assign  
Alternate Dial-Out Directory, 5-65  
async terminal interface, direct management control,  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
IN-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
B
primary, 5-49  
secondary, 5-50  
Bit Stuffing, 5-8  
C
cable  
Communication Port  
components  
COM port to terminal/printer, E-2  
EIA 530A-to-RS449 DTE adapter, E-9  
EIA 530A-to-V.35 DTE adapter, E-7  
EIA 530A-to-X.21 DTE Adapter, E-11  
Configuration  
Call  
changing  
channels  
Circuit Identifier, 5-11  
Configuration options  
Clock Failure Alarm  
Configuration Worksheets, A-1  
configure  
Primary, 5-51  
Secondary, 5-51  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
IN-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
connectivity, IP, 1-8  
dialing out  
connector  
Control  
Directory Numbers  
Disconnect Time, 5-55, 5-62  
displaying  
control  
document  
creating  
summary, ix  
DSX-1  
cross-reference, SNMP, D-1  
D
DDS Network Failure Alarm, OCU-DP, 5-34  
Delete key, 4-5  
E
50-Pin Amphenol Connector, E-13  
Dial-Out Delay Time (Min), 5-65  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
IN-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
file transfer, 8-9  
Enter key, 4-5  
Enterprise Specific Traps, 5-76  
function keys  
Esc key, 4-5  
FXO/FXS, 50-Pin Amphenol Connector, E-12  
External Device  
setting up communication port for, 5-57  
G
gender adapter/changer, E-3  
General Traps, 5-76  
F
H
hardware revision  
feature numbers  
access carrier, G-2  
housing  
access carrier, 1-3  
Field  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
IN-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Line Framing Format  
I
interface  
async terminal/user, 4-3  
Interface Status  
logging  
Invalid  
Login  
Character, 9-18  
IP connectivity, 1-8  
Loopback Detection, OCU-DP, 5-33  
Loss of Loop Timing Alarm, OCU-DP, 5-34  
Loss of Signal Alarm, OCU-DP, 5-33  
K
M
keys  
Management  
L
Management and Communication  
limiting  
Line Coding Format  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
IN-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Network interface  
Messages  
messages  
system error, 9-18  
NMS, security, set up, 5-72  
No  
Model number, NAM, 7-1  
Monitor Pattern  
O
OCU-DP ports  
N
OCU-DP tests  
Operating Mode  
Network  
network  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
IN-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Port Rate, OCU-DP, 5-33  
Port Status  
P
Parity, 5-54  
Matching Error, 9-18  
Performance Statistics  
power supply, 1-10  
pin assignments  
R
E&M voice APM connector, E-13  
FXO/FXS voice APM connector, E-12  
FXS voice APM connector, E-12  
LAN adapter, E-4  
Return (Enter) key, 4-5  
right arrow key, 4-5  
T1 Network Interface Connector, E-5  
Routing  
Please Wait, 7-17  
port  
Rx Gain (dB)  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Index  
SNMP  
S
screen  
MIB to User Interface Command Cross-Reference,  
selecting  
Send All Ones on Data Port Not Ready, 5-19  
Send Pattern  
setting up for, 5-70  
SNMP NMS Security, setting up, 5-72  
serial, APM number, 7-2  
serial number, NAM, 7-1  
Session  
software  
Spacebar, 4-5  
set  
selecting performance intervals for display, 7-14  
setting up  
Signaling, force and monitor, 9-35  
Signaling Type  
April 1998  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
IN-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
status  
Terminating Impedance (ohms)  
Test  
subnet  
routing using different, B-5  
system  
System Alarm Relay, 5-66  
T
T1  
Network Interface Connector, E-5  
Tab key, 4-5  
Telnet  
Timeout, Test, 9-43  
9161-A2-GH30-30  
April 1998  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 

Miele Microwave Oven DA249 4 Alu User Manual
Mr Heater Electric Heater MH45T User Manual
MTD Snow Blower 769 01276A User Manual
NEC Computer Monitor XM37 User Manual
Nilfisk Advance America Pressure Washer C 1203 User Manual
NordicTrack Home Gym NTSY98960 User Manual
Nortel Networks Telephone 150 User Manual
N Tron Switch 1003GX2 User Manual
Optiview DVR DVRJ4A User Manual
Panasonic Network Card FP Sigma User Manual